make fetch
[automake.git] / lib / texinfo.tex
blob9bd75b91e462fb16e2c393ef28018057a97eba0f
1 % texinfo.tex -- TeX macros to handle Texinfo files.
2 %
3 % Load plain if necessary, i.e., if running under initex.
4 \expandafter\ifx\csname fmtname\endcsname\relax\input plain\fi
6 \def\texinfoversion{2017-09-16.10}
8 % Copyright 1985, 1986, 1988, 1990, 1991, 1992, 1993, 1994, 1995,
9 % 1996, 1997, 1998, 1999, 2000, 2001, 2002, 2003, 2004, 2005, 2006,
10 % 2007, 2008, 2009, 2010, 2011, 2012, 2013, 2014, 2015, 2016, 2017
11 % Free Software Foundation, Inc.
13 % This texinfo.tex file is free software: you can redistribute it and/or
14 % modify it under the terms of the GNU General Public License as
15 % published by the Free Software Foundation, either version 3 of the
16 % License, or (at your option) any later version.
18 % This texinfo.tex file is distributed in the hope that it will be
19 % useful, but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty
20 % of MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the GNU
21 % General Public License for more details.
23 % You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License
24 % along with this program. If not, see <https://www.gnu.org/licenses/>.
26 % As a special exception, when this file is read by TeX when processing
27 % a Texinfo source document, you may use the result without
28 % restriction. This Exception is an additional permission under section 7
29 % of the GNU General Public License, version 3 ("GPLv3").
31 % Please try the latest version of texinfo.tex before submitting bug
32 % reports; you can get the latest version from:
33 % https://ftp.gnu.org/gnu/texinfo/ (the Texinfo release area), or
34 % https://ftpmirror.gnu.org/texinfo/ (same, via a mirror), or
35 % https://www.gnu.org/software/texinfo/ (the Texinfo home page)
36 % The texinfo.tex in any given distribution could well be out
37 % of date, so if that's what you're using, please check.
39 % Send bug reports to bug-texinfo@gnu.org. Please include including a
40 % complete document in each bug report with which we can reproduce the
41 % problem. Patches are, of course, greatly appreciated.
43 % To process a Texinfo manual with TeX, it's most reliable to use the
44 % texi2dvi shell script that comes with the distribution. For a simple
45 % manual foo.texi, however, you can get away with this:
46 % tex foo.texi
47 % texindex foo.??
48 % tex foo.texi
49 % tex foo.texi
50 % dvips foo.dvi -o # or whatever; this makes foo.ps.
51 % The extra TeX runs get the cross-reference information correct.
52 % Sometimes one run after texindex suffices, and sometimes you need more
53 % than two; texi2dvi does it as many times as necessary.
55 % It is possible to adapt texinfo.tex for other languages, to some
56 % extent. You can get the existing language-specific files from the
57 % full Texinfo distribution.
59 % The GNU Texinfo home page is https://www.gnu.org/software/texinfo.
62 \message{Loading texinfo [version \texinfoversion]:}
64 % If in a .fmt file, print the version number
65 % and turn on active characters that we couldn't do earlier because
66 % they might have appeared in the input file name.
67 \everyjob{\message{[Texinfo version \texinfoversion]}%
68 \catcode`+=\active \catcode`\_=\active}
70 % LaTeX's \typeout. This ensures that the messages it is used for
71 % are identical in format to the corresponding ones from latex/pdflatex.
72 \def\typeout{\immediate\write17}%
74 \chardef\other=12
76 % We never want plain's \outer definition of \+ in Texinfo.
77 % For @tex, we can use \tabalign.
78 \let\+ = \relax
80 % Save some plain tex macros whose names we will redefine.
81 \let\ptexb=\b
82 \let\ptexbullet=\bullet
83 \let\ptexc=\c
84 \let\ptexcomma=\,
85 \let\ptexdot=\.
86 \let\ptexdots=\dots
87 \let\ptexend=\end
88 \let\ptexequiv=\equiv
89 \let\ptexexclam=\!
90 \let\ptexfootnote=\footnote
91 \let\ptexgtr=>
92 \let\ptexhat=^
93 \let\ptexi=\i
94 \let\ptexindent=\indent
95 \let\ptexinsert=\insert
96 \let\ptexlbrace=\{
97 \let\ptexless=<
98 \let\ptexnewwrite\newwrite
99 \let\ptexnoindent=\noindent
100 \let\ptexplus=+
101 \let\ptexraggedright=\raggedright
102 \let\ptexrbrace=\}
103 \let\ptexslash=\/
104 \let\ptexsp=\sp
105 \let\ptexstar=\*
106 \let\ptexsup=\sup
107 \let\ptext=\t
108 \let\ptextop=\top
109 {\catcode`\'=\active \global\let\ptexquoteright'}% active in plain's math mode
111 % If this character appears in an error message or help string, it
112 % starts a new line in the output.
113 \newlinechar = `^^J
115 % Use TeX 3.0's \inputlineno to get the line number, for better error
116 % messages, but if we're using an old version of TeX, don't do anything.
118 \ifx\inputlineno\thisisundefined
119 \let\linenumber = \empty % Pre-3.0.
120 \else
121 \def\linenumber{l.\the\inputlineno:\space}
124 % Set up fixed words for English if not already set.
125 \ifx\putwordAppendix\undefined \gdef\putwordAppendix{Appendix}\fi
126 \ifx\putwordChapter\undefined \gdef\putwordChapter{Chapter}\fi
127 \ifx\putworderror\undefined \gdef\putworderror{error}\fi
128 \ifx\putwordfile\undefined \gdef\putwordfile{file}\fi
129 \ifx\putwordin\undefined \gdef\putwordin{in}\fi
130 \ifx\putwordIndexIsEmpty\undefined \gdef\putwordIndexIsEmpty{(Index is empty)}\fi
131 \ifx\putwordIndexNonexistent\undefined \gdef\putwordIndexNonexistent{(Index is nonexistent)}\fi
132 \ifx\putwordInfo\undefined \gdef\putwordInfo{Info}\fi
133 \ifx\putwordInstanceVariableof\undefined \gdef\putwordInstanceVariableof{Instance Variable of}\fi
134 \ifx\putwordMethodon\undefined \gdef\putwordMethodon{Method on}\fi
135 \ifx\putwordNoTitle\undefined \gdef\putwordNoTitle{No Title}\fi
136 \ifx\putwordof\undefined \gdef\putwordof{of}\fi
137 \ifx\putwordon\undefined \gdef\putwordon{on}\fi
138 \ifx\putwordpage\undefined \gdef\putwordpage{page}\fi
139 \ifx\putwordsection\undefined \gdef\putwordsection{section}\fi
140 \ifx\putwordSection\undefined \gdef\putwordSection{Section}\fi
141 \ifx\putwordsee\undefined \gdef\putwordsee{see}\fi
142 \ifx\putwordSee\undefined \gdef\putwordSee{See}\fi
143 \ifx\putwordShortTOC\undefined \gdef\putwordShortTOC{Short Contents}\fi
144 \ifx\putwordTOC\undefined \gdef\putwordTOC{Table of Contents}\fi
146 \ifx\putwordMJan\undefined \gdef\putwordMJan{January}\fi
147 \ifx\putwordMFeb\undefined \gdef\putwordMFeb{February}\fi
148 \ifx\putwordMMar\undefined \gdef\putwordMMar{March}\fi
149 \ifx\putwordMApr\undefined \gdef\putwordMApr{April}\fi
150 \ifx\putwordMMay\undefined \gdef\putwordMMay{May}\fi
151 \ifx\putwordMJun\undefined \gdef\putwordMJun{June}\fi
152 \ifx\putwordMJul\undefined \gdef\putwordMJul{July}\fi
153 \ifx\putwordMAug\undefined \gdef\putwordMAug{August}\fi
154 \ifx\putwordMSep\undefined \gdef\putwordMSep{September}\fi
155 \ifx\putwordMOct\undefined \gdef\putwordMOct{October}\fi
156 \ifx\putwordMNov\undefined \gdef\putwordMNov{November}\fi
157 \ifx\putwordMDec\undefined \gdef\putwordMDec{December}\fi
159 \ifx\putwordDefmac\undefined \gdef\putwordDefmac{Macro}\fi
160 \ifx\putwordDefspec\undefined \gdef\putwordDefspec{Special Form}\fi
161 \ifx\putwordDefvar\undefined \gdef\putwordDefvar{Variable}\fi
162 \ifx\putwordDefopt\undefined \gdef\putwordDefopt{User Option}\fi
163 \ifx\putwordDeffunc\undefined \gdef\putwordDeffunc{Function}\fi
165 % Give the space character the catcode for a space.
166 \def\spaceisspace{\catcode`\ =10\relax}
168 % Likewise for ^^M, the end of line character.
169 \def\endlineisspace{\catcode13=10\relax}
171 \chardef\dashChar = `\-
172 \chardef\slashChar = `\/
173 \chardef\underChar = `\_
175 % Ignore a token.
177 \def\gobble#1{}
179 % The following is used inside several \edef's.
180 \def\makecsname#1{\expandafter\noexpand\csname#1\endcsname}
182 % Hyphenation fixes.
183 \hyphenation{
184 Flor-i-da Ghost-script Ghost-view Mac-OS Post-Script
185 ap-pen-dix bit-map bit-maps
186 data-base data-bases eshell fall-ing half-way long-est man-u-script
187 man-u-scripts mini-buf-fer mini-buf-fers over-view par-a-digm
188 par-a-digms rath-er rec-tan-gu-lar ro-bot-ics se-vere-ly set-up spa-ces
189 spell-ing spell-ings
190 stand-alone strong-est time-stamp time-stamps which-ever white-space
191 wide-spread wrap-around
194 % Sometimes it is convenient to have everything in the transcript file
195 % and nothing on the terminal. We don't just call \tracingall here,
196 % since that produces some useless output on the terminal. We also make
197 % some effort to order the tracing commands to reduce output in the log
198 % file; cf. trace.sty in LaTeX.
200 \def\gloggingall{\begingroup \globaldefs = 1 \loggingall \endgroup}%
201 \def\loggingall{%
202 \tracingstats2
203 \tracingpages1
204 \tracinglostchars2 % 2 gives us more in etex
205 \tracingparagraphs1
206 \tracingoutput1
207 \tracingmacros2
208 \tracingrestores1
209 \showboxbreadth\maxdimen \showboxdepth\maxdimen
210 \ifx\eTeXversion\thisisundefined\else % etex gives us more logging
211 \tracingscantokens1
212 \tracingifs1
213 \tracinggroups1
214 \tracingnesting2
215 \tracingassigns1
217 \tracingcommands3 % 3 gives us more in etex
218 \errorcontextlines16
221 % @errormsg{MSG}. Do the index-like expansions on MSG, but if things
222 % aren't perfect, it's not the end of the world, being an error message,
223 % after all.
225 \def\errormsg{\begingroup \indexnofonts \doerrormsg}
226 \def\doerrormsg#1{\errmessage{#1}}
228 % add check for \lastpenalty to plain's definitions. If the last thing
229 % we did was a \nobreak, we don't want to insert more space.
231 \def\smallbreak{\ifnum\lastpenalty<10000\par\ifdim\lastskip<\smallskipamount
232 \removelastskip\penalty-50\smallskip\fi\fi}
233 \def\medbreak{\ifnum\lastpenalty<10000\par\ifdim\lastskip<\medskipamount
234 \removelastskip\penalty-100\medskip\fi\fi}
235 \def\bigbreak{\ifnum\lastpenalty<10000\par\ifdim\lastskip<\bigskipamount
236 \removelastskip\penalty-200\bigskip\fi\fi}
238 %\f Output routine
241 % For a final copy, take out the rectangles
242 % that mark overfull boxes (in case you have decided
243 % that the text looks ok even though it passes the margin).
245 \def\finalout{\overfullrule=0pt }
247 % Do @cropmarks to get crop marks.
249 \newif\ifcropmarks
250 \let\cropmarks = \cropmarkstrue
252 % Dimensions to add cropmarks at corners.
253 % Added by P. A. MacKay, 12 Nov. 1986
255 \newdimen\outerhsize \newdimen\outervsize % set by the paper size routines
256 \newdimen\cornerlong \cornerlong=1pc
257 \newdimen\cornerthick \cornerthick=.3pt
258 \newdimen\topandbottommargin \topandbottommargin=.75in
260 % Output a mark which sets \thischapter, \thissection and \thiscolor.
261 % We dump everything together because we only have one kind of mark.
262 % This works because we only use \botmark / \topmark, not \firstmark.
264 % A mark contains a subexpression of the \ifcase ... \fi construct.
265 % \get*marks macros below extract the needed part using \ifcase.
267 % Another complication is to let the user choose whether \thischapter
268 % (\thissection) refers to the chapter (section) in effect at the top
269 % of a page, or that at the bottom of a page.
271 % \domark is called twice inside \chapmacro, to add one
272 % mark before the section break, and one after.
273 % In the second call \prevchapterdefs is the same as \lastchapterdefs,
274 % and \prevsectiondefs is the same as \lastsectiondefs.
275 % Then if the page is not broken at the mark, some of the previous
276 % section appears on the page, and we can get the name of this section
277 % from \firstmark for @everyheadingmarks top.
278 % @everyheadingmarks bottom uses \botmark.
280 % See page 260 of The TeXbook.
281 \def\domark{%
282 \toks0=\expandafter{\lastchapterdefs}%
283 \toks2=\expandafter{\lastsectiondefs}%
284 \toks4=\expandafter{\prevchapterdefs}%
285 \toks6=\expandafter{\prevsectiondefs}%
286 \toks8=\expandafter{\lastcolordefs}%
287 \mark{%
288 \the\toks0 \the\toks2 % 0: marks for @everyheadingmarks top
289 \noexpand\or \the\toks4 \the\toks6 % 1: for @everyheadingmarks bottom
290 \noexpand\else \the\toks8 % 2: color marks
294 % \gettopheadingmarks, \getbottomheadingmarks,
295 % \getcolormarks - extract needed part of mark.
297 % \topmark doesn't work for the very first chapter (after the title
298 % page or the contents), so we use \firstmark there -- this gets us
299 % the mark with the chapter defs, unless the user sneaks in, e.g.,
300 % @setcolor (or @url, or @link, etc.) between @contents and the very
301 % first @chapter.
302 \def\gettopheadingmarks{%
303 \ifcase0\topmark\fi
304 \ifx\thischapter\empty \ifcase0\firstmark\fi \fi
306 \def\getbottomheadingmarks{\ifcase1\botmark\fi}
307 \def\getcolormarks{\ifcase2\topmark\fi}
309 % Avoid "undefined control sequence" errors.
310 \def\lastchapterdefs{}
311 \def\lastsectiondefs{}
312 \def\lastsection{}
313 \def\prevchapterdefs{}
314 \def\prevsectiondefs{}
315 \def\lastcolordefs{}
317 % Margin to add to right of even pages, to left of odd pages.
318 \newdimen\bindingoffset
319 \newdimen\normaloffset
320 \newdimen\txipagewidth \newdimen\txipageheight
322 % Main output routine.
324 \chardef\PAGE = 255
325 \output = {\onepageout{\pagecontents\PAGE}}
327 \newbox\headlinebox
328 \newbox\footlinebox
330 % \onepageout takes a vbox as an argument.
331 % \shipout a vbox for a single page, adding an optional header, footer,
332 % cropmarks, and footnote. This also causes index entries for this page
333 % to be written to the auxiliary files.
335 \def\onepageout#1{%
336 \ifcropmarks \hoffset=0pt \else \hoffset=\normaloffset \fi
338 \ifodd\pageno \advance\hoffset by \bindingoffset
339 \else \advance\hoffset by -\bindingoffset\fi
341 % Common context changes for both heading and footing.
342 % Do this outside of the \shipout so @code etc. will be expanded in
343 % the headline as they should be, not taken literally (outputting ''code).
344 \def\commmonheadfootline{\let\hsize=\txipagewidth \texinfochars}
346 % Retrieve the information for the headings from the marks in the page,
347 % and call Plain TeX's \makeheadline and \makefootline, which use the
348 % values in \headline and \footline.
350 % This is used to check if we are on the first page of a chapter.
351 \ifcase1\topmark\fi
352 \let\prevchaptername\thischaptername
353 \ifcase0\firstmark\fi
354 \let\curchaptername\thischaptername
356 \ifodd\pageno \getoddheadingmarks \else \getevenheadingmarks \fi
357 \ifodd\pageno \getoddfootingmarks \else \getevenfootingmarks \fi
359 \ifx\curchaptername\prevchaptername
360 \let\thischapterheading\thischapter
361 \else
362 % \thischapterheading is the same as \thischapter except it is blank
363 % for the first page of a chapter. This is to prevent the chapter name
364 % being shown twice.
365 \def\thischapterheading{}%
368 \global\setbox\headlinebox = \vbox{\commmonheadfootline \makeheadline}%
369 \global\setbox\footlinebox = \vbox{\commmonheadfootline \makefootline}%
372 % Set context for writing to auxiliary files like index files.
373 % Have to do this stuff outside the \shipout because we want it to
374 % take effect in \write's, yet the group defined by the \vbox ends
375 % before the \shipout runs.
377 \indexdummies % don't expand commands in the output.
378 \normalturnoffactive % \ in index entries must not stay \, e.g., if
379 % the page break happens to be in the middle of an example.
380 % We don't want .vr (or whatever) entries like this:
381 % \entry{{\indexbackslash }acronym}{32}{\code {\acronym}}
382 % "\acronym" won't work when it's read back in;
383 % it needs to be
384 % {\code {{\backslashcurfont }acronym}
385 \shipout\vbox{%
386 % Do this early so pdf references go to the beginning of the page.
387 \ifpdfmakepagedest \pdfdest name{\the\pageno} xyz\fi
389 \ifcropmarks \vbox to \outervsize\bgroup
390 \hsize = \outerhsize
391 \vskip-\topandbottommargin
392 \vtop to0pt{%
393 \line{\ewtop\hfil\ewtop}%
394 \nointerlineskip
395 \line{%
396 \vbox{\moveleft\cornerthick\nstop}%
397 \hfill
398 \vbox{\moveright\cornerthick\nstop}%
400 \vss}%
401 \vskip\topandbottommargin
402 \line\bgroup
403 \hfil % center the page within the outer (page) hsize.
404 \ifodd\pageno\hskip\bindingoffset\fi
405 \vbox\bgroup
408 \unvbox\headlinebox
409 \pagebody{#1}%
410 \ifdim\ht\footlinebox > 0pt
411 % Only leave this space if the footline is nonempty.
412 % (We lessened \vsize for it in \oddfootingyyy.)
413 % The \baselineskip=24pt in plain's \makefootline has no effect.
414 \vskip 24pt
415 \unvbox\footlinebox
418 \ifcropmarks
419 \egroup % end of \vbox\bgroup
420 \hfil\egroup % end of (centering) \line\bgroup
421 \vskip\topandbottommargin plus1fill minus1fill
422 \boxmaxdepth = \cornerthick
423 \vbox to0pt{\vss
424 \line{%
425 \vbox{\moveleft\cornerthick\nsbot}%
426 \hfill
427 \vbox{\moveright\cornerthick\nsbot}%
429 \nointerlineskip
430 \line{\ewbot\hfil\ewbot}%
432 \egroup % \vbox from first cropmarks clause
434 }% end of \shipout\vbox
435 }% end of group with \indexdummies
436 \advancepageno
437 \ifnum\outputpenalty>-20000 \else\dosupereject\fi
440 \newinsert\margin \dimen\margin=\maxdimen
442 % Main part of page, including any footnotes
443 \def\pagebody#1{\vbox to\txipageheight{\boxmaxdepth=\maxdepth #1}}
444 {\catcode`\@ =11
445 \gdef\pagecontents#1{\ifvoid\topins\else\unvbox\topins\fi
446 % marginal hacks, juha@viisa.uucp (Juha Takala)
447 \ifvoid\margin\else % marginal info is present
448 \rlap{\kern\hsize\vbox to\z@{\kern1pt\box\margin \vss}}\fi
449 \dimen@=\dp#1\relax \unvbox#1\relax
450 \ifvoid\footins\else\vskip\skip\footins\footnoterule \unvbox\footins\fi
451 \ifr@ggedbottom \kern-\dimen@ \vfil \fi}
454 % Here are the rules for the cropmarks. Note that they are
455 % offset so that the space between them is truly \outerhsize or \outervsize
456 % (P. A. MacKay, 12 November, 1986)
458 \def\ewtop{\vrule height\cornerthick depth0pt width\cornerlong}
459 \def\nstop{\vbox
460 {\hrule height\cornerthick depth\cornerlong width\cornerthick}}
461 \def\ewbot{\vrule height0pt depth\cornerthick width\cornerlong}
462 \def\nsbot{\vbox
463 {\hrule height\cornerlong depth\cornerthick width\cornerthick}}
466 % Argument parsing
468 % Parse an argument, then pass it to #1. The argument is the rest of
469 % the input line (except we remove a trailing comment). #1 should be a
470 % macro which expects an ordinary undelimited TeX argument.
471 % For example, \def\foo{\parsearg\fooxxx}.
473 \def\parsearg{\parseargusing{}}
474 \def\parseargusing#1#2{%
475 \def\argtorun{#2}%
476 \begingroup
477 \obeylines
478 \spaceisspace
480 \parseargline\empty% Insert the \empty token, see \finishparsearg below.
483 {\obeylines %
484 \gdef\parseargline#1^^M{%
485 \endgroup % End of the group started in \parsearg.
486 \argremovecomment #1\comment\ArgTerm%
490 % First remove any @comment, then any @c comment. Also remove a @texinfoc
491 % comment (see \scanmacro for details). Pass the result on to \argcheckspaces.
492 \def\argremovecomment#1\comment#2\ArgTerm{\argremovec #1\c\ArgTerm}
493 \def\argremovec#1\c#2\ArgTerm{\argremovetexinfoc #1\texinfoc\ArgTerm}
494 \def\argremovetexinfoc#1\texinfoc#2\ArgTerm{\argcheckspaces#1\^^M\ArgTerm}
496 % Each occurrence of `\^^M' or `<space>\^^M' is replaced by a single space.
498 % \argremovec might leave us with trailing space, e.g.,
499 % @end itemize @c foo
500 % This space token undergoes the same procedure and is eventually removed
501 % by \finishparsearg.
503 \def\argcheckspaces#1\^^M{\argcheckspacesX#1\^^M \^^M}
504 \def\argcheckspacesX#1 \^^M{\argcheckspacesY#1\^^M}
505 \def\argcheckspacesY#1\^^M#2\^^M#3\ArgTerm{%
506 \def\temp{#3}%
507 \ifx\temp\empty
508 % Do not use \next, perhaps the caller of \parsearg uses it; reuse \temp:
509 \let\temp\finishparsearg
510 \else
511 \let\temp\argcheckspaces
513 % Put the space token in:
514 \temp#1 #3\ArgTerm
517 % If a _delimited_ argument is enclosed in braces, they get stripped; so
518 % to get _exactly_ the rest of the line, we had to prevent such situation.
519 % We prepended an \empty token at the very beginning and we expand it now,
520 % just before passing the control to \argtorun.
521 % (Similarly, we have to think about #3 of \argcheckspacesY above: it is
522 % either the null string, or it ends with \^^M---thus there is no danger
523 % that a pair of braces would be stripped.
525 % But first, we have to remove the trailing space token.
527 \def\finishparsearg#1 \ArgTerm{\expandafter\argtorun\expandafter{#1}}
530 % \parseargdef - define a command taking an argument on the line
532 % \parseargdef\foo{...}
533 % is roughly equivalent to
534 % \def\foo{\parsearg\Xfoo}
535 % \def\Xfoo#1{...}
536 \def\parseargdef#1{%
537 \expandafter \doparseargdef \csname\string#1\endcsname #1%
539 \def\doparseargdef#1#2{%
540 \def#2{\parsearg#1}%
541 \def#1##1%
544 % Several utility definitions with active space:
546 \obeyspaces
547 \gdef\obeyedspace{ }
549 % Make each space character in the input produce a normal interword
550 % space in the output. Don't allow a line break at this space, as this
551 % is used only in environments like @example, where each line of input
552 % should produce a line of output anyway.
554 \gdef\sepspaces{\obeyspaces\let =\tie}
556 % If an index command is used in an @example environment, any spaces
557 % therein should become regular spaces in the raw index file, not the
558 % expansion of \tie (\leavevmode \penalty \@M \ ).
559 \gdef\unsepspaces{\let =\space}
563 \def\flushcr{\ifx\par\lisppar \def\next##1{}\else \let\next=\relax \fi \next}
565 % Define the framework for environments in texinfo.tex. It's used like this:
567 % \envdef\foo{...}
568 % \def\Efoo{...}
570 % It's the responsibility of \envdef to insert \begingroup before the
571 % actual body; @end closes the group after calling \Efoo. \envdef also
572 % defines \thisenv, so the current environment is known; @end checks
573 % whether the environment name matches. The \checkenv macro can also be
574 % used to check whether the current environment is the one expected.
576 % Non-false conditionals (@iftex, @ifset) don't fit into this, so they
577 % are not treated as environments; they don't open a group. (The
578 % implementation of @end takes care not to call \endgroup in this
579 % special case.)
582 % At run-time, environments start with this:
583 \def\startenvironment#1{\begingroup\def\thisenv{#1}}
584 % initialize
585 \let\thisenv\empty
587 % ... but they get defined via ``\envdef\foo{...}'':
588 \long\def\envdef#1#2{\def#1{\startenvironment#1#2}}
589 \def\envparseargdef#1#2{\parseargdef#1{\startenvironment#1#2}}
591 % Check whether we're in the right environment:
592 \def\checkenv#1{%
593 \def\temp{#1}%
594 \ifx\thisenv\temp
595 \else
596 \badenverr
600 % Environment mismatch, #1 expected:
601 \def\badenverr{%
602 \errhelp = \EMsimple
603 \errmessage{This command can appear only \inenvironment\temp,
604 not \inenvironment\thisenv}%
606 \def\inenvironment#1{%
607 \ifx#1\empty
608 outside of any environment%
609 \else
610 in environment \expandafter\string#1%
614 % @end foo executes the definition of \Efoo.
615 % But first, it executes a specialized version of \checkenv
617 \parseargdef\end{%
618 \if 1\csname iscond.#1\endcsname
619 \else
620 % The general wording of \badenverr may not be ideal.
621 \expandafter\checkenv\csname#1\endcsname
622 \csname E#1\endcsname
623 \endgroup
627 \newhelp\EMsimple{Press RETURN to continue.}
630 % Be sure we're in horizontal mode when doing a tie, since we make space
631 % equivalent to this in @example-like environments. Otherwise, a space
632 % at the beginning of a line will start with \penalty -- and
633 % since \penalty is valid in vertical mode, we'd end up putting the
634 % penalty on the vertical list instead of in the new paragraph.
635 {\catcode`@ = 11
636 % Avoid using \@M directly, because that causes trouble
637 % if the definition is written into an index file.
638 \global\let\tiepenalty = \@M
639 \gdef\tie{\leavevmode\penalty\tiepenalty\ }
642 % @: forces normal size whitespace following.
643 \def\:{\spacefactor=1000 }
645 % @* forces a line break.
646 \def\*{\unskip\hfil\break\hbox{}\ignorespaces}
648 % @/ allows a line break.
649 \let\/=\allowbreak
651 % @. is an end-of-sentence period.
652 \def\.{.\spacefactor=\endofsentencespacefactor\space}
654 % @! is an end-of-sentence bang.
655 \def\!{!\spacefactor=\endofsentencespacefactor\space}
657 % @? is an end-of-sentence query.
658 \def\?{?\spacefactor=\endofsentencespacefactor\space}
660 % @frenchspacing on|off says whether to put extra space after punctuation.
662 \def\onword{on}
663 \def\offword{off}
665 \parseargdef\frenchspacing{%
666 \def\temp{#1}%
667 \ifx\temp\onword \plainfrenchspacing
668 \else\ifx\temp\offword \plainnonfrenchspacing
669 \else
670 \errhelp = \EMsimple
671 \errmessage{Unknown @frenchspacing option `\temp', must be on|off}%
672 \fi\fi
675 % @w prevents a word break. Without the \leavevmode, @w at the
676 % beginning of a paragraph, when TeX is still in vertical mode, would
677 % produce a whole line of output instead of starting the paragraph.
678 \def\w#1{\leavevmode\hbox{#1}}
680 % @group ... @end group forces ... to be all on one page, by enclosing
681 % it in a TeX vbox. We use \vtop instead of \vbox to construct the box
682 % to keep its height that of a normal line. According to the rules for
683 % \topskip (p.114 of the TeXbook), the glue inserted is
684 % max (\topskip - \ht (first item), 0). If that height is large,
685 % therefore, no glue is inserted, and the space between the headline and
686 % the text is small, which looks bad.
688 % Another complication is that the group might be very large. This can
689 % cause the glue on the previous page to be unduly stretched, because it
690 % does not have much material. In this case, it's better to add an
691 % explicit \vfill so that the extra space is at the bottom. The
692 % threshold for doing this is if the group is more than \vfilllimit
693 % percent of a page (\vfilllimit can be changed inside of @tex).
695 \newbox\groupbox
696 \def\vfilllimit{0.7}
698 \envdef\group{%
699 \ifnum\catcode`\^^M=\active \else
700 \errhelp = \groupinvalidhelp
701 \errmessage{@group invalid in context where filling is enabled}%
703 \startsavinginserts
705 \setbox\groupbox = \vtop\bgroup
706 % Do @comment since we are called inside an environment such as
707 % @example, where each end-of-line in the input causes an
708 % end-of-line in the output. We don't want the end-of-line after
709 % the `@group' to put extra space in the output. Since @group
710 % should appear on a line by itself (according to the Texinfo
711 % manual), we don't worry about eating any user text.
712 \comment
715 % The \vtop produces a box with normal height and large depth; thus, TeX puts
716 % \baselineskip glue before it, and (when the next line of text is done)
717 % \lineskip glue after it. Thus, space below is not quite equal to space
718 % above. But it's pretty close.
719 \def\Egroup{%
720 % To get correct interline space between the last line of the group
721 % and the first line afterwards, we have to propagate \prevdepth.
722 \endgraf % Not \par, as it may have been set to \lisppar.
723 \global\dimen1 = \prevdepth
724 \egroup % End the \vtop.
725 \addgroupbox
726 \prevdepth = \dimen1
727 \checkinserts
730 \def\addgroupbox{
731 % \dimen0 is the vertical size of the group's box.
732 \dimen0 = \ht\groupbox \advance\dimen0 by \dp\groupbox
733 % \dimen2 is how much space is left on the page (more or less).
734 \dimen2 = \txipageheight \advance\dimen2 by -\pagetotal
735 % if the group doesn't fit on the current page, and it's a big big
736 % group, force a page break.
737 \ifdim \dimen0 > \dimen2
738 \ifdim \pagetotal < \vfilllimit\txipageheight
739 \page
742 \box\groupbox
746 % TeX puts in an \escapechar (i.e., `@') at the beginning of the help
747 % message, so this ends up printing `@group can only ...'.
749 \newhelp\groupinvalidhelp{%
750 group can only be used in environments such as @example,^^J%
751 where each line of input produces a line of output.}
753 % @need space-in-mils
754 % forces a page break if there is not space-in-mils remaining.
756 \newdimen\mil \mil=0.001in
758 \parseargdef\need{%
759 % Ensure vertical mode, so we don't make a big box in the middle of a
760 % paragraph.
761 \par
763 % If the @need value is less than one line space, it's useless.
764 \dimen0 = #1\mil
765 \dimen2 = \ht\strutbox
766 \advance\dimen2 by \dp\strutbox
767 \ifdim\dimen0 > \dimen2
769 % Do a \strut just to make the height of this box be normal, so the
770 % normal leading is inserted relative to the preceding line.
771 % And a page break here is fine.
772 \vtop to #1\mil{\strut\vfil}%
774 % TeX does not even consider page breaks if a penalty added to the
775 % main vertical list is 10000 or more. But in order to see if the
776 % empty box we just added fits on the page, we must make it consider
777 % page breaks. On the other hand, we don't want to actually break the
778 % page after the empty box. So we use a penalty of 9999.
780 % There is an extremely small chance that TeX will actually break the
781 % page at this \penalty, if there are no other feasible breakpoints in
782 % sight. (If the user is using lots of big @group commands, which
783 % almost-but-not-quite fill up a page, TeX will have a hard time doing
784 % good page breaking, for example.) However, I could not construct an
785 % example where a page broke at this \penalty; if it happens in a real
786 % document, then we can reconsider our strategy.
787 \penalty9999
789 % Back up by the size of the box, whether we did a page break or not.
790 \kern -#1\mil
792 % Do not allow a page break right after this kern.
793 \nobreak
797 % @br forces paragraph break (and is undocumented).
799 \let\br = \par
801 % @page forces the start of a new page.
803 \def\page{\par\vfill\supereject}
805 % @exdent text....
806 % outputs text on separate line in roman font, starting at standard page margin
808 % This records the amount of indent in the innermost environment.
809 % That's how much \exdent should take out.
810 \newskip\exdentamount
812 % This defn is used inside fill environments such as @defun.
813 \parseargdef\exdent{\hfil\break\hbox{\kern -\exdentamount{\rm#1}}\hfil\break}
815 % This defn is used inside nofill environments such as @example.
816 \parseargdef\nofillexdent{{\advance \leftskip by -\exdentamount
817 \leftline{\hskip\leftskip{\rm#1}}}}
819 % @inmargin{WHICH}{TEXT} puts TEXT in the WHICH margin next to the current
820 % paragraph. For more general purposes, use the \margin insertion
821 % class. WHICH is `l' or `r'. Not documented, written for gawk manual.
823 \newskip\inmarginspacing \inmarginspacing=1cm
824 \def\strutdepth{\dp\strutbox}
826 \def\doinmargin#1#2{\strut\vadjust{%
827 \nobreak
828 \kern-\strutdepth
829 \vtop to \strutdepth{%
830 \baselineskip=\strutdepth
831 \vss
832 % if you have multiple lines of stuff to put here, you'll need to
833 % make the vbox yourself of the appropriate size.
834 \ifx#1l%
835 \llap{\ignorespaces #2\hskip\inmarginspacing}%
836 \else
837 \rlap{\hskip\hsize \hskip\inmarginspacing \ignorespaces #2}%
839 \null
842 \def\inleftmargin{\doinmargin l}
843 \def\inrightmargin{\doinmargin r}
845 % @inmargin{TEXT [, RIGHT-TEXT]}
846 % (if RIGHT-TEXT is given, use TEXT for left page, RIGHT-TEXT for right;
847 % else use TEXT for both).
849 \def\inmargin#1{\parseinmargin #1,,\finish}
850 \def\parseinmargin#1,#2,#3\finish{% not perfect, but better than nothing.
851 \setbox0 = \hbox{\ignorespaces #2}%
852 \ifdim\wd0 > 0pt
853 \def\lefttext{#1}% have both texts
854 \def\righttext{#2}%
855 \else
856 \def\lefttext{#1}% have only one text
857 \def\righttext{#1}%
860 \ifodd\pageno
861 \def\temp{\inrightmargin\righttext}% odd page -> outside is right margin
862 \else
863 \def\temp{\inleftmargin\lefttext}%
865 \temp
868 % @include FILE -- \input text of FILE.
870 \def\include{\parseargusing\filenamecatcodes\includezzz}
871 \def\includezzz#1{%
872 \pushthisfilestack
873 \def\thisfile{#1}%
875 \makevalueexpandable % we want to expand any @value in FILE.
876 \turnoffactive % and allow special characters in the expansion
877 \indexnofonts % Allow `@@' and other weird things in file names.
878 \wlog{texinfo.tex: doing @include of #1^^J}%
879 \edef\temp{\noexpand\input #1 }%
881 % This trickery is to read FILE outside of a group, in case it makes
882 % definitions, etc.
883 \expandafter
884 }\temp
885 \popthisfilestack
887 \def\filenamecatcodes{%
888 \catcode`\\=\other
889 \catcode`~=\other
890 \catcode`^=\other
891 \catcode`_=\other
892 \catcode`|=\other
893 \catcode`<=\other
894 \catcode`>=\other
895 \catcode`+=\other
896 \catcode`-=\other
897 \catcode`\`=\other
898 \catcode`\'=\other
901 \def\pushthisfilestack{%
902 \expandafter\pushthisfilestackX\popthisfilestack\StackTerm
904 \def\pushthisfilestackX{%
905 \expandafter\pushthisfilestackY\thisfile\StackTerm
907 \def\pushthisfilestackY #1\StackTerm #2\StackTerm {%
908 \gdef\popthisfilestack{\gdef\thisfile{#1}\gdef\popthisfilestack{#2}}%
911 \def\popthisfilestack{\errthisfilestackempty}
912 \def\errthisfilestackempty{\errmessage{Internal error:
913 the stack of filenames is empty.}}
915 \def\thisfile{}
917 % @center line
918 % outputs that line, centered.
920 \parseargdef\center{%
921 \ifhmode
922 \let\centersub\centerH
923 \else
924 \let\centersub\centerV
926 \centersub{\hfil \ignorespaces#1\unskip \hfil}%
927 \let\centersub\relax % don't let the definition persist, just in case
929 \def\centerH#1{{%
930 \hfil\break
931 \advance\hsize by -\leftskip
932 \advance\hsize by -\rightskip
933 \line{#1}%
934 \break
937 \newcount\centerpenalty
938 \def\centerV#1{%
939 % The idea here is the same as in \startdefun, \cartouche, etc.: if
940 % @center is the first thing after a section heading, we need to wipe
941 % out the negative parskip inserted by \sectionheading, but still
942 % prevent a page break here.
943 \centerpenalty = \lastpenalty
944 \ifnum\centerpenalty>10000 \vskip\parskip \fi
945 \ifnum\centerpenalty>9999 \penalty\centerpenalty \fi
946 \line{\kern\leftskip #1\kern\rightskip}%
949 % @sp n outputs n lines of vertical space
951 \parseargdef\sp{\vskip #1\baselineskip}
953 % @comment ...line which is ignored...
954 % @c is the same as @comment
955 % @ignore ... @end ignore is another way to write a comment
958 \def\c{\begingroup \catcode`\^^M=\active%
959 \catcode`\@=\other \catcode`\{=\other \catcode`\}=\other%
960 \cxxx}
961 {\catcode`\^^M=\active \gdef\cxxx#1^^M{\endgroup}}
963 \let\comment\c
965 % @paragraphindent NCHARS
966 % We'll use ems for NCHARS, close enough.
967 % NCHARS can also be the word `asis' or `none'.
968 % We cannot feasibly implement @paragraphindent asis, though.
970 \def\asisword{asis} % no translation, these are keywords
971 \def\noneword{none}
973 \parseargdef\paragraphindent{%
974 \def\temp{#1}%
975 \ifx\temp\asisword
976 \else
977 \ifx\temp\noneword
978 \defaultparindent = 0pt
979 \else
980 \defaultparindent = #1em
983 \parindent = \defaultparindent
986 % @exampleindent NCHARS
987 % We'll use ems for NCHARS like @paragraphindent.
988 % It seems @exampleindent asis isn't necessary, but
989 % I preserve it to make it similar to @paragraphindent.
990 \parseargdef\exampleindent{%
991 \def\temp{#1}%
992 \ifx\temp\asisword
993 \else
994 \ifx\temp\noneword
995 \lispnarrowing = 0pt
996 \else
997 \lispnarrowing = #1em
1002 % @firstparagraphindent WORD
1003 % If WORD is `none', then suppress indentation of the first paragraph
1004 % after a section heading. If WORD is `insert', then do indent at such
1005 % paragraphs.
1007 % The paragraph indentation is suppressed or not by calling
1008 % \suppressfirstparagraphindent, which the sectioning commands do.
1009 % We switch the definition of this back and forth according to WORD.
1010 % By default, we suppress indentation.
1012 \def\suppressfirstparagraphindent{\dosuppressfirstparagraphindent}
1013 \def\insertword{insert}
1015 \parseargdef\firstparagraphindent{%
1016 \def\temp{#1}%
1017 \ifx\temp\noneword
1018 \let\suppressfirstparagraphindent = \dosuppressfirstparagraphindent
1019 \else\ifx\temp\insertword
1020 \let\suppressfirstparagraphindent = \relax
1021 \else
1022 \errhelp = \EMsimple
1023 \errmessage{Unknown @firstparagraphindent option `\temp'}%
1024 \fi\fi
1027 % Here is how we actually suppress indentation. Redefine \everypar to
1028 % \kern backwards by \parindent, and then reset itself to empty.
1030 % We also make \indent itself not actually do anything until the next
1031 % paragraph.
1033 \gdef\dosuppressfirstparagraphindent{%
1034 \gdef\indent {\restorefirstparagraphindent \indent}%
1035 \gdef\noindent{\restorefirstparagraphindent \noindent}%
1036 \global\everypar = {\kern -\parindent \restorefirstparagraphindent}%
1039 \gdef\restorefirstparagraphindent{%
1040 \global\let\indent = \ptexindent
1041 \global\let\noindent = \ptexnoindent
1042 \global\everypar = {}%
1046 % @refill is a no-op.
1047 \let\refill=\relax
1049 % @setfilename INFO-FILENAME - ignored
1050 \let\setfilename=\comment
1052 % @bye.
1053 \outer\def\bye{\pagealignmacro\tracingstats=1\ptexend}
1056 \message{pdf,}
1057 % adobe `portable' document format
1058 \newcount\tempnum
1059 \newcount\lnkcount
1060 \newtoks\filename
1061 \newcount\filenamelength
1062 \newcount\pgn
1063 \newtoks\toksA
1064 \newtoks\toksB
1065 \newtoks\toksC
1066 \newtoks\toksD
1067 \newbox\boxA
1068 \newbox\boxB
1069 \newcount\countA
1070 \newif\ifpdf
1071 \newif\ifpdfmakepagedest
1074 % For LuaTeX
1077 \newif\iftxiuseunicodedestname
1078 \txiuseunicodedestnamefalse % For pdfTeX etc.
1080 \ifx\luatexversion\thisisundefined
1081 \else
1082 % Use Unicode destination names
1083 \txiuseunicodedestnametrue
1084 % Escape PDF strings with converting UTF-16 from UTF-8
1085 \begingroup
1086 \catcode`\%=12
1087 \directlua{
1088 function UTF16oct(str)
1089 tex.sprint(string.char(0x5c) .. '376' .. string.char(0x5c) .. '377')
1090 for c in string.utfvalues(str) do
1091 if c < 0x10000 then
1092 tex.sprint(
1093 string.format(string.char(0x5c) .. string.char(0x25) .. '03o' ..
1094 string.char(0x5c) .. string.char(0x25) .. '03o',
1095 (c / 256), (c % 256)))
1096 else
1097 c = c - 0x10000
1098 local c_hi = c / 1024 + 0xd800
1099 local c_lo = c % 1024 + 0xdc00
1100 tex.sprint(
1101 string.format(string.char(0x5c) .. string.char(0x25) .. '03o' ..
1102 string.char(0x5c) .. string.char(0x25) .. '03o' ..
1103 string.char(0x5c) .. string.char(0x25) .. '03o' ..
1104 string.char(0x5c) .. string.char(0x25) .. '03o',
1105 (c_hi / 256), (c_hi % 256),
1106 (c_lo / 256), (c_lo % 256)))
1111 \endgroup
1112 \def\pdfescapestrutfsixteen#1{\directlua{UTF16oct('\luaescapestring{#1}')}}
1113 % Escape PDF strings without converting
1114 \begingroup
1115 \directlua{
1116 function PDFescstr(str)
1117 for c in string.bytes(str) do
1118 if c <= 0x20 or c >= 0x80 or c == 0x28 or c == 0x29 or c == 0x5c then
1119 tex.sprint(
1120 string.format(string.char(0x5c) .. string.char(0x25) .. '03o',
1122 else
1123 tex.sprint(string.char(c))
1128 \endgroup
1129 \def\pdfescapestring#1{\directlua{PDFescstr('\luaescapestring{#1}')}}
1130 \ifnum\luatexversion>84
1131 % For LuaTeX >= 0.85
1132 \def\pdfdest{\pdfextension dest}
1133 \let\pdfoutput\outputmode
1134 \def\pdfliteral{\pdfextension literal}
1135 \def\pdfcatalog{\pdfextension catalog}
1136 \def\pdftexversion{\numexpr\pdffeedback version\relax}
1137 \let\pdfximage\saveimageresource
1138 \let\pdfrefximage\useimageresource
1139 \let\pdflastximage\lastsavedimageresourceindex
1140 \def\pdfendlink{\pdfextension endlink\relax}
1141 \def\pdfoutline{\pdfextension outline}
1142 \def\pdfstartlink{\pdfextension startlink}
1143 \def\pdffontattr{\pdfextension fontattr}
1144 \def\pdfobj{\pdfextension obj}
1145 \def\pdflastobj{\numexpr\pdffeedback lastobj\relax}
1146 \let\pdfpagewidth\pagewidth
1147 \let\pdfpageheight\pageheight
1148 \edef\pdfhorigin{\pdfvariable horigin}
1149 \edef\pdfvorigin{\pdfvariable vorigin}
1153 % when pdftex is run in dvi mode, \pdfoutput is defined (so \pdfoutput=1
1154 % can be set). So we test for \relax and 0 as well as being undefined.
1155 \ifx\pdfoutput\thisisundefined
1156 \else
1157 \ifx\pdfoutput\relax
1158 \else
1159 \ifcase\pdfoutput
1160 \else
1161 \pdftrue
1166 % PDF uses PostScript string constants for the names of xref targets,
1167 % for display in the outlines, and in other places. Thus, we have to
1168 % double any backslashes. Otherwise, a name like "\node" will be
1169 % interpreted as a newline (\n), followed by o, d, e. Not good.
1171 % See http://www.ntg.nl/pipermail/ntg-pdftex/2004-July/000654.html and
1172 % related messages. The final outcome is that it is up to the TeX user
1173 % to double the backslashes and otherwise make the string valid, so
1174 % that's what we do. pdftex 1.30.0 (ca.2005) introduced a primitive to
1175 % do this reliably, so we use it.
1177 % #1 is a control sequence in which to do the replacements,
1178 % which we \xdef.
1179 \def\txiescapepdf#1{%
1180 \ifx\pdfescapestring\thisisundefined
1181 % No primitive available; should we give a warning or log?
1182 % Many times it won't matter.
1183 \xdef#1{#1}%
1184 \else
1185 % The expandable \pdfescapestring primitive escapes parentheses,
1186 % backslashes, and other special chars.
1187 \xdef#1{\pdfescapestring{#1}}%
1190 \def\txiescapepdfutfsixteen#1{%
1191 \ifx\pdfescapestrutfsixteen\thisisundefined
1192 % No UTF-16 converting macro available.
1193 \txiescapepdf{#1}%
1194 \else
1195 \xdef#1{\pdfescapestrutfsixteen{#1}}%
1199 \newhelp\nopdfimagehelp{Texinfo supports .png, .jpg, .jpeg, and .pdf images
1200 with PDF output, and none of those formats could be found. (.eps cannot
1201 be supported due to the design of the PDF format; use regular TeX (DVI
1202 output) for that.)}
1204 \ifpdf
1206 % Color manipulation macros using ideas from pdfcolor.tex,
1207 % except using rgb instead of cmyk; the latter is said to render as a
1208 % very dark gray on-screen and a very dark halftone in print, instead
1209 % of actual black. The dark red here is dark enough to print on paper as
1210 % nearly black, but still distinguishable for online viewing. We use
1211 % black by default, though.
1212 \def\rgbDarkRed{0.50 0.09 0.12}
1213 \def\rgbBlack{0 0 0}
1215 % rg sets the color for filling (usual text, etc.);
1216 % RG sets the color for stroking (thin rules, e.g., normal _'s).
1217 \def\pdfsetcolor#1{\pdfliteral{#1 rg #1 RG}}
1219 % Set color, and create a mark which defines \thiscolor accordingly,
1220 % so that \makeheadline knows which color to restore.
1221 \def\setcolor#1{%
1222 \xdef\lastcolordefs{\gdef\noexpand\thiscolor{#1}}%
1223 \domark
1224 \pdfsetcolor{#1}%
1227 \def\maincolor{\rgbBlack}
1228 \pdfsetcolor{\maincolor}
1229 \edef\thiscolor{\maincolor}
1230 \def\lastcolordefs{}
1232 \def\makefootline{%
1233 \baselineskip24pt
1234 \line{\pdfsetcolor{\maincolor}\the\footline}%
1237 \def\makeheadline{%
1238 \vbox to 0pt{%
1239 \vskip-22.5pt
1240 \line{%
1241 \vbox to8.5pt{}%
1242 % Extract \thiscolor definition from the marks.
1243 \getcolormarks
1244 % Typeset the headline with \maincolor, then restore the color.
1245 \pdfsetcolor{\maincolor}\the\headline\pdfsetcolor{\thiscolor}%
1247 \vss
1249 \nointerlineskip
1253 \pdfcatalog{/PageMode /UseOutlines}
1255 % #1 is image name, #2 width (might be empty/whitespace), #3 height (ditto).
1256 \def\dopdfimage#1#2#3{%
1257 \def\pdfimagewidth{#2}\setbox0 = \hbox{\ignorespaces #2}%
1258 \def\pdfimageheight{#3}\setbox2 = \hbox{\ignorespaces #3}%
1260 % pdftex (and the PDF format) support .pdf, .png, .jpg (among
1261 % others). Let's try in that order, PDF first since if
1262 % someone has a scalable image, presumably better to use that than a
1263 % bitmap.
1264 \let\pdfimgext=\empty
1265 \begingroup
1266 \openin 1 #1.pdf \ifeof 1
1267 \openin 1 #1.PDF \ifeof 1
1268 \openin 1 #1.png \ifeof 1
1269 \openin 1 #1.jpg \ifeof 1
1270 \openin 1 #1.jpeg \ifeof 1
1271 \openin 1 #1.JPG \ifeof 1
1272 \errhelp = \nopdfimagehelp
1273 \errmessage{Could not find image file #1 for pdf}%
1274 \else \gdef\pdfimgext{JPG}%
1276 \else \gdef\pdfimgext{jpeg}%
1278 \else \gdef\pdfimgext{jpg}%
1280 \else \gdef\pdfimgext{png}%
1282 \else \gdef\pdfimgext{PDF}%
1284 \else \gdef\pdfimgext{pdf}%
1286 \closein 1
1287 \endgroup
1289 % without \immediate, ancient pdftex seg faults when the same image is
1290 % included twice. (Version 3.14159-pre-1.0-unofficial-20010704.)
1291 \ifnum\pdftexversion < 14
1292 \immediate\pdfimage
1293 \else
1294 \immediate\pdfximage
1296 \ifdim \wd0 >0pt width \pdfimagewidth \fi
1297 \ifdim \wd2 >0pt height \pdfimageheight \fi
1298 \ifnum\pdftexversion<13
1299 #1.\pdfimgext
1300 \else
1301 {#1.\pdfimgext}%
1303 \ifnum\pdftexversion < 14 \else
1304 \pdfrefximage \pdflastximage
1305 \fi}
1307 \def\setpdfdestname#1{{%
1308 % We have to set dummies so commands such as @code, and characters
1309 % such as \, aren't expanded when present in a section title.
1310 \indexnofonts
1311 \makevalueexpandable
1312 \turnoffactive
1313 \iftxiuseunicodedestname
1314 \ifx \declaredencoding \latone
1315 % Pass through Latin-1 characters.
1316 % LuaTeX with byte wise I/O converts Latin-1 characters to Unicode.
1317 \else
1318 \ifx \declaredencoding \utfeight
1319 % Pass through Unicode characters.
1320 \else
1321 % Use ASCII approximations in destination names.
1322 \passthroughcharsfalse
1325 \else
1326 % Use ASCII approximations in destination names.
1327 \passthroughcharsfalse
1329 \def\pdfdestname{#1}%
1330 \txiescapepdf\pdfdestname
1333 \def\setpdfoutlinetext#1{{%
1334 \indexnofonts
1335 \makevalueexpandable
1336 \turnoffactive
1337 \ifx \declaredencoding \latone
1338 % The PDF format can use an extended form of Latin-1 in bookmark
1339 % strings. See Appendix D of the PDF Reference, Sixth Edition, for
1340 % the "PDFDocEncoding".
1341 \passthroughcharstrue
1342 % Pass through Latin-1 characters.
1343 % LuaTeX: Convert to Unicode
1344 % pdfTeX: Use Latin-1 as PDFDocEncoding
1345 \def\pdfoutlinetext{#1}%
1346 \else
1347 \ifx \declaredencoding \utfeight
1348 \ifx\luatexversion\thisisundefined
1349 % For pdfTeX with UTF-8.
1350 % TODO: the PDF format can use UTF-16 in bookmark strings,
1351 % but the code for this isn't done yet.
1352 % Use ASCII approximations.
1353 \passthroughcharsfalse
1354 \def\pdfoutlinetext{#1}%
1355 \else
1356 % For LuaTeX with UTF-8.
1357 % Pass through Unicode characters for title texts.
1358 \passthroughcharstrue
1359 \def\pdfoutlinetext{#1}%
1361 \else
1362 % For non-Latin-1 or non-UTF-8 encodings.
1363 % Use ASCII approximations.
1364 \passthroughcharsfalse
1365 \def\pdfoutlinetext{#1}%
1368 % LuaTeX: Convert to UTF-16
1369 % pdfTeX: Use Latin-1 as PDFDocEncoding
1370 \txiescapepdfutfsixteen\pdfoutlinetext
1373 \def\pdfmkdest#1{%
1374 \setpdfdestname{#1}%
1375 \safewhatsit{\pdfdest name{\pdfdestname} xyz}%
1378 % used to mark target names; must be expandable.
1379 \def\pdfmkpgn#1{#1}
1381 % by default, use black for everything.
1382 \def\urlcolor{\rgbBlack}
1383 \def\linkcolor{\rgbBlack}
1384 \def\endlink{\setcolor{\maincolor}\pdfendlink}
1386 % Adding outlines to PDF; macros for calculating structure of outlines
1387 % come from Petr Olsak
1388 \def\expnumber#1{\expandafter\ifx\csname#1\endcsname\relax 0%
1389 \else \csname#1\endcsname \fi}
1390 \def\advancenumber#1{\tempnum=\expnumber{#1}\relax
1391 \advance\tempnum by 1
1392 \expandafter\xdef\csname#1\endcsname{\the\tempnum}}
1394 % #1 is the section text, which is what will be displayed in the
1395 % outline by the pdf viewer. #2 is the pdf expression for the number
1396 % of subentries (or empty, for subsubsections). #3 is the node text,
1397 % which might be empty if this toc entry had no corresponding node.
1398 % #4 is the page number
1400 \def\dopdfoutline#1#2#3#4{%
1401 % Generate a link to the node text if that exists; else, use the
1402 % page number. We could generate a destination for the section
1403 % text in the case where a section has no node, but it doesn't
1404 % seem worth the trouble, since most documents are normally structured.
1405 \setpdfoutlinetext{#1}
1406 \setpdfdestname{#3}
1407 \ifx\pdfdestname\empty
1408 \def\pdfdestname{#4}%
1411 \pdfoutline goto name{\pdfmkpgn{\pdfdestname}}#2{\pdfoutlinetext}%
1414 \def\pdfmakeoutlines{%
1415 \begingroup
1416 % Read toc silently, to get counts of subentries for \pdfoutline.
1417 \def\partentry##1##2##3##4{}% ignore parts in the outlines
1418 \def\numchapentry##1##2##3##4{%
1419 \def\thischapnum{##2}%
1420 \def\thissecnum{0}%
1421 \def\thissubsecnum{0}%
1423 \def\numsecentry##1##2##3##4{%
1424 \advancenumber{chap\thischapnum}%
1425 \def\thissecnum{##2}%
1426 \def\thissubsecnum{0}%
1428 \def\numsubsecentry##1##2##3##4{%
1429 \advancenumber{sec\thissecnum}%
1430 \def\thissubsecnum{##2}%
1432 \def\numsubsubsecentry##1##2##3##4{%
1433 \advancenumber{subsec\thissubsecnum}%
1435 \def\thischapnum{0}%
1436 \def\thissecnum{0}%
1437 \def\thissubsecnum{0}%
1439 % use \def rather than \let here because we redefine \chapentry et
1440 % al. a second time, below.
1441 \def\appentry{\numchapentry}%
1442 \def\appsecentry{\numsecentry}%
1443 \def\appsubsecentry{\numsubsecentry}%
1444 \def\appsubsubsecentry{\numsubsubsecentry}%
1445 \def\unnchapentry{\numchapentry}%
1446 \def\unnsecentry{\numsecentry}%
1447 \def\unnsubsecentry{\numsubsecentry}%
1448 \def\unnsubsubsecentry{\numsubsubsecentry}%
1449 \readdatafile{toc}%
1451 % Read toc second time, this time actually producing the outlines.
1452 % The `-' means take the \expnumber as the absolute number of
1453 % subentries, which we calculated on our first read of the .toc above.
1455 % We use the node names as the destinations.
1456 \def\numchapentry##1##2##3##4{%
1457 \dopdfoutline{##1}{count-\expnumber{chap##2}}{##3}{##4}}%
1458 \def\numsecentry##1##2##3##4{%
1459 \dopdfoutline{##1}{count-\expnumber{sec##2}}{##3}{##4}}%
1460 \def\numsubsecentry##1##2##3##4{%
1461 \dopdfoutline{##1}{count-\expnumber{subsec##2}}{##3}{##4}}%
1462 \def\numsubsubsecentry##1##2##3##4{% count is always zero
1463 \dopdfoutline{##1}{}{##3}{##4}}%
1465 % PDF outlines are displayed using system fonts, instead of
1466 % document fonts. Therefore we cannot use special characters,
1467 % since the encoding is unknown. For example, the eogonek from
1468 % Latin 2 (0xea) gets translated to a | character. Info from
1469 % Staszek Wawrykiewicz, 19 Jan 2004 04:09:24 +0100.
1471 % TODO this right, we have to translate 8-bit characters to
1472 % their "best" equivalent, based on the @documentencoding. Too
1473 % much work for too little return. Just use the ASCII equivalents
1474 % we use for the index sort strings.
1476 \indexnofonts
1477 \setupdatafile
1478 % We can have normal brace characters in the PDF outlines, unlike
1479 % Texinfo index files. So set that up.
1480 \def\{{\lbracecharliteral}%
1481 \def\}{\rbracecharliteral}%
1482 \catcode`\\=\active \otherbackslash
1483 \input \tocreadfilename
1484 \endgroup
1486 {\catcode`[=1 \catcode`]=2
1487 \catcode`{=\other \catcode`}=\other
1488 \gdef\lbracecharliteral[{]%
1489 \gdef\rbracecharliteral[}]%
1492 \def\skipspaces#1{\def\PP{#1}\def\D{|}%
1493 \ifx\PP\D\let\nextsp\relax
1494 \else\let\nextsp\skipspaces
1495 \addtokens{\filename}{\PP}%
1496 \advance\filenamelength by 1
1498 \nextsp}
1499 \def\getfilename#1{%
1500 \filenamelength=0
1501 % If we don't expand the argument now, \skipspaces will get
1502 % snagged on things like "@value{foo}".
1503 \edef\temp{#1}%
1504 \expandafter\skipspaces\temp|\relax
1506 \ifnum\pdftexversion < 14
1507 \let \startlink \pdfannotlink
1508 \else
1509 \let \startlink \pdfstartlink
1511 % make a live url in pdf output.
1512 \def\pdfurl#1{%
1513 \begingroup
1514 % it seems we really need yet another set of dummies; have not
1515 % tried to figure out what each command should do in the context
1516 % of @url. for now, just make @/ a no-op, that's the only one
1517 % people have actually reported a problem with.
1519 \normalturnoffactive
1520 \def\@{@}%
1521 \let\/=\empty
1522 \makevalueexpandable
1523 % do we want to go so far as to use \indexnofonts instead of just
1524 % special-casing \var here?
1525 \def\var##1{##1}%
1527 \leavevmode\setcolor{\urlcolor}%
1528 \startlink attr{/Border [0 0 0]}%
1529 user{/Subtype /Link /A << /S /URI /URI (#1) >>}%
1530 \endgroup}
1531 \def\pdfgettoks#1.{\setbox\boxA=\hbox{\toksA={#1.}\toksB={}\maketoks}}
1532 \def\addtokens#1#2{\edef\addtoks{\noexpand#1={\the#1#2}}\addtoks}
1533 \def\adn#1{\addtokens{\toksC}{#1}\global\countA=1\let\next=\maketoks}
1534 \def\poptoks#1#2|ENDTOKS|{\let\first=#1\toksD={#1}\toksA={#2}}
1535 \def\maketoks{%
1536 \expandafter\poptoks\the\toksA|ENDTOKS|\relax
1537 \ifx\first0\adn0
1538 \else\ifx\first1\adn1 \else\ifx\first2\adn2 \else\ifx\first3\adn3
1539 \else\ifx\first4\adn4 \else\ifx\first5\adn5 \else\ifx\first6\adn6
1540 \else\ifx\first7\adn7 \else\ifx\first8\adn8 \else\ifx\first9\adn9
1541 \else
1542 \ifnum0=\countA\else\makelink\fi
1543 \ifx\first.\let\next=\done\else
1544 \let\next=\maketoks
1545 \addtokens{\toksB}{\the\toksD}
1546 \ifx\first,\addtokens{\toksB}{\space}\fi
1548 \fi\fi\fi\fi\fi\fi\fi\fi\fi\fi
1549 \next}
1550 \def\makelink{\addtokens{\toksB}%
1551 {\noexpand\pdflink{\the\toksC}}\toksC={}\global\countA=0}
1552 \def\pdflink#1{%
1553 \startlink attr{/Border [0 0 0]} goto name{\pdfmkpgn{#1}}
1554 \setcolor{\linkcolor}#1\endlink}
1555 \def\done{\edef\st{\global\noexpand\toksA={\the\toksB}}\st}
1556 \else
1557 % non-pdf mode
1558 \let\pdfmkdest = \gobble
1559 \let\pdfurl = \gobble
1560 \let\endlink = \relax
1561 \let\setcolor = \gobble
1562 \let\pdfsetcolor = \gobble
1563 \let\pdfmakeoutlines = \relax
1564 \fi % \ifx\pdfoutput
1567 % For XeTeX
1569 \ifx\XeTeXrevision\thisisundefined
1570 \else
1572 % XeTeX version check
1574 \ifnum\strcmp{\the\XeTeXversion\XeTeXrevision}{0.99996}>-1
1575 % TeX Live 2016 contains XeTeX 0.99996 and xdvipdfmx 20160307.
1576 % It can use the `dvipdfmx:config' special (from TeX Live SVN r40941).
1577 % For avoiding PDF destination name replacement, we use this special
1578 % instead of xdvipdfmx's command line option `-C 0x0010'.
1579 \special{dvipdfmx:config C 0x0010}
1580 % XeTeX 0.99995+ comes with xdvipdfmx 20160307+.
1581 % It can handle Unicode destination names for PDF.
1582 \txiuseunicodedestnametrue
1583 \else
1584 % XeTeX < 0.99996 (TeX Live < 2016) cannot use the
1585 % `dvipdfmx:config' special.
1586 % So for avoiding PDF destination name replacement,
1587 % xdvipdfmx's command line option `-C 0x0010' is necessary.
1589 % XeTeX < 0.99995 can not handle Unicode destination names for PDF
1590 % because xdvipdfmx 20150315 has a UTF-16 conversion issue.
1591 % It is fixed by xdvipdfmx 20160106 (TeX Live SVN r39753).
1592 \txiuseunicodedestnamefalse
1595 % Color support
1597 \def\rgbDarkRed{0.50 0.09 0.12}
1598 \def\rgbBlack{0 0 0}
1600 \def\pdfsetcolor#1{\special{pdf:scolor [#1]}}
1602 % Set color, and create a mark which defines \thiscolor accordingly,
1603 % so that \makeheadline knows which color to restore.
1604 \def\setcolor#1{%
1605 \xdef\lastcolordefs{\gdef\noexpand\thiscolor{#1}}%
1606 \domark
1607 \pdfsetcolor{#1}%
1610 \def\maincolor{\rgbBlack}
1611 \pdfsetcolor{\maincolor}
1612 \edef\thiscolor{\maincolor}
1613 \def\lastcolordefs{}
1615 \def\makefootline{%
1616 \baselineskip24pt
1617 \line{\pdfsetcolor{\maincolor}\the\footline}%
1620 \def\makeheadline{%
1621 \vbox to 0pt{%
1622 \vskip-22.5pt
1623 \line{%
1624 \vbox to8.5pt{}%
1625 % Extract \thiscolor definition from the marks.
1626 \getcolormarks
1627 % Typeset the headline with \maincolor, then restore the color.
1628 \pdfsetcolor{\maincolor}\the\headline\pdfsetcolor{\thiscolor}%
1630 \vss
1632 \nointerlineskip
1635 % PDF outline support
1637 % Emulate pdfTeX primitive
1638 \def\pdfdest name#1 xyz{%
1639 \special{pdf:dest (#1) [@thispage /XYZ @xpos @ypos null]}%
1642 \def\setpdfdestname#1{{%
1643 % We have to set dummies so commands such as @code, and characters
1644 % such as \, aren't expanded when present in a section title.
1645 \indexnofonts
1646 \makevalueexpandable
1647 \turnoffactive
1648 \iftxiuseunicodedestname
1649 % Pass through Unicode characters.
1650 \else
1651 % Use ASCII approximations in destination names.
1652 \passthroughcharsfalse
1654 \def\pdfdestname{#1}%
1655 \txiescapepdf\pdfdestname
1658 \def\setpdfoutlinetext#1{{%
1659 \turnoffactive
1660 % Always use Unicode characters in title texts.
1661 \def\pdfoutlinetext{#1}%
1662 % For XeTeX, xdvipdfmx converts to UTF-16.
1663 % So we do not convert.
1664 \txiescapepdf\pdfoutlinetext
1667 \def\pdfmkdest#1{%
1668 \setpdfdestname{#1}%
1669 \safewhatsit{\pdfdest name{\pdfdestname} xyz}%
1672 % by default, use black for everything.
1673 \def\urlcolor{\rgbBlack}
1674 \def\linkcolor{\rgbBlack}
1675 \def\endlink{\setcolor{\maincolor}\pdfendlink}
1677 \def\dopdfoutline#1#2#3#4{%
1678 \setpdfoutlinetext{#1}
1679 \setpdfdestname{#3}
1680 \ifx\pdfdestname\empty
1681 \def\pdfdestname{#4}%
1684 \special{pdf:out [-] #2 << /Title (\pdfoutlinetext) /A
1685 << /S /GoTo /D (\pdfdestname) >> >> }%
1688 \def\pdfmakeoutlines{%
1689 \begingroup
1691 % For XeTeX, counts of subentries are not necessary.
1692 % Therefore, we read toc only once.
1694 % We use node names as destinations.
1695 \def\partentry##1##2##3##4{}% ignore parts in the outlines
1696 \def\numchapentry##1##2##3##4{%
1697 \dopdfoutline{##1}{1}{##3}{##4}}%
1698 \def\numsecentry##1##2##3##4{%
1699 \dopdfoutline{##1}{2}{##3}{##4}}%
1700 \def\numsubsecentry##1##2##3##4{%
1701 \dopdfoutline{##1}{3}{##3}{##4}}%
1702 \def\numsubsubsecentry##1##2##3##4{%
1703 \dopdfoutline{##1}{4}{##3}{##4}}%
1705 \let\appentry\numchapentry%
1706 \let\appsecentry\numsecentry%
1707 \let\appsubsecentry\numsubsecentry%
1708 \let\appsubsubsecentry\numsubsubsecentry%
1709 \let\unnchapentry\numchapentry%
1710 \let\unnsecentry\numsecentry%
1711 \let\unnsubsecentry\numsubsecentry%
1712 \let\unnsubsubsecentry\numsubsubsecentry%
1714 % For XeTeX, xdvipdfmx converts strings to UTF-16.
1715 % Therefore, the encoding and the language may not be considered.
1717 \indexnofonts
1718 \setupdatafile
1719 % We can have normal brace characters in the PDF outlines, unlike
1720 % Texinfo index files. So set that up.
1721 \def\{{\lbracecharliteral}%
1722 \def\}{\rbracecharliteral}%
1723 \catcode`\\=\active \otherbackslash
1724 \input \tocreadfilename
1725 \endgroup
1727 {\catcode`[=1 \catcode`]=2
1728 \catcode`{=\other \catcode`}=\other
1729 \gdef\lbracecharliteral[{]%
1730 \gdef\rbracecharliteral[}]%
1733 \special{pdf:docview << /PageMode /UseOutlines >> }
1734 % ``\special{pdf:tounicode ...}'' is not necessary
1735 % because xdvipdfmx converts strings from UTF-8 to UTF-16 without it.
1736 % However, due to a UTF-16 conversion issue of xdvipdfmx 20150315,
1737 % ``\special{pdf:dest ...}'' cannot handle non-ASCII strings.
1738 % It is fixed by xdvipdfmx 20160106 (TeX Live SVN r39753).
1740 \def\skipspaces#1{\def\PP{#1}\def\D{|}%
1741 \ifx\PP\D\let\nextsp\relax
1742 \else\let\nextsp\skipspaces
1743 \addtokens{\filename}{\PP}%
1744 \advance\filenamelength by 1
1746 \nextsp}
1747 \def\getfilename#1{%
1748 \filenamelength=0
1749 % If we don't expand the argument now, \skipspaces will get
1750 % snagged on things like "@value{foo}".
1751 \edef\temp{#1}%
1752 \expandafter\skipspaces\temp|\relax
1754 % make a live url in pdf output.
1755 \def\pdfurl#1{%
1756 \begingroup
1757 % it seems we really need yet another set of dummies; have not
1758 % tried to figure out what each command should do in the context
1759 % of @url. for now, just make @/ a no-op, that's the only one
1760 % people have actually reported a problem with.
1762 \normalturnoffactive
1763 \def\@{@}%
1764 \let\/=\empty
1765 \makevalueexpandable
1766 % do we want to go so far as to use \indexnofonts instead of just
1767 % special-casing \var here?
1768 \def\var##1{##1}%
1770 \leavevmode\setcolor{\urlcolor}%
1771 \special{pdf:bann << /Border [0 0 0]
1772 /Subtype /Link /A << /S /URI /URI (#1) >> >>}%
1773 \endgroup}
1774 \def\endlink{\setcolor{\maincolor}\special{pdf:eann}}
1775 \def\pdfgettoks#1.{\setbox\boxA=\hbox{\toksA={#1.}\toksB={}\maketoks}}
1776 \def\addtokens#1#2{\edef\addtoks{\noexpand#1={\the#1#2}}\addtoks}
1777 \def\adn#1{\addtokens{\toksC}{#1}\global\countA=1\let\next=\maketoks}
1778 \def\poptoks#1#2|ENDTOKS|{\let\first=#1\toksD={#1}\toksA={#2}}
1779 \def\maketoks{%
1780 \expandafter\poptoks\the\toksA|ENDTOKS|\relax
1781 \ifx\first0\adn0
1782 \else\ifx\first1\adn1 \else\ifx\first2\adn2 \else\ifx\first3\adn3
1783 \else\ifx\first4\adn4 \else\ifx\first5\adn5 \else\ifx\first6\adn6
1784 \else\ifx\first7\adn7 \else\ifx\first8\adn8 \else\ifx\first9\adn9
1785 \else
1786 \ifnum0=\countA\else\makelink\fi
1787 \ifx\first.\let\next=\done\else
1788 \let\next=\maketoks
1789 \addtokens{\toksB}{\the\toksD}
1790 \ifx\first,\addtokens{\toksB}{\space}\fi
1792 \fi\fi\fi\fi\fi\fi\fi\fi\fi\fi
1793 \next}
1794 \def\makelink{\addtokens{\toksB}%
1795 {\noexpand\pdflink{\the\toksC}}\toksC={}\global\countA=0}
1796 \def\pdflink#1{%
1797 \special{pdf:bann << /Border [0 0 0]
1798 /Type /Annot /Subtype /Link /A << /S /GoTo /D (#1) >> >>}%
1799 \setcolor{\linkcolor}#1\endlink}
1800 \def\done{\edef\st{\global\noexpand\toksA={\the\toksB}}\st}
1803 % @image support
1805 % #1 is image name, #2 width (might be empty/whitespace), #3 height (ditto).
1806 \def\doxeteximage#1#2#3{%
1807 \def\xeteximagewidth{#2}\setbox0 = \hbox{\ignorespaces #2}%
1808 \def\xeteximageheight{#3}\setbox2 = \hbox{\ignorespaces #3}%
1810 % XeTeX (and the PDF format) supports .pdf, .png, .jpg (among
1811 % others). Let's try in that order, PDF first since if
1812 % someone has a scalable image, presumably better to use that than a
1813 % bitmap.
1814 \let\xeteximgext=\empty
1815 \begingroup
1816 \openin 1 #1.pdf \ifeof 1
1817 \openin 1 #1.PDF \ifeof 1
1818 \openin 1 #1.png \ifeof 1
1819 \openin 1 #1.jpg \ifeof 1
1820 \openin 1 #1.jpeg \ifeof 1
1821 \openin 1 #1.JPG \ifeof 1
1822 \errmessage{Could not find image file #1 for XeTeX}%
1823 \else \gdef\xeteximgext{JPG}%
1825 \else \gdef\xeteximgext{jpeg}%
1827 \else \gdef\xeteximgext{jpg}%
1829 \else \gdef\xeteximgext{png}%
1831 \else \gdef\xeteximgext{PDF}%
1833 \else \gdef\xeteximgext{pdf}%
1835 \closein 1
1836 \endgroup
1838 \def\xetexpdfext{pdf}%
1839 \ifx\xeteximgext\xetexpdfext
1840 \XeTeXpdffile "#1".\xeteximgext ""
1841 \else
1842 \def\xetexpdfext{PDF}%
1843 \ifx\xeteximgext\xetexpdfext
1844 \XeTeXpdffile "#1".\xeteximgext ""
1845 \else
1846 \XeTeXpicfile "#1".\xeteximgext ""
1849 \ifdim \wd0 >0pt width \xeteximagewidth \fi
1850 \ifdim \wd2 >0pt height \xeteximageheight \fi \relax
1856 \message{fonts,}
1858 % Set the baselineskip to #1, and the lineskip and strut size
1859 % correspondingly. There is no deep meaning behind these magic numbers
1860 % used as factors; they just match (closely enough) what Knuth defined.
1862 \def\lineskipfactor{.08333}
1863 \def\strutheightpercent{.70833}
1864 \def\strutdepthpercent {.29167}
1866 % can get a sort of poor man's double spacing by redefining this.
1867 \def\baselinefactor{1}
1869 \newdimen\textleading
1870 \def\setleading#1{%
1871 \dimen0 = #1\relax
1872 \normalbaselineskip = \baselinefactor\dimen0
1873 \normallineskip = \lineskipfactor\normalbaselineskip
1874 \normalbaselines
1875 \setbox\strutbox =\hbox{%
1876 \vrule width0pt height\strutheightpercent\baselineskip
1877 depth \strutdepthpercent \baselineskip
1881 % PDF CMaps. See also LaTeX's t1.cmap.
1883 % do nothing with this by default.
1884 \expandafter\let\csname cmapOT1\endcsname\gobble
1885 \expandafter\let\csname cmapOT1IT\endcsname\gobble
1886 \expandafter\let\csname cmapOT1TT\endcsname\gobble
1888 % if we are producing pdf, and we have \pdffontattr, then define cmaps.
1889 % (\pdffontattr was introduced many years ago, but people still run
1890 % older pdftex's; it's easy to conditionalize, so we do.)
1891 \ifpdf \ifx\pdffontattr\thisisundefined \else
1892 \begingroup
1893 \catcode`\^^M=\active \def^^M{^^J}% Output line endings as the ^^J char.
1894 \catcode`\%=12 \immediate\pdfobj stream {%!PS-Adobe-3.0 Resource-CMap
1895 %%DocumentNeededResources: ProcSet (CIDInit)
1896 %%IncludeResource: ProcSet (CIDInit)
1897 %%BeginResource: CMap (TeX-OT1-0)
1898 %%Title: (TeX-OT1-0 TeX OT1 0)
1899 %%Version: 1.000
1900 %%EndComments
1901 /CIDInit /ProcSet findresource begin
1902 12 dict begin
1903 begincmap
1904 /CIDSystemInfo
1905 << /Registry (TeX)
1906 /Ordering (OT1)
1907 /Supplement 0
1908 >> def
1909 /CMapName /TeX-OT1-0 def
1910 /CMapType 2 def
1911 1 begincodespacerange
1912 <00> <7F>
1913 endcodespacerange
1914 8 beginbfrange
1915 <00> <01> <0393>
1916 <09> <0A> <03A8>
1917 <23> <26> <0023>
1918 <28> <3B> <0028>
1919 <3F> <5B> <003F>
1920 <5D> <5E> <005D>
1921 <61> <7A> <0061>
1922 <7B> <7C> <2013>
1923 endbfrange
1924 40 beginbfchar
1925 <02> <0398>
1926 <03> <039B>
1927 <04> <039E>
1928 <05> <03A0>
1929 <06> <03A3>
1930 <07> <03D2>
1931 <08> <03A6>
1932 <0B> <00660066>
1933 <0C> <00660069>
1934 <0D> <0066006C>
1935 <0E> <006600660069>
1936 <0F> <00660066006C>
1937 <10> <0131>
1938 <11> <0237>
1939 <12> <0060>
1940 <13> <00B4>
1941 <14> <02C7>
1942 <15> <02D8>
1943 <16> <00AF>
1944 <17> <02DA>
1945 <18> <00B8>
1946 <19> <00DF>
1947 <1A> <00E6>
1948 <1B> <0153>
1949 <1C> <00F8>
1950 <1D> <00C6>
1951 <1E> <0152>
1952 <1F> <00D8>
1953 <21> <0021>
1954 <22> <201D>
1955 <27> <2019>
1956 <3C> <00A1>
1957 <3D> <003D>
1958 <3E> <00BF>
1959 <5C> <201C>
1960 <5F> <02D9>
1961 <60> <2018>
1962 <7D> <02DD>
1963 <7E> <007E>
1964 <7F> <00A8>
1965 endbfchar
1966 endcmap
1967 CMapName currentdict /CMap defineresource pop
1970 %%EndResource
1971 %%EOF
1972 }\endgroup
1973 \expandafter\edef\csname cmapOT1\endcsname#1{%
1974 \pdffontattr#1{/ToUnicode \the\pdflastobj\space 0 R}%
1977 % \cmapOT1IT
1978 \begingroup
1979 \catcode`\^^M=\active \def^^M{^^J}% Output line endings as the ^^J char.
1980 \catcode`\%=12 \immediate\pdfobj stream {%!PS-Adobe-3.0 Resource-CMap
1981 %%DocumentNeededResources: ProcSet (CIDInit)
1982 %%IncludeResource: ProcSet (CIDInit)
1983 %%BeginResource: CMap (TeX-OT1IT-0)
1984 %%Title: (TeX-OT1IT-0 TeX OT1IT 0)
1985 %%Version: 1.000
1986 %%EndComments
1987 /CIDInit /ProcSet findresource begin
1988 12 dict begin
1989 begincmap
1990 /CIDSystemInfo
1991 << /Registry (TeX)
1992 /Ordering (OT1IT)
1993 /Supplement 0
1994 >> def
1995 /CMapName /TeX-OT1IT-0 def
1996 /CMapType 2 def
1997 1 begincodespacerange
1998 <00> <7F>
1999 endcodespacerange
2000 8 beginbfrange
2001 <00> <01> <0393>
2002 <09> <0A> <03A8>
2003 <25> <26> <0025>
2004 <28> <3B> <0028>
2005 <3F> <5B> <003F>
2006 <5D> <5E> <005D>
2007 <61> <7A> <0061>
2008 <7B> <7C> <2013>
2009 endbfrange
2010 42 beginbfchar
2011 <02> <0398>
2012 <03> <039B>
2013 <04> <039E>
2014 <05> <03A0>
2015 <06> <03A3>
2016 <07> <03D2>
2017 <08> <03A6>
2018 <0B> <00660066>
2019 <0C> <00660069>
2020 <0D> <0066006C>
2021 <0E> <006600660069>
2022 <0F> <00660066006C>
2023 <10> <0131>
2024 <11> <0237>
2025 <12> <0060>
2026 <13> <00B4>
2027 <14> <02C7>
2028 <15> <02D8>
2029 <16> <00AF>
2030 <17> <02DA>
2031 <18> <00B8>
2032 <19> <00DF>
2033 <1A> <00E6>
2034 <1B> <0153>
2035 <1C> <00F8>
2036 <1D> <00C6>
2037 <1E> <0152>
2038 <1F> <00D8>
2039 <21> <0021>
2040 <22> <201D>
2041 <23> <0023>
2042 <24> <00A3>
2043 <27> <2019>
2044 <3C> <00A1>
2045 <3D> <003D>
2046 <3E> <00BF>
2047 <5C> <201C>
2048 <5F> <02D9>
2049 <60> <2018>
2050 <7D> <02DD>
2051 <7E> <007E>
2052 <7F> <00A8>
2053 endbfchar
2054 endcmap
2055 CMapName currentdict /CMap defineresource pop
2058 %%EndResource
2059 %%EOF
2060 }\endgroup
2061 \expandafter\edef\csname cmapOT1IT\endcsname#1{%
2062 \pdffontattr#1{/ToUnicode \the\pdflastobj\space 0 R}%
2065 % \cmapOT1TT
2066 \begingroup
2067 \catcode`\^^M=\active \def^^M{^^J}% Output line endings as the ^^J char.
2068 \catcode`\%=12 \immediate\pdfobj stream {%!PS-Adobe-3.0 Resource-CMap
2069 %%DocumentNeededResources: ProcSet (CIDInit)
2070 %%IncludeResource: ProcSet (CIDInit)
2071 %%BeginResource: CMap (TeX-OT1TT-0)
2072 %%Title: (TeX-OT1TT-0 TeX OT1TT 0)
2073 %%Version: 1.000
2074 %%EndComments
2075 /CIDInit /ProcSet findresource begin
2076 12 dict begin
2077 begincmap
2078 /CIDSystemInfo
2079 << /Registry (TeX)
2080 /Ordering (OT1TT)
2081 /Supplement 0
2082 >> def
2083 /CMapName /TeX-OT1TT-0 def
2084 /CMapType 2 def
2085 1 begincodespacerange
2086 <00> <7F>
2087 endcodespacerange
2088 5 beginbfrange
2089 <00> <01> <0393>
2090 <09> <0A> <03A8>
2091 <21> <26> <0021>
2092 <28> <5F> <0028>
2093 <61> <7E> <0061>
2094 endbfrange
2095 32 beginbfchar
2096 <02> <0398>
2097 <03> <039B>
2098 <04> <039E>
2099 <05> <03A0>
2100 <06> <03A3>
2101 <07> <03D2>
2102 <08> <03A6>
2103 <0B> <2191>
2104 <0C> <2193>
2105 <0D> <0027>
2106 <0E> <00A1>
2107 <0F> <00BF>
2108 <10> <0131>
2109 <11> <0237>
2110 <12> <0060>
2111 <13> <00B4>
2112 <14> <02C7>
2113 <15> <02D8>
2114 <16> <00AF>
2115 <17> <02DA>
2116 <18> <00B8>
2117 <19> <00DF>
2118 <1A> <00E6>
2119 <1B> <0153>
2120 <1C> <00F8>
2121 <1D> <00C6>
2122 <1E> <0152>
2123 <1F> <00D8>
2124 <20> <2423>
2125 <27> <2019>
2126 <60> <2018>
2127 <7F> <00A8>
2128 endbfchar
2129 endcmap
2130 CMapName currentdict /CMap defineresource pop
2133 %%EndResource
2134 %%EOF
2135 }\endgroup
2136 \expandafter\edef\csname cmapOT1TT\endcsname#1{%
2137 \pdffontattr#1{/ToUnicode \the\pdflastobj\space 0 R}%
2139 \fi\fi
2142 % Set the font macro #1 to the font named \fontprefix#2.
2143 % #3 is the font's design size, #4 is a scale factor, #5 is the CMap
2144 % encoding (only OT1, OT1IT and OT1TT are allowed, or empty to omit).
2145 % Example:
2146 % #1 = \textrm
2147 % #2 = \rmshape
2148 % #3 = 10
2149 % #4 = \mainmagstep
2150 % #5 = OT1
2152 \def\setfont#1#2#3#4#5{%
2153 \font#1=\fontprefix#2#3 scaled #4
2154 \csname cmap#5\endcsname#1%
2156 % This is what gets called when #5 of \setfont is empty.
2157 \let\cmap\gobble
2159 % (end of cmaps)
2161 % Use cm as the default font prefix.
2162 % To specify the font prefix, you must define \fontprefix
2163 % before you read in texinfo.tex.
2164 \ifx\fontprefix\thisisundefined
2165 \def\fontprefix{cm}
2167 % Support font families that don't use the same naming scheme as CM.
2168 \def\rmshape{r}
2169 \def\rmbshape{bx} % where the normal face is bold
2170 \def\bfshape{b}
2171 \def\bxshape{bx}
2172 \def\ttshape{tt}
2173 \def\ttbshape{tt}
2174 \def\ttslshape{sltt}
2175 \def\itshape{ti}
2176 \def\itbshape{bxti}
2177 \def\slshape{sl}
2178 \def\slbshape{bxsl}
2179 \def\sfshape{ss}
2180 \def\sfbshape{ss}
2181 \def\scshape{csc}
2182 \def\scbshape{csc}
2184 % Definitions for a main text size of 11pt. (The default in Texinfo.)
2186 \def\definetextfontsizexi{%
2187 % Text fonts (11.2pt, magstep1).
2188 \def\textnominalsize{11pt}
2189 \edef\mainmagstep{\magstephalf}
2190 \setfont\textrm\rmshape{10}{\mainmagstep}{OT1}
2191 \setfont\texttt\ttshape{10}{\mainmagstep}{OT1TT}
2192 \setfont\textbf\bfshape{10}{\mainmagstep}{OT1}
2193 \setfont\textit\itshape{10}{\mainmagstep}{OT1IT}
2194 \setfont\textsl\slshape{10}{\mainmagstep}{OT1}
2195 \setfont\textsf\sfshape{10}{\mainmagstep}{OT1}
2196 \setfont\textsc\scshape{10}{\mainmagstep}{OT1}
2197 \setfont\textttsl\ttslshape{10}{\mainmagstep}{OT1TT}
2198 \font\texti=cmmi10 scaled \mainmagstep
2199 \font\textsy=cmsy10 scaled \mainmagstep
2200 \def\textecsize{1095}
2202 % A few fonts for @defun names and args.
2203 \setfont\defbf\bfshape{10}{\magstep1}{OT1}
2204 \setfont\deftt\ttshape{10}{\magstep1}{OT1TT}
2205 \setfont\defsl\slshape{10}{\magstep1}{OT1TT}
2206 \setfont\defttsl\ttslshape{10}{\magstep1}{OT1TT}
2207 \def\df{\let\ttfont=\deftt \let\bffont = \defbf
2208 \let\ttslfont=\defttsl \let\slfont=\defsl \bf}
2210 % Fonts for indices, footnotes, small examples (9pt).
2211 \def\smallnominalsize{9pt}
2212 \setfont\smallrm\rmshape{9}{1000}{OT1}
2213 \setfont\smalltt\ttshape{9}{1000}{OT1TT}
2214 \setfont\smallbf\bfshape{10}{900}{OT1}
2215 \setfont\smallit\itshape{9}{1000}{OT1IT}
2216 \setfont\smallsl\slshape{9}{1000}{OT1}
2217 \setfont\smallsf\sfshape{9}{1000}{OT1}
2218 \setfont\smallsc\scshape{10}{900}{OT1}
2219 \setfont\smallttsl\ttslshape{10}{900}{OT1TT}
2220 \font\smalli=cmmi9
2221 \font\smallsy=cmsy9
2222 \def\smallecsize{0900}
2224 % Fonts for small examples (8pt).
2225 \def\smallernominalsize{8pt}
2226 \setfont\smallerrm\rmshape{8}{1000}{OT1}
2227 \setfont\smallertt\ttshape{8}{1000}{OT1TT}
2228 \setfont\smallerbf\bfshape{10}{800}{OT1}
2229 \setfont\smallerit\itshape{8}{1000}{OT1IT}
2230 \setfont\smallersl\slshape{8}{1000}{OT1}
2231 \setfont\smallersf\sfshape{8}{1000}{OT1}
2232 \setfont\smallersc\scshape{10}{800}{OT1}
2233 \setfont\smallerttsl\ttslshape{10}{800}{OT1TT}
2234 \font\smalleri=cmmi8
2235 \font\smallersy=cmsy8
2236 \def\smallerecsize{0800}
2238 % Fonts for title page (20.4pt):
2239 \def\titlenominalsize{20pt}
2240 \setfont\titlerm\rmbshape{12}{\magstep3}{OT1}
2241 \setfont\titleit\itbshape{10}{\magstep4}{OT1IT}
2242 \setfont\titlesl\slbshape{10}{\magstep4}{OT1}
2243 \setfont\titlett\ttbshape{12}{\magstep3}{OT1TT}
2244 \setfont\titlettsl\ttslshape{10}{\magstep4}{OT1TT}
2245 \setfont\titlesf\sfbshape{17}{\magstep1}{OT1}
2246 \let\titlebf=\titlerm
2247 \setfont\titlesc\scbshape{10}{\magstep4}{OT1}
2248 \font\titlei=cmmi12 scaled \magstep3
2249 \font\titlesy=cmsy10 scaled \magstep4
2250 \def\titleecsize{2074}
2252 % Chapter (and unnumbered) fonts (17.28pt).
2253 \def\chapnominalsize{17pt}
2254 \setfont\chaprm\rmbshape{12}{\magstep2}{OT1}
2255 \setfont\chapit\itbshape{10}{\magstep3}{OT1IT}
2256 \setfont\chapsl\slbshape{10}{\magstep3}{OT1}
2257 \setfont\chaptt\ttbshape{12}{\magstep2}{OT1TT}
2258 \setfont\chapttsl\ttslshape{10}{\magstep3}{OT1TT}
2259 \setfont\chapsf\sfbshape{17}{1000}{OT1}
2260 \let\chapbf=\chaprm
2261 \setfont\chapsc\scbshape{10}{\magstep3}{OT1}
2262 \font\chapi=cmmi12 scaled \magstep2
2263 \font\chapsy=cmsy10 scaled \magstep3
2264 \def\chapecsize{1728}
2266 % Section fonts (14.4pt).
2267 \def\secnominalsize{14pt}
2268 \setfont\secrm\rmbshape{12}{\magstep1}{OT1}
2269 \setfont\secrmnotbold\rmshape{12}{\magstep1}{OT1}
2270 \setfont\secit\itbshape{10}{\magstep2}{OT1IT}
2271 \setfont\secsl\slbshape{10}{\magstep2}{OT1}
2272 \setfont\sectt\ttbshape{12}{\magstep1}{OT1TT}
2273 \setfont\secttsl\ttslshape{10}{\magstep2}{OT1TT}
2274 \setfont\secsf\sfbshape{12}{\magstep1}{OT1}
2275 \let\secbf\secrm
2276 \setfont\secsc\scbshape{10}{\magstep2}{OT1}
2277 \font\seci=cmmi12 scaled \magstep1
2278 \font\secsy=cmsy10 scaled \magstep2
2279 \def\sececsize{1440}
2281 % Subsection fonts (13.15pt).
2282 \def\ssecnominalsize{13pt}
2283 \setfont\ssecrm\rmbshape{12}{\magstephalf}{OT1}
2284 \setfont\ssecit\itbshape{10}{1315}{OT1IT}
2285 \setfont\ssecsl\slbshape{10}{1315}{OT1}
2286 \setfont\ssectt\ttbshape{12}{\magstephalf}{OT1TT}
2287 \setfont\ssecttsl\ttslshape{10}{1315}{OT1TT}
2288 \setfont\ssecsf\sfbshape{12}{\magstephalf}{OT1}
2289 \let\ssecbf\ssecrm
2290 \setfont\ssecsc\scbshape{10}{1315}{OT1}
2291 \font\sseci=cmmi12 scaled \magstephalf
2292 \font\ssecsy=cmsy10 scaled 1315
2293 \def\ssececsize{1200}
2295 % Reduced fonts for @acronym in text (10pt).
2296 \def\reducednominalsize{10pt}
2297 \setfont\reducedrm\rmshape{10}{1000}{OT1}
2298 \setfont\reducedtt\ttshape{10}{1000}{OT1TT}
2299 \setfont\reducedbf\bfshape{10}{1000}{OT1}
2300 \setfont\reducedit\itshape{10}{1000}{OT1IT}
2301 \setfont\reducedsl\slshape{10}{1000}{OT1}
2302 \setfont\reducedsf\sfshape{10}{1000}{OT1}
2303 \setfont\reducedsc\scshape{10}{1000}{OT1}
2304 \setfont\reducedttsl\ttslshape{10}{1000}{OT1TT}
2305 \font\reducedi=cmmi10
2306 \font\reducedsy=cmsy10
2307 \def\reducedecsize{1000}
2309 \textleading = 13.2pt % line spacing for 11pt CM
2310 \textfonts % reset the current fonts
2312 } % end of 11pt text font size definitions, \definetextfontsizexi
2315 % Definitions to make the main text be 10pt Computer Modern, with
2316 % section, chapter, etc., sizes following suit. This is for the GNU
2317 % Press printing of the Emacs 22 manual. Maybe other manuals in the
2318 % future. Used with @smallbook, which sets the leading to 12pt.
2320 \def\definetextfontsizex{%
2321 % Text fonts (10pt).
2322 \def\textnominalsize{10pt}
2323 \edef\mainmagstep{1000}
2324 \setfont\textrm\rmshape{10}{\mainmagstep}{OT1}
2325 \setfont\texttt\ttshape{10}{\mainmagstep}{OT1TT}
2326 \setfont\textbf\bfshape{10}{\mainmagstep}{OT1}
2327 \setfont\textit\itshape{10}{\mainmagstep}{OT1IT}
2328 \setfont\textsl\slshape{10}{\mainmagstep}{OT1}
2329 \setfont\textsf\sfshape{10}{\mainmagstep}{OT1}
2330 \setfont\textsc\scshape{10}{\mainmagstep}{OT1}
2331 \setfont\textttsl\ttslshape{10}{\mainmagstep}{OT1TT}
2332 \font\texti=cmmi10 scaled \mainmagstep
2333 \font\textsy=cmsy10 scaled \mainmagstep
2334 \def\textecsize{1000}
2336 % A few fonts for @defun names and args.
2337 \setfont\defbf\bfshape{10}{\magstephalf}{OT1}
2338 \setfont\deftt\ttshape{10}{\magstephalf}{OT1TT}
2339 \setfont\defsl\slshape{10}{\magstephalf}{OT1TT}
2340 \setfont\defttsl\ttslshape{10}{\magstephalf}{OT1TT}
2341 \def\df{\let\ttfont=\deftt \let\bffont = \defbf
2342 \let\slfont=\defsl \let\ttslfont=\defttsl \bf}
2344 % Fonts for indices, footnotes, small examples (9pt).
2345 \def\smallnominalsize{9pt}
2346 \setfont\smallrm\rmshape{9}{1000}{OT1}
2347 \setfont\smalltt\ttshape{9}{1000}{OT1TT}
2348 \setfont\smallbf\bfshape{10}{900}{OT1}
2349 \setfont\smallit\itshape{9}{1000}{OT1IT}
2350 \setfont\smallsl\slshape{9}{1000}{OT1}
2351 \setfont\smallsf\sfshape{9}{1000}{OT1}
2352 \setfont\smallsc\scshape{10}{900}{OT1}
2353 \setfont\smallttsl\ttslshape{10}{900}{OT1TT}
2354 \font\smalli=cmmi9
2355 \font\smallsy=cmsy9
2356 \def\smallecsize{0900}
2358 % Fonts for small examples (8pt).
2359 \def\smallernominalsize{8pt}
2360 \setfont\smallerrm\rmshape{8}{1000}{OT1}
2361 \setfont\smallertt\ttshape{8}{1000}{OT1TT}
2362 \setfont\smallerbf\bfshape{10}{800}{OT1}
2363 \setfont\smallerit\itshape{8}{1000}{OT1IT}
2364 \setfont\smallersl\slshape{8}{1000}{OT1}
2365 \setfont\smallersf\sfshape{8}{1000}{OT1}
2366 \setfont\smallersc\scshape{10}{800}{OT1}
2367 \setfont\smallerttsl\ttslshape{10}{800}{OT1TT}
2368 \font\smalleri=cmmi8
2369 \font\smallersy=cmsy8
2370 \def\smallerecsize{0800}
2372 % Fonts for title page (20.4pt):
2373 \def\titlenominalsize{20pt}
2374 \setfont\titlerm\rmbshape{12}{\magstep3}{OT1}
2375 \setfont\titleit\itbshape{10}{\magstep4}{OT1IT}
2376 \setfont\titlesl\slbshape{10}{\magstep4}{OT1}
2377 \setfont\titlett\ttbshape{12}{\magstep3}{OT1TT}
2378 \setfont\titlettsl\ttslshape{10}{\magstep4}{OT1TT}
2379 \setfont\titlesf\sfbshape{17}{\magstep1}{OT1}
2380 \let\titlebf=\titlerm
2381 \setfont\titlesc\scbshape{10}{\magstep4}{OT1}
2382 \font\titlei=cmmi12 scaled \magstep3
2383 \font\titlesy=cmsy10 scaled \magstep4
2384 \def\titleecsize{2074}
2386 % Chapter fonts (14.4pt).
2387 \def\chapnominalsize{14pt}
2388 \setfont\chaprm\rmbshape{12}{\magstep1}{OT1}
2389 \setfont\chapit\itbshape{10}{\magstep2}{OT1IT}
2390 \setfont\chapsl\slbshape{10}{\magstep2}{OT1}
2391 \setfont\chaptt\ttbshape{12}{\magstep1}{OT1TT}
2392 \setfont\chapttsl\ttslshape{10}{\magstep2}{OT1TT}
2393 \setfont\chapsf\sfbshape{12}{\magstep1}{OT1}
2394 \let\chapbf\chaprm
2395 \setfont\chapsc\scbshape{10}{\magstep2}{OT1}
2396 \font\chapi=cmmi12 scaled \magstep1
2397 \font\chapsy=cmsy10 scaled \magstep2
2398 \def\chapecsize{1440}
2400 % Section fonts (12pt).
2401 \def\secnominalsize{12pt}
2402 \setfont\secrm\rmbshape{12}{1000}{OT1}
2403 \setfont\secit\itbshape{10}{\magstep1}{OT1IT}
2404 \setfont\secsl\slbshape{10}{\magstep1}{OT1}
2405 \setfont\sectt\ttbshape{12}{1000}{OT1TT}
2406 \setfont\secttsl\ttslshape{10}{\magstep1}{OT1TT}
2407 \setfont\secsf\sfbshape{12}{1000}{OT1}
2408 \let\secbf\secrm
2409 \setfont\secsc\scbshape{10}{\magstep1}{OT1}
2410 \font\seci=cmmi12
2411 \font\secsy=cmsy10 scaled \magstep1
2412 \def\sececsize{1200}
2414 % Subsection fonts (10pt).
2415 \def\ssecnominalsize{10pt}
2416 \setfont\ssecrm\rmbshape{10}{1000}{OT1}
2417 \setfont\ssecit\itbshape{10}{1000}{OT1IT}
2418 \setfont\ssecsl\slbshape{10}{1000}{OT1}
2419 \setfont\ssectt\ttbshape{10}{1000}{OT1TT}
2420 \setfont\ssecttsl\ttslshape{10}{1000}{OT1TT}
2421 \setfont\ssecsf\sfbshape{10}{1000}{OT1}
2422 \let\ssecbf\ssecrm
2423 \setfont\ssecsc\scbshape{10}{1000}{OT1}
2424 \font\sseci=cmmi10
2425 \font\ssecsy=cmsy10
2426 \def\ssececsize{1000}
2428 % Reduced fonts for @acronym in text (9pt).
2429 \def\reducednominalsize{9pt}
2430 \setfont\reducedrm\rmshape{9}{1000}{OT1}
2431 \setfont\reducedtt\ttshape{9}{1000}{OT1TT}
2432 \setfont\reducedbf\bfshape{10}{900}{OT1}
2433 \setfont\reducedit\itshape{9}{1000}{OT1IT}
2434 \setfont\reducedsl\slshape{9}{1000}{OT1}
2435 \setfont\reducedsf\sfshape{9}{1000}{OT1}
2436 \setfont\reducedsc\scshape{10}{900}{OT1}
2437 \setfont\reducedttsl\ttslshape{10}{900}{OT1TT}
2438 \font\reducedi=cmmi9
2439 \font\reducedsy=cmsy9
2440 \def\reducedecsize{0900}
2442 \divide\parskip by 2 % reduce space between paragraphs
2443 \textleading = 12pt % line spacing for 10pt CM
2444 \textfonts % reset the current fonts
2446 } % end of 10pt text font size definitions, \definetextfontsizex
2448 % Fonts for short table of contents.
2449 \setfont\shortcontrm\rmshape{12}{1000}{OT1}
2450 \setfont\shortcontbf\bfshape{10}{\magstep1}{OT1} % no cmb12
2451 \setfont\shortcontsl\slshape{12}{1000}{OT1}
2452 \setfont\shortconttt\ttshape{12}{1000}{OT1TT}
2455 % We provide the user-level command
2456 % @fonttextsize 10
2457 % (or 11) to redefine the text font size. pt is assumed.
2459 \def\xiword{11}
2460 \def\xword{10}
2461 \def\xwordpt{10pt}
2463 \parseargdef\fonttextsize{%
2464 \def\textsizearg{#1}%
2465 %\wlog{doing @fonttextsize \textsizearg}%
2467 % Set \globaldefs so that documents can use this inside @tex, since
2468 % makeinfo 4.8 does not support it, but we need it nonetheless.
2470 \begingroup \globaldefs=1
2471 \ifx\textsizearg\xword \definetextfontsizex
2472 \else \ifx\textsizearg\xiword \definetextfontsizexi
2473 \else
2474 \errhelp=\EMsimple
2475 \errmessage{@fonttextsize only supports `10' or `11', not `\textsizearg'}
2476 \fi\fi
2477 \endgroup
2481 % Change the current font style to #1, remembering it in \curfontstyle.
2482 % For now, we do not accumulate font styles: @b{@i{foo}} prints foo in
2483 % italics, not bold italics.
2485 \def\setfontstyle#1{%
2486 \def\curfontstyle{#1}% not as a control sequence, because we are \edef'd.
2487 \csname #1font\endcsname % change the current font
2490 \def\rm{\fam=0 \setfontstyle{rm}}
2491 \def\it{\fam=\itfam \setfontstyle{it}}
2492 \def\sl{\fam=\slfam \setfontstyle{sl}}
2493 \def\bf{\fam=\bffam \setfontstyle{bf}}\def\bfstylename{bf}
2494 \def\tt{\fam=\ttfam \setfontstyle{tt}}
2496 % Texinfo sort of supports the sans serif font style, which plain TeX does not.
2497 % So we set up a \sf.
2498 \newfam\sffam
2499 \def\sf{\fam=\sffam \setfontstyle{sf}}
2501 % We don't need math for this font style.
2502 \def\ttsl{\setfontstyle{ttsl}}
2505 % In order for the font changes to affect most math symbols and letters,
2506 % we have to define the \textfont of the standard families. We don't
2507 % bother to reset \scriptfont and \scriptscriptfont; awaiting user need.
2509 \def\resetmathfonts{%
2510 \textfont0=\rmfont \textfont1=\ifont \textfont2=\syfont
2511 \textfont\itfam=\itfont \textfont\slfam=\slfont \textfont\bffam=\bffont
2512 \textfont\ttfam=\ttfont \textfont\sffam=\sffont
2517 % The font-changing commands (all called \...fonts) redefine the meanings
2518 % of \STYLEfont, instead of just \STYLE. We do this because \STYLE needs
2519 % to also set the current \fam for math mode. Our \STYLE (e.g., \rm)
2520 % commands hardwire \STYLEfont to set the current font.
2522 % Each font-changing command also sets the names \lsize (one size lower)
2523 % and \lllsize (three sizes lower). These relative commands are used
2524 % in, e.g., the LaTeX logo and acronyms.
2526 % This all needs generalizing, badly.
2529 \def\assignfonts#1{%
2530 \expandafter\let\expandafter\rmfont\csname #1rm\endcsname
2531 \expandafter\let\expandafter\itfont\csname #1it\endcsname
2532 \expandafter\let\expandafter\slfont\csname #1sl\endcsname
2533 \expandafter\let\expandafter\bffont\csname #1bf\endcsname
2534 \expandafter\let\expandafter\ttfont\csname #1tt\endcsname
2535 \expandafter\let\expandafter\smallcaps\csname #1sc\endcsname
2536 \expandafter\let\expandafter\sffont \csname #1sf\endcsname
2537 \expandafter\let\expandafter\ifont \csname #1i\endcsname
2538 \expandafter\let\expandafter\syfont \csname #1sy\endcsname
2539 \expandafter\let\expandafter\ttslfont\csname #1ttsl\endcsname
2542 \newif\ifrmisbold
2544 % Select smaller font size with the current style. Used to change font size
2545 % in, e.g., the LaTeX logo and acronyms. If we are using bold fonts for
2546 % normal roman text, also use bold fonts for roman text in the smaller size.
2547 \def\switchtolllsize{%
2548 \expandafter\assignfonts\expandafter{\lllsize}%
2549 \ifrmisbold
2550 \let\rmfont\bffont
2552 \csname\curfontstyle\endcsname
2555 \def\switchtolsize{%
2556 \expandafter\assignfonts\expandafter{\lsize}%
2557 \ifrmisbold
2558 \let\rmfont\bffont
2560 \csname\curfontstyle\endcsname
2563 \def\definefontsetatsize#1#2#3#4#5{%
2564 \expandafter\def\csname #1fonts\endcsname{%
2565 \def\curfontsize{#1}%
2566 \def\lsize{#2}\def\lllsize{#3}%
2567 \csname rmisbold#5\endcsname
2568 \assignfonts{#1}%
2569 \resetmathfonts
2570 \setleading{#4}%
2573 \definefontsetatsize{text} {reduced}{smaller}{\textleading}{false}
2574 \definefontsetatsize{title} {chap} {subsec} {27pt} {true}
2575 \definefontsetatsize{chap} {sec} {text} {19pt} {true}
2576 \definefontsetatsize{sec} {subsec} {reduced}{17pt} {true}
2577 \definefontsetatsize{ssec} {text} {small} {15pt} {true}
2578 \definefontsetatsize{reduced}{small} {smaller}{10.5pt}{false}
2579 \definefontsetatsize{small} {smaller}{smaller}{10.5pt}{false}
2580 \definefontsetatsize{smaller}{smaller}{smaller}{9.5pt} {false}
2582 \def\titlefont#1{{\titlefonts\rm #1}}
2583 \let\subsecfonts = \ssecfonts
2584 \let\subsubsecfonts = \ssecfonts
2586 % Define these just so they can be easily changed for other fonts.
2587 \def\angleleft{$\langle$}
2588 \def\angleright{$\rangle$}
2590 % Set the fonts to use with the @small... environments.
2591 \let\smallexamplefonts = \smallfonts
2593 % About \smallexamplefonts. If we use \smallfonts (9pt), @smallexample
2594 % can fit this many characters:
2595 % 8.5x11=86 smallbook=72 a4=90 a5=69
2596 % If we use \scriptfonts (8pt), then we can fit this many characters:
2597 % 8.5x11=90+ smallbook=80 a4=90+ a5=77
2598 % For me, subjectively, the few extra characters that fit aren't worth
2599 % the additional smallness of 8pt. So I'm making the default 9pt.
2601 % By the way, for comparison, here's what fits with @example (10pt):
2602 % 8.5x11=71 smallbook=60 a4=75 a5=58
2603 % --karl, 24jan03.
2605 % Set up the default fonts, so we can use them for creating boxes.
2607 \definetextfontsizexi
2610 \message{markup,}
2612 % Check if we are currently using a typewriter font. Since all the
2613 % Computer Modern typewriter fonts have zero interword stretch (and
2614 % shrink), and it is reasonable to expect all typewriter fonts to have
2615 % this property, we can check that font parameter.
2617 \def\ifmonospace{\ifdim\fontdimen3\font=0pt }
2619 % Markup style infrastructure. \defmarkupstylesetup\INITMACRO will
2620 % define and register \INITMACRO to be called on markup style changes.
2621 % \INITMACRO can check \currentmarkupstyle for the innermost
2622 % style and the set of \ifmarkupSTYLE switches for all styles
2623 % currently in effect.
2624 \newif\ifmarkupvar
2625 \newif\ifmarkupsamp
2626 \newif\ifmarkupkey
2627 %\newif\ifmarkupfile % @file == @samp.
2628 %\newif\ifmarkupoption % @option == @samp.
2629 \newif\ifmarkupcode
2630 \newif\ifmarkupkbd
2631 %\newif\ifmarkupenv % @env == @code.
2632 %\newif\ifmarkupcommand % @command == @code.
2633 \newif\ifmarkuptex % @tex (and part of @math, for now).
2634 \newif\ifmarkupexample
2635 \newif\ifmarkupverb
2636 \newif\ifmarkupverbatim
2638 \let\currentmarkupstyle\empty
2640 \def\setupmarkupstyle#1{%
2641 \csname markup#1true\endcsname
2642 \def\currentmarkupstyle{#1}%
2643 \markupstylesetup
2646 \let\markupstylesetup\empty
2648 \def\defmarkupstylesetup#1{%
2649 \expandafter\def\expandafter\markupstylesetup
2650 \expandafter{\markupstylesetup #1}%
2651 \def#1%
2654 % Markup style setup for left and right quotes.
2655 \defmarkupstylesetup\markupsetuplq{%
2656 \expandafter\let\expandafter \temp
2657 \csname markupsetuplq\currentmarkupstyle\endcsname
2658 \ifx\temp\relax \markupsetuplqdefault \else \temp \fi
2661 \defmarkupstylesetup\markupsetuprq{%
2662 \expandafter\let\expandafter \temp
2663 \csname markupsetuprq\currentmarkupstyle\endcsname
2664 \ifx\temp\relax \markupsetuprqdefault \else \temp \fi
2668 \catcode`\'=\active
2669 \catcode`\`=\active
2671 \gdef\markupsetuplqdefault{\let`\lq}
2672 \gdef\markupsetuprqdefault{\let'\rq}
2674 \gdef\markupsetcodequoteleft{\let`\codequoteleft}
2675 \gdef\markupsetcodequoteright{\let'\codequoteright}
2678 \let\markupsetuplqcode \markupsetcodequoteleft
2679 \let\markupsetuprqcode \markupsetcodequoteright
2681 \let\markupsetuplqexample \markupsetcodequoteleft
2682 \let\markupsetuprqexample \markupsetcodequoteright
2684 \let\markupsetuplqkbd \markupsetcodequoteleft
2685 \let\markupsetuprqkbd \markupsetcodequoteright
2687 \let\markupsetuplqsamp \markupsetcodequoteleft
2688 \let\markupsetuprqsamp \markupsetcodequoteright
2690 \let\markupsetuplqverb \markupsetcodequoteleft
2691 \let\markupsetuprqverb \markupsetcodequoteright
2693 \let\markupsetuplqverbatim \markupsetcodequoteleft
2694 \let\markupsetuprqverbatim \markupsetcodequoteright
2696 % Allow an option to not use regular directed right quote/apostrophe
2697 % (char 0x27), but instead the undirected quote from cmtt (char 0x0d).
2698 % The undirected quote is ugly, so don't make it the default, but it
2699 % works for pasting with more pdf viewers (at least evince), the
2700 % lilypond developers report. xpdf does work with the regular 0x27.
2702 \def\codequoteright{%
2703 \expandafter\ifx\csname SETtxicodequoteundirected\endcsname\relax
2704 \expandafter\ifx\csname SETcodequoteundirected\endcsname\relax
2706 \else \char'15 \fi
2707 \else \char'15 \fi
2710 % and a similar option for the left quote char vs. a grave accent.
2711 % Modern fonts display ASCII 0x60 as a grave accent, so some people like
2712 % the code environments to do likewise.
2714 \def\codequoteleft{%
2715 \expandafter\ifx\csname SETtxicodequotebacktick\endcsname\relax
2716 \expandafter\ifx\csname SETcodequotebacktick\endcsname\relax
2717 % [Knuth] pp. 380,381,391
2718 % \relax disables Spanish ligatures ?` and !` of \tt font.
2719 \relax`%
2720 \else \char'22 \fi
2721 \else \char'22 \fi
2724 % Commands to set the quote options.
2726 \parseargdef\codequoteundirected{%
2727 \def\temp{#1}%
2728 \ifx\temp\onword
2729 \expandafter\let\csname SETtxicodequoteundirected\endcsname
2730 = t%
2731 \else\ifx\temp\offword
2732 \expandafter\let\csname SETtxicodequoteundirected\endcsname
2733 = \relax
2734 \else
2735 \errhelp = \EMsimple
2736 \errmessage{Unknown @codequoteundirected value `\temp', must be on|off}%
2737 \fi\fi
2740 \parseargdef\codequotebacktick{%
2741 \def\temp{#1}%
2742 \ifx\temp\onword
2743 \expandafter\let\csname SETtxicodequotebacktick\endcsname
2744 = t%
2745 \else\ifx\temp\offword
2746 \expandafter\let\csname SETtxicodequotebacktick\endcsname
2747 = \relax
2748 \else
2749 \errhelp = \EMsimple
2750 \errmessage{Unknown @codequotebacktick value `\temp', must be on|off}%
2751 \fi\fi
2754 % [Knuth] pp. 380,381,391, disable Spanish ligatures ?` and !` of \tt font.
2755 \def\noligaturesquoteleft{\relax\lq}
2757 % Count depth in font-changes, for error checks
2758 \newcount\fontdepth \fontdepth=0
2760 % Font commands.
2762 % #1 is the font command (\sl or \it), #2 is the text to slant.
2763 % If we are in a monospaced environment, however, 1) always use \ttsl,
2764 % and 2) do not add an italic correction.
2765 \def\dosmartslant#1#2{%
2766 \ifusingtt
2767 {{\ttsl #2}\let\next=\relax}%
2768 {\def\next{{#1#2}\futurelet\next\smartitaliccorrection}}%
2769 \next
2771 \def\smartslanted{\dosmartslant\sl}
2772 \def\smartitalic{\dosmartslant\it}
2774 % Output an italic correction unless \next (presumed to be the following
2775 % character) is such as not to need one.
2776 \def\smartitaliccorrection{%
2777 \ifx\next,%
2778 \else\ifx\next-%
2779 \else\ifx\next.%
2780 \else\ifx\next\.%
2781 \else\ifx\next\comma%
2782 \else\ptexslash
2783 \fi\fi\fi\fi\fi
2784 \aftersmartic
2787 % Unconditional use \ttsl, and no ic. @var is set to this for defuns.
2788 \def\ttslanted#1{{\ttsl #1}}
2790 % @cite is like \smartslanted except unconditionally use \sl. We never want
2791 % ttsl for book titles, do we?
2792 \def\cite#1{{\sl #1}\futurelet\next\smartitaliccorrection}
2794 \def\aftersmartic{}
2795 \def\var#1{%
2796 \let\saveaftersmartic = \aftersmartic
2797 \def\aftersmartic{\null\let\aftersmartic=\saveaftersmartic}%
2798 \smartslanted{#1}%
2801 \let\i=\smartitalic
2802 \let\slanted=\smartslanted
2803 \let\dfn=\smartslanted
2804 \let\emph=\smartitalic
2806 % Explicit font changes: @r, @sc, undocumented @ii.
2807 \def\r#1{{\rm #1}} % roman font
2808 \def\sc#1{{\smallcaps#1}} % smallcaps font
2809 \def\ii#1{{\it #1}} % italic font
2811 % @b, explicit bold. Also @strong.
2812 \def\b#1{{\bf #1}}
2813 \let\strong=\b
2815 % @sansserif, explicit sans.
2816 \def\sansserif#1{{\sf #1}}
2818 % We can't just use \exhyphenpenalty, because that only has effect at
2819 % the end of a paragraph. Restore normal hyphenation at the end of the
2820 % group within which \nohyphenation is presumably called.
2822 \def\nohyphenation{\hyphenchar\font = -1 \aftergroup\restorehyphenation}
2823 \def\restorehyphenation{\hyphenchar\font = `- }
2825 % Set sfcode to normal for the chars that usually have another value.
2826 % Can't use plain's \frenchspacing because it uses the `\x notation, and
2827 % sometimes \x has an active definition that messes things up.
2829 \catcode`@=11
2830 \def\plainfrenchspacing{%
2831 \sfcode`\.=\@m \sfcode`\?=\@m \sfcode`\!=\@m
2832 \sfcode`\:=\@m \sfcode`\;=\@m \sfcode`\,=\@m
2833 \def\endofsentencespacefactor{1000}% for @. and friends
2835 \def\plainnonfrenchspacing{%
2836 \sfcode`\.3000\sfcode`\?3000\sfcode`\!3000
2837 \sfcode`\:2000\sfcode`\;1500\sfcode`\,1250
2838 \def\endofsentencespacefactor{3000}% for @. and friends
2840 \catcode`@=\other
2841 \def\endofsentencespacefactor{3000}% default
2843 % @t, explicit typewriter.
2844 \def\t#1{%
2845 {\tt \rawbackslash \plainfrenchspacing #1}%
2846 \null
2849 % @samp.
2850 \def\samp#1{{\setupmarkupstyle{samp}\lq\tclose{#1}\rq\null}}
2852 % @indicateurl is \samp, that is, with quotes.
2853 \let\indicateurl=\samp
2855 % @code (and similar) prints in typewriter, but with spaces the same
2856 % size as normal in the surrounding text, without hyphenation, etc.
2857 % This is a subroutine for that.
2858 \def\tclose#1{%
2860 % Change normal interword space to be same as for the current font.
2861 \spaceskip = \fontdimen2\font
2863 % Switch to typewriter.
2866 % But `\ ' produces the large typewriter interword space.
2867 \def\ {{\spaceskip = 0pt{} }}%
2869 % Turn off hyphenation.
2870 \nohyphenation
2872 \rawbackslash
2873 \plainfrenchspacing
2876 \null % reset spacefactor to 1000
2879 % We *must* turn on hyphenation at `-' and `_' in @code.
2880 % (But see \codedashfinish below.)
2881 % Otherwise, it is too hard to avoid overfull hboxes
2882 % in the Emacs manual, the Library manual, etc.
2884 % Unfortunately, TeX uses one parameter (\hyphenchar) to control
2885 % both hyphenation at - and hyphenation within words.
2886 % We must therefore turn them both off (\tclose does that)
2887 % and arrange explicitly to hyphenate at a dash. -- rms.
2889 \catcode`\-=\active \catcode`\_=\active
2890 \catcode`\'=\active \catcode`\`=\active
2891 \global\let'=\rq \global\let`=\lq % default definitions
2893 \global\def\code{\begingroup
2894 \setupmarkupstyle{code}%
2895 % The following should really be moved into \setupmarkupstyle handlers.
2896 \catcode\dashChar=\active \catcode\underChar=\active
2897 \ifallowcodebreaks
2898 \let-\codedash
2899 \let_\codeunder
2900 \else
2901 \let-\normaldash
2902 \let_\realunder
2904 % Given -foo (with a single dash), we do not want to allow a break
2905 % after the hyphen.
2906 \global\let\codedashprev=\codedash
2908 \codex
2911 \gdef\codedash{\futurelet\next\codedashfinish}
2912 \gdef\codedashfinish{%
2913 \normaldash % always output the dash character itself.
2915 % Now, output a discretionary to allow a line break, unless
2916 % (a) the next character is a -, or
2917 % (b) the preceding character is a -.
2918 % E.g., given --posix, we do not want to allow a break after either -.
2919 % Given --foo-bar, we do want to allow a break between the - and the b.
2920 \ifx\next\codedash \else
2921 \ifx\codedashprev\codedash
2922 \else \discretionary{}{}{}\fi
2924 % we need the space after the = for the case when \next itself is a
2925 % space token; it would get swallowed otherwise. As in @code{- a}.
2926 \global\let\codedashprev= \next
2929 \def\normaldash{-}
2931 \def\codex #1{\tclose{#1}\endgroup}
2933 \def\codeunder{%
2934 % this is all so @math{@code{var_name}+1} can work. In math mode, _
2935 % is "active" (mathcode"8000) and \normalunderscore (or \char95, etc.)
2936 % will therefore expand the active definition of _, which is us
2937 % (inside @code that is), therefore an endless loop.
2938 \ifusingtt{\ifmmode
2939 \mathchar"075F % class 0=ordinary, family 7=ttfam, pos 0x5F=_.
2940 \else\normalunderscore \fi
2941 \discretionary{}{}{}}%
2942 {\_}%
2945 % An additional complication: the above will allow breaks after, e.g.,
2946 % each of the four underscores in __typeof__. This is bad.
2947 % @allowcodebreaks provides a document-level way to turn breaking at -
2948 % and _ on and off.
2950 \newif\ifallowcodebreaks \allowcodebreakstrue
2952 \def\keywordtrue{true}
2953 \def\keywordfalse{false}
2955 \parseargdef\allowcodebreaks{%
2956 \def\txiarg{#1}%
2957 \ifx\txiarg\keywordtrue
2958 \allowcodebreakstrue
2959 \else\ifx\txiarg\keywordfalse
2960 \allowcodebreaksfalse
2961 \else
2962 \errhelp = \EMsimple
2963 \errmessage{Unknown @allowcodebreaks option `\txiarg', must be true|false}%
2964 \fi\fi
2967 % For @command, @env, @file, @option quotes seem unnecessary,
2968 % so use \code rather than \samp.
2969 \let\command=\code
2970 \let\env=\code
2971 \let\file=\code
2972 \let\option=\code
2974 % @uref (abbreviation for `urlref') aka @url takes an optional
2975 % (comma-separated) second argument specifying the text to display and
2976 % an optional third arg as text to display instead of (rather than in
2977 % addition to) the url itself. First (mandatory) arg is the url.
2979 % TeX-only option to allow changing PDF output to show only the second
2980 % arg (if given), and not the url (which is then just the link target).
2981 \newif\ifurefurlonlylink
2983 % The main macro is \urefbreak, which allows breaking at expected
2984 % places within the url. (There used to be another version, which
2985 % didn't support automatic breaking.)
2986 \def\urefbreak{\begingroup \urefcatcodes \dourefbreak}
2987 \let\uref=\urefbreak
2989 \def\dourefbreak#1{\urefbreakfinish #1,,,\finish}
2990 \def\urefbreakfinish#1,#2,#3,#4\finish{% doesn't work in @example
2991 \unsepspaces
2992 \pdfurl{#1}%
2993 \setbox0 = \hbox{\ignorespaces #3}%
2994 \ifdim\wd0 > 0pt
2995 \unhbox0 % third arg given, show only that
2996 \else
2997 \setbox0 = \hbox{\ignorespaces #2}% look for second arg
2998 \ifdim\wd0 > 0pt
2999 \ifpdf
3000 % For pdfTeX and LuaTeX
3001 \ifurefurlonlylink
3002 % PDF plus option to not display url, show just arg
3003 \unhbox0
3004 \else
3005 % PDF, normally display both arg and url for consistency,
3006 % visibility, if the pdf is eventually used to print, etc.
3007 \unhbox0\ (\urefcode{#1})%
3009 \else
3010 \ifx\XeTeXrevision\thisisundefined
3011 \unhbox0\ (\urefcode{#1})% DVI, always show arg and url
3012 \else
3013 % For XeTeX
3014 \ifurefurlonlylink
3015 % PDF plus option to not display url, show just arg
3016 \unhbox0
3017 \else
3018 % PDF, normally display both arg and url for consistency,
3019 % visibility, if the pdf is eventually used to print, etc.
3020 \unhbox0\ (\urefcode{#1})%
3024 \else
3025 \urefcode{#1}% only url given, so show it
3028 \endlink
3029 \endgroup}
3031 % Allow line breaks around only a few characters (only).
3032 \def\urefcatcodes{%
3033 \catcode`\&=\active \catcode`\.=\active
3034 \catcode`\#=\active \catcode`\?=\active
3035 \catcode`\/=\active
3038 \urefcatcodes
3040 \global\def\urefcode{\begingroup
3041 \setupmarkupstyle{code}%
3042 \urefcatcodes
3043 \let&\urefcodeamp
3044 \let.\urefcodedot
3045 \let#\urefcodehash
3046 \let?\urefcodequest
3047 \let/\urefcodeslash
3048 \codex
3051 % By default, they are just regular characters.
3052 \global\def&{\normalamp}
3053 \global\def.{\normaldot}
3054 \global\def#{\normalhash}
3055 \global\def?{\normalquest}
3056 \global\def/{\normalslash}
3059 % we put a little stretch before and after the breakable chars, to help
3060 % line breaking of long url's. The unequal skips make look better in
3061 % cmtt at least, especially for dots.
3062 \def\urefprestretchamount{.13em}
3063 \def\urefpoststretchamount{.1em}
3064 \def\urefprestretch{\urefprebreak \hskip0pt plus\urefprestretchamount\relax}
3065 \def\urefpoststretch{\urefpostbreak \hskip0pt plus\urefprestretchamount\relax}
3067 \def\urefcodeamp{\urefprestretch \&\urefpoststretch}
3068 \def\urefcodedot{\urefprestretch .\urefpoststretch}
3069 \def\urefcodehash{\urefprestretch \#\urefpoststretch}
3070 \def\urefcodequest{\urefprestretch ?\urefpoststretch}
3071 \def\urefcodeslash{\futurelet\next\urefcodeslashfinish}
3073 \catcode`\/=\active
3074 \global\def\urefcodeslashfinish{%
3075 \urefprestretch \slashChar
3076 % Allow line break only after the final / in a sequence of
3077 % slashes, to avoid line break between the slashes in http://.
3078 \ifx\next/\else \urefpoststretch \fi
3082 % One more complication: by default we'll break after the special
3083 % characters, but some people like to break before the special chars, so
3084 % allow that. Also allow no breaking at all, for manual control.
3086 \parseargdef\urefbreakstyle{%
3087 \def\txiarg{#1}%
3088 \ifx\txiarg\wordnone
3089 \def\urefprebreak{\nobreak}\def\urefpostbreak{\nobreak}
3090 \else\ifx\txiarg\wordbefore
3091 \def\urefprebreak{\allowbreak}\def\urefpostbreak{\nobreak}
3092 \else\ifx\txiarg\wordafter
3093 \def\urefprebreak{\nobreak}\def\urefpostbreak{\allowbreak}
3094 \else
3095 \errhelp = \EMsimple
3096 \errmessage{Unknown @urefbreakstyle setting `\txiarg'}%
3097 \fi\fi\fi
3099 \def\wordafter{after}
3100 \def\wordbefore{before}
3101 \def\wordnone{none}
3103 \urefbreakstyle after
3105 % @url synonym for @uref, since that's how everyone uses it.
3107 \let\url=\uref
3109 % rms does not like angle brackets --karl, 17may97.
3110 % So now @email is just like @uref, unless we are pdf.
3112 %\def\email#1{\angleleft{\tt #1}\angleright}
3113 \ifpdf
3114 \def\email#1{\doemail#1,,\finish}
3115 \def\doemail#1,#2,#3\finish{\begingroup
3116 \unsepspaces
3117 \pdfurl{mailto:#1}%
3118 \setbox0 = \hbox{\ignorespaces #2}%
3119 \ifdim\wd0>0pt\unhbox0\else\code{#1}\fi
3120 \endlink
3121 \endgroup}
3122 \else
3123 \ifx\XeTeXrevision\thisisundefined
3124 \let\email=\uref
3125 \else
3126 \def\email#1{\doemail#1,,\finish}
3127 \def\doemail#1,#2,#3\finish{\begingroup
3128 \unsepspaces
3129 \pdfurl{mailto:#1}%
3130 \setbox0 = \hbox{\ignorespaces #2}%
3131 \ifdim\wd0>0pt\unhbox0\else\code{#1}\fi
3132 \endlink
3133 \endgroup}
3137 % @kbdinputstyle -- arg is `distinct' (@kbd uses slanted tty font always),
3138 % `example' (@kbd uses ttsl only inside of @example and friends),
3139 % or `code' (@kbd uses normal tty font always).
3140 \parseargdef\kbdinputstyle{%
3141 \def\txiarg{#1}%
3142 \ifx\txiarg\worddistinct
3143 \gdef\kbdexamplefont{\ttsl}\gdef\kbdfont{\ttsl}%
3144 \else\ifx\txiarg\wordexample
3145 \gdef\kbdexamplefont{\ttsl}\gdef\kbdfont{\tt}%
3146 \else\ifx\txiarg\wordcode
3147 \gdef\kbdexamplefont{\tt}\gdef\kbdfont{\tt}%
3148 \else
3149 \errhelp = \EMsimple
3150 \errmessage{Unknown @kbdinputstyle setting `\txiarg'}%
3151 \fi\fi\fi
3153 \def\worddistinct{distinct}
3154 \def\wordexample{example}
3155 \def\wordcode{code}
3157 % Default is `distinct'.
3158 \kbdinputstyle distinct
3160 % @kbd is like @code, except that if the argument is just one @key command,
3161 % then @kbd has no effect.
3162 \def\kbd#1{{\def\look{#1}\expandafter\kbdsub\look??\par}}
3164 \def\xkey{\key}
3165 \def\kbdsub#1#2#3\par{%
3166 \def\one{#1}\def\three{#3}\def\threex{??}%
3167 \ifx\one\xkey\ifx\threex\three \key{#2}%
3168 \else{\tclose{\kbdfont\setupmarkupstyle{kbd}\look}}\fi
3169 \else{\tclose{\kbdfont\setupmarkupstyle{kbd}\look}}\fi
3172 % definition of @key that produces a lozenge. Doesn't adjust to text size.
3173 %\setfont\keyrm\rmshape{8}{1000}{OT1}
3174 %\font\keysy=cmsy9
3175 %\def\key#1{{\keyrm\textfont2=\keysy \leavevmode\hbox{%
3176 % \raise0.4pt\hbox{\angleleft}\kern-.08em\vtop{%
3177 % \vbox{\hrule\kern-0.4pt
3178 % \hbox{\raise0.4pt\hbox{\vphantom{\angleleft}}#1}}%
3179 % \kern-0.4pt\hrule}%
3180 % \kern-.06em\raise0.4pt\hbox{\angleright}}}}
3182 % definition of @key with no lozenge. If the current font is already
3183 % monospace, don't change it; that way, we respect @kbdinputstyle. But
3184 % if it isn't monospace, then use \tt.
3186 \def\key#1{{\setupmarkupstyle{key}%
3187 \nohyphenation
3188 \ifmonospace\else\tt\fi
3189 #1}\null}
3191 % @clicksequence{File @click{} Open ...}
3192 \def\clicksequence#1{\begingroup #1\endgroup}
3194 % @clickstyle @arrow (by default)
3195 \parseargdef\clickstyle{\def\click{#1}}
3196 \def\click{\arrow}
3198 % Typeset a dimension, e.g., `in' or `pt'. The only reason for the
3199 % argument is to make the input look right: @dmn{pt} instead of @dmn{}pt.
3201 \def\dmn#1{\thinspace #1}
3203 % @acronym for "FBI", "NATO", and the like.
3204 % We print this one point size smaller, since it's intended for
3205 % all-uppercase.
3207 \def\acronym#1{\doacronym #1,,\finish}
3208 \def\doacronym#1,#2,#3\finish{%
3209 {\switchtolsize #1}%
3210 \def\temp{#2}%
3211 \ifx\temp\empty \else
3212 \space ({\unsepspaces \ignorespaces \temp \unskip})%
3214 \null % reset \spacefactor=1000
3217 % @abbr for "Comput. J." and the like.
3218 % No font change, but don't do end-of-sentence spacing.
3220 \def\abbr#1{\doabbr #1,,\finish}
3221 \def\doabbr#1,#2,#3\finish{%
3222 {\plainfrenchspacing #1}%
3223 \def\temp{#2}%
3224 \ifx\temp\empty \else
3225 \space ({\unsepspaces \ignorespaces \temp \unskip})%
3227 \null % reset \spacefactor=1000
3230 % @asis just yields its argument. Used with @table, for example.
3232 \def\asis#1{#1}
3234 % @math outputs its argument in math mode.
3236 % One complication: _ usually means subscripts, but it could also mean
3237 % an actual _ character, as in @math{@var{some_variable} + 1}. So make
3238 % _ active, and distinguish by seeing if the current family is \slfam,
3239 % which is what @var uses.
3241 \catcode`\_ = \active
3242 \gdef\mathunderscore{%
3243 \catcode`\_=\active
3244 \def_{\ifnum\fam=\slfam \_\else\sb\fi}%
3247 % Another complication: we want \\ (and @\) to output a math (or tt) \.
3248 % FYI, plain.tex uses \\ as a temporary control sequence (for no
3249 % particular reason), but this is not advertised and we don't care.
3251 % The \mathchar is class=0=ordinary, family=7=ttfam, position=5C=\.
3252 \def\mathbackslash{\ifnum\fam=\ttfam \mathchar"075C \else\backslash \fi}
3254 \def\math{%
3255 \ifmmode\else % only go into math if not in math mode already
3256 \tex
3257 \mathunderscore
3258 \let\\ = \mathbackslash
3259 \mathactive
3260 % make the texinfo accent commands work in math mode
3261 \let\"=\ddot
3262 \let\'=\acute
3263 \let\==\bar
3264 \let\^=\hat
3265 \let\`=\grave
3266 \let\u=\breve
3267 \let\v=\check
3268 \let\~=\tilde
3269 \let\dotaccent=\dot
3270 % have to provide another name for sup operator
3271 \let\mathopsup=\sup
3272 $\expandafter\finishmath\fi
3274 \def\finishmath#1{#1$\endgroup} % Close the group opened by \tex.
3276 % Some active characters (such as <) are spaced differently in math.
3277 % We have to reset their definitions in case the @math was an argument
3278 % to a command which sets the catcodes (such as @item or @section).
3281 \catcode`^ = \active
3282 \catcode`< = \active
3283 \catcode`> = \active
3284 \catcode`+ = \active
3285 \catcode`' = \active
3286 \gdef\mathactive{%
3287 \let^ = \ptexhat
3288 \let< = \ptexless
3289 \let> = \ptexgtr
3290 \let+ = \ptexplus
3291 \let' = \ptexquoteright
3295 % for @sub and @sup, if in math mode, just do a normal sub/superscript.
3296 % If in text, use math to place as sub/superscript, but switch
3297 % into text mode, with smaller fonts. This is a different font than the
3298 % one used for real math sub/superscripts (8pt vs. 7pt), but let's not
3299 % fix it (significant additions to font machinery) until someone notices.
3301 \def\sub{\ifmmode \expandafter\sb \else \expandafter\finishsub\fi}
3302 \def\finishsub#1{$\sb{\hbox{\switchtolllsize #1}}$}%
3304 \def\sup{\ifmmode \expandafter\ptexsp \else \expandafter\finishsup\fi}
3305 \def\finishsup#1{$\ptexsp{\hbox{\switchtolllsize #1}}$}%
3307 % @inlinefmt{FMTNAME,PROCESSED-TEXT} and @inlineraw{FMTNAME,RAW-TEXT}.
3308 % Ignore unless FMTNAME == tex; then it is like @iftex and @tex,
3309 % except specified as a normal braced arg, so no newlines to worry about.
3311 \def\outfmtnametex{tex}
3313 \long\def\inlinefmt#1{\doinlinefmt #1,\finish}
3314 \long\def\doinlinefmt#1,#2,\finish{%
3315 \def\inlinefmtname{#1}%
3316 \ifx\inlinefmtname\outfmtnametex \ignorespaces #2\fi
3319 % @inlinefmtifelse{FMTNAME,THEN-TEXT,ELSE-TEXT} expands THEN-TEXT if
3320 % FMTNAME is tex, else ELSE-TEXT.
3321 \long\def\inlinefmtifelse#1{\doinlinefmtifelse #1,,,\finish}
3322 \long\def\doinlinefmtifelse#1,#2,#3,#4,\finish{%
3323 \def\inlinefmtname{#1}%
3324 \ifx\inlinefmtname\outfmtnametex \ignorespaces #2\else \ignorespaces #3\fi
3327 % For raw, must switch into @tex before parsing the argument, to avoid
3328 % setting catcodes prematurely. Doing it this way means that, for
3329 % example, @inlineraw{html, foo{bar} gets a parse error instead of being
3330 % ignored. But this isn't important because if people want a literal
3331 % *right* brace they would have to use a command anyway, so they may as
3332 % well use a command to get a left brace too. We could re-use the
3333 % delimiter character idea from \verb, but it seems like overkill.
3335 \long\def\inlineraw{\tex \doinlineraw}
3336 \long\def\doinlineraw#1{\doinlinerawtwo #1,\finish}
3337 \def\doinlinerawtwo#1,#2,\finish{%
3338 \def\inlinerawname{#1}%
3339 \ifx\inlinerawname\outfmtnametex \ignorespaces #2\fi
3340 \endgroup % close group opened by \tex.
3343 % @inlineifset{VAR, TEXT} expands TEXT if VAR is @set.
3345 \long\def\inlineifset#1{\doinlineifset #1,\finish}
3346 \long\def\doinlineifset#1,#2,\finish{%
3347 \def\inlinevarname{#1}%
3348 \expandafter\ifx\csname SET\inlinevarname\endcsname\relax
3349 \else\ignorespaces#2\fi
3352 % @inlineifclear{VAR, TEXT} expands TEXT if VAR is not @set.
3354 \long\def\inlineifclear#1{\doinlineifclear #1,\finish}
3355 \long\def\doinlineifclear#1,#2,\finish{%
3356 \def\inlinevarname{#1}%
3357 \expandafter\ifx\csname SET\inlinevarname\endcsname\relax \ignorespaces#2\fi
3361 \message{glyphs,}
3362 % and logos.
3364 % @@ prints an @, as does @atchar{}.
3365 \def\@{\char64 }
3366 \let\atchar=\@
3368 % @{ @} @lbracechar{} @rbracechar{} all generate brace characters.
3369 \def\lbracechar{{\ifmonospace\char123\else\ensuremath\lbrace\fi}}
3370 \def\rbracechar{{\ifmonospace\char125\else\ensuremath\rbrace\fi}}
3371 \let\{=\lbracechar
3372 \let\}=\rbracechar
3374 % @comma{} to avoid , parsing problems.
3375 \let\comma = ,
3377 % Accents: @, @dotaccent @ringaccent @ubaraccent @udotaccent
3378 % Others are defined by plain TeX: @` @' @" @^ @~ @= @u @v @H.
3379 \let\, = \ptexc
3380 \let\dotaccent = \ptexdot
3381 \def\ringaccent#1{{\accent23 #1}}
3382 \let\tieaccent = \ptext
3383 \let\ubaraccent = \ptexb
3384 \let\udotaccent = \d
3386 % Other special characters: @questiondown @exclamdown @ordf @ordm
3387 % Plain TeX defines: @AA @AE @O @OE @L (plus lowercase versions) @ss.
3388 \def\questiondown{?`}
3389 \def\exclamdown{!`}
3390 \def\ordf{\leavevmode\raise1ex\hbox{\switchtolllsize \underbar{a}}}
3391 \def\ordm{\leavevmode\raise1ex\hbox{\switchtolllsize \underbar{o}}}
3393 % Dotless i and dotless j, used for accents.
3394 \def\imacro{i}
3395 \def\jmacro{j}
3396 \def\dotless#1{%
3397 \def\temp{#1}%
3398 \ifx\temp\imacro \ifmmode\imath \else\ptexi \fi
3399 \else\ifx\temp\jmacro \ifmmode\jmath \else\j \fi
3400 \else \errmessage{@dotless can be used only with i or j}%
3401 \fi\fi
3404 % The \TeX{} logo, as in plain, but resetting the spacing so that a
3405 % period following counts as ending a sentence. (Idea found in latex.)
3407 \edef\TeX{\TeX \spacefactor=1000 }
3409 % @LaTeX{} logo. Not quite the same results as the definition in
3410 % latex.ltx, since we use a different font for the raised A; it's most
3411 % convenient for us to use an explicitly smaller font, rather than using
3412 % the \scriptstyle font (since we don't reset \scriptstyle and
3413 % \scriptscriptstyle).
3415 \def\LaTeX{%
3416 L\kern-.36em
3417 {\setbox0=\hbox{T}%
3418 \vbox to \ht0{\hbox{%
3419 \ifx\textnominalsize\xwordpt
3420 % for 10pt running text, lllsize (8pt) is too small for the A in LaTeX.
3421 % Revert to plain's \scriptsize, which is 7pt.
3422 \count255=\the\fam $\fam\count255 \scriptstyle A$%
3423 \else
3424 % For 11pt, we can use our lllsize.
3425 \switchtolllsize A%
3428 \vss
3430 \kern-.15em
3431 \TeX
3434 % Some math mode symbols. Define \ensuremath to switch into math mode
3435 % unless we are already there. Expansion tricks may not be needed here,
3436 % but safer, and can't hurt.
3437 \def\ensuremath{\ifmmode \expandafter\asis \else\expandafter\ensuredmath \fi}
3438 \def\ensuredmath#1{$\relax#1$}
3440 \def\bullet{\ensuremath\ptexbullet}
3441 \def\geq{\ensuremath\ge}
3442 \def\leq{\ensuremath\le}
3443 \def\minus{\ensuremath-}
3445 % @dots{} outputs an ellipsis using the current font.
3446 % We do .5em per period so that it has the same spacing in the cm
3447 % typewriter fonts as three actual period characters; on the other hand,
3448 % in other typewriter fonts three periods are wider than 1.5em. So do
3449 % whichever is larger.
3451 \def\dots{%
3452 \leavevmode
3453 \setbox0=\hbox{...}% get width of three periods
3454 \ifdim\wd0 > 1.5em
3455 \dimen0 = \wd0
3456 \else
3457 \dimen0 = 1.5em
3459 \hbox to \dimen0{%
3460 \hskip 0pt plus.25fil
3461 .\hskip 0pt plus1fil
3462 .\hskip 0pt plus1fil
3463 .\hskip 0pt plus.5fil
3467 % @enddots{} is an end-of-sentence ellipsis.
3469 \def\enddots{%
3470 \dots
3471 \spacefactor=\endofsentencespacefactor
3474 % @point{}, @result{}, @expansion{}, @print{}, @equiv{}.
3476 % Since these characters are used in examples, they should be an even number of
3477 % \tt widths. Each \tt character is 1en, so two makes it 1em.
3479 \def\point{$\star$}
3480 \def\arrow{\leavevmode\raise.05ex\hbox to 1em{\hfil$\rightarrow$\hfil}}
3481 \def\result{\leavevmode\raise.05ex\hbox to 1em{\hfil$\Rightarrow$\hfil}}
3482 \def\expansion{\leavevmode\hbox to 1em{\hfil$\mapsto$\hfil}}
3483 \def\print{\leavevmode\lower.1ex\hbox to 1em{\hfil$\dashv$\hfil}}
3484 \def\equiv{\leavevmode\hbox to 1em{\hfil$\ptexequiv$\hfil}}
3486 % The @error{} command.
3487 % Adapted from the TeXbook's \boxit.
3489 \newbox\errorbox
3491 {\ttfont \global\dimen0 = 3em}% Width of the box.
3492 \dimen2 = .55pt % Thickness of rules
3493 % The text. (`r' is open on the right, `e' somewhat less so on the left.)
3494 \setbox0 = \hbox{\kern-.75pt \reducedsf \putworderror\kern-1.5pt}
3496 \setbox\errorbox=\hbox to \dimen0{\hfil
3497 \hsize = \dimen0 \advance\hsize by -5.8pt % Space to left+right.
3498 \advance\hsize by -2\dimen2 % Rules.
3499 \vbox{%
3500 \hrule height\dimen2
3501 \hbox{\vrule width\dimen2 \kern3pt % Space to left of text.
3502 \vtop{\kern2.4pt \box0 \kern2.4pt}% Space above/below.
3503 \kern3pt\vrule width\dimen2}% Space to right.
3504 \hrule height\dimen2}
3505 \hfil}
3507 \def\error{\leavevmode\lower.7ex\copy\errorbox}
3509 % @pounds{} is a sterling sign, which Knuth put in the CM italic font.
3511 \def\pounds{{\it\$}}
3513 % @euro{} comes from a separate font, depending on the current style.
3514 % We use the free feym* fonts from the eurosym package by Henrik
3515 % Theiling, which support regular, slanted, bold and bold slanted (and
3516 % "outlined" (blackboard board, sort of) versions, which we don't need).
3517 % It is available from http://www.ctan.org/tex-archive/fonts/eurosym.
3519 % Although only regular is the truly official Euro symbol, we ignore
3520 % that. The Euro is designed to be slightly taller than the regular
3521 % font height.
3523 % feymr - regular
3524 % feymo - slanted
3525 % feybr - bold
3526 % feybo - bold slanted
3528 % There is no good (free) typewriter version, to my knowledge.
3529 % A feymr10 euro is ~7.3pt wide, while a normal cmtt10 char is ~5.25pt wide.
3530 % Hmm.
3532 % Also doesn't work in math. Do we need to do math with euro symbols?
3533 % Hope not.
3536 \def\euro{{\eurofont e}}
3537 \def\eurofont{%
3538 % We set the font at each command, rather than predefining it in
3539 % \textfonts and the other font-switching commands, so that
3540 % installations which never need the symbol don't have to have the
3541 % font installed.
3543 % There is only one designed size (nominal 10pt), so we always scale
3544 % that to the current nominal size.
3546 % By the way, simply using "at 1em" works for cmr10 and the like, but
3547 % does not work for cmbx10 and other extended/shrunken fonts.
3549 \def\eurosize{\csname\curfontsize nominalsize\endcsname}%
3551 \ifx\curfontstyle\bfstylename
3552 % bold:
3553 \font\thiseurofont = \ifusingit{feybo10}{feybr10} at \eurosize
3554 \else
3555 % regular:
3556 \font\thiseurofont = \ifusingit{feymo10}{feymr10} at \eurosize
3558 \thiseurofont
3561 % Glyphs from the EC fonts. We don't use \let for the aliases, because
3562 % sometimes we redefine the original macro, and the alias should reflect
3563 % the redefinition.
3565 % Use LaTeX names for the Icelandic letters.
3566 \def\DH{{\ecfont \char"D0}} % Eth
3567 \def\dh{{\ecfont \char"F0}} % eth
3568 \def\TH{{\ecfont \char"DE}} % Thorn
3569 \def\th{{\ecfont \char"FE}} % thorn
3571 \def\guillemetleft{{\ecfont \char"13}}
3572 \def\guillemotleft{\guillemetleft}
3573 \def\guillemetright{{\ecfont \char"14}}
3574 \def\guillemotright{\guillemetright}
3575 \def\guilsinglleft{{\ecfont \char"0E}}
3576 \def\guilsinglright{{\ecfont \char"0F}}
3577 \def\quotedblbase{{\ecfont \char"12}}
3578 \def\quotesinglbase{{\ecfont \char"0D}}
3580 % This positioning is not perfect (see the ogonek LaTeX package), but
3581 % we have the precomposed glyphs for the most common cases. We put the
3582 % tests to use those glyphs in the single \ogonek macro so we have fewer
3583 % dummy definitions to worry about for index entries, etc.
3585 % ogonek is also used with other letters in Lithuanian (IOU), but using
3586 % the precomposed glyphs for those is not so easy since they aren't in
3587 % the same EC font.
3588 \def\ogonek#1{{%
3589 \def\temp{#1}%
3590 \ifx\temp\macrocharA\Aogonek
3591 \else\ifx\temp\macrochara\aogonek
3592 \else\ifx\temp\macrocharE\Eogonek
3593 \else\ifx\temp\macrochare\eogonek
3594 \else
3595 \ecfont \setbox0=\hbox{#1}%
3596 \ifdim\ht0=1ex\accent"0C #1%
3597 \else\ooalign{\unhbox0\crcr\hidewidth\char"0C \hidewidth}%
3599 \fi\fi\fi\fi
3602 \def\Aogonek{{\ecfont \char"81}}\def\macrocharA{A}
3603 \def\aogonek{{\ecfont \char"A1}}\def\macrochara{a}
3604 \def\Eogonek{{\ecfont \char"86}}\def\macrocharE{E}
3605 \def\eogonek{{\ecfont \char"A6}}\def\macrochare{e}
3607 % Use the European Computer Modern fonts (cm-super in outline format)
3608 % for non-CM glyphs. That is ec* for regular text and tc* for the text
3609 % companion symbols (LaTeX TS1 encoding). Both are part of the ec
3610 % package and follow the same conventions.
3612 \def\ecfont{\etcfont{e}}
3613 \def\tcfont{\etcfont{t}}
3615 \def\etcfont#1{%
3616 % We can't distinguish serif/sans and italic/slanted, but this
3617 % is used for crude hacks anyway (like adding French and German
3618 % quotes to documents typeset with CM, where we lose kerning), so
3619 % hopefully nobody will notice/care.
3620 \edef\ecsize{\csname\curfontsize ecsize\endcsname}%
3621 \edef\nominalsize{\csname\curfontsize nominalsize\endcsname}%
3622 \ifmonospace
3623 % typewriter:
3624 \font\thisecfont = #1ctt\ecsize \space at \nominalsize
3625 \else
3626 \ifx\curfontstyle\bfstylename
3627 % bold:
3628 \font\thisecfont = #1cb\ifusingit{i}{x}\ecsize \space at \nominalsize
3629 \else
3630 % regular:
3631 \font\thisecfont = #1c\ifusingit{ti}{rm}\ecsize \space at \nominalsize
3634 \thisecfont
3637 % @registeredsymbol - R in a circle. The font for the R should really
3638 % be smaller yet, but lllsize is the best we can do for now.
3639 % Adapted from the plain.tex definition of \copyright.
3641 \def\registeredsymbol{%
3642 $^{{\ooalign{\hfil\raise.07ex\hbox{\switchtolllsize R}%
3643 \hfil\crcr\Orb}}%
3647 % @textdegree - the normal degrees sign.
3649 \def\textdegree{$^\circ$}
3651 % Laurent Siebenmann reports \Orb undefined with:
3652 % Textures 1.7.7 (preloaded format=plain 93.10.14) (68K) 16 APR 2004 02:38
3653 % so we'll define it if necessary.
3655 \ifx\Orb\thisisundefined
3656 \def\Orb{\mathhexbox20D}
3659 % Quotes.
3660 \chardef\quotedblleft="5C
3661 \chardef\quotedblright=`\"
3662 \chardef\quoteleft=`\`
3663 \chardef\quoteright=`\'
3666 \message{page headings,}
3668 \newskip\titlepagetopglue \titlepagetopglue = 1.5in
3669 \newskip\titlepagebottomglue \titlepagebottomglue = 2pc
3671 % First the title page. Must do @settitle before @titlepage.
3672 \newif\ifseenauthor
3673 \newif\iffinishedtitlepage
3675 % @setcontentsaftertitlepage used to do an implicit @contents or
3676 % @shortcontents after @end titlepage, but it is now obsolete.
3677 \def\setcontentsaftertitlepage{%
3678 \errmessage{@setcontentsaftertitlepage has been removed as a Texinfo
3679 command; move your @contents command if you want the contents
3680 after the title page.}}%
3681 \def\setshortcontentsaftertitlepage{%
3682 \errmessage{@setshortcontentsaftertitlepage has been removed as a Texinfo
3683 command; move your @shortcontents and @contents commands if you
3684 want the contents after the title page.}}%
3686 \parseargdef\shorttitlepage{%
3687 \begingroup \hbox{}\vskip 1.5in \chaprm \centerline{#1}%
3688 \endgroup\page\hbox{}\page}
3690 \envdef\titlepage{%
3691 % Open one extra group, as we want to close it in the middle of \Etitlepage.
3692 \begingroup
3693 \parindent=0pt \textfonts
3694 % Leave some space at the very top of the page.
3695 \vglue\titlepagetopglue
3696 % No rule at page bottom unless we print one at the top with @title.
3697 \finishedtitlepagetrue
3699 % Most title ``pages'' are actually two pages long, with space
3700 % at the top of the second. We don't want the ragged left on the second.
3701 \let\oldpage = \page
3702 \def\page{%
3703 \iffinishedtitlepage\else
3704 \finishtitlepage
3706 \let\page = \oldpage
3707 \page
3708 \null
3712 \def\Etitlepage{%
3713 \iffinishedtitlepage\else
3714 \finishtitlepage
3716 % It is important to do the page break before ending the group,
3717 % because the headline and footline are only empty inside the group.
3718 % If we use the new definition of \page, we always get a blank page
3719 % after the title page, which we certainly don't want.
3720 \oldpage
3721 \endgroup
3723 % Need this before the \...aftertitlepage checks so that if they are
3724 % in effect the toc pages will come out with page numbers.
3725 \HEADINGSon
3728 \def\finishtitlepage{%
3729 \vskip4pt \hrule height 2pt width \hsize
3730 \vskip\titlepagebottomglue
3731 \finishedtitlepagetrue
3734 % Settings used for typesetting titles: no hyphenation, no indentation,
3735 % don't worry much about spacing, ragged right. This should be used
3736 % inside a \vbox, and fonts need to be set appropriately first. \par should
3737 % be specified before the end of the \vbox, since a vbox is a group.
3739 \def\raggedtitlesettings{%
3741 \hyphenpenalty=10000
3742 \parindent=0pt
3743 \tolerance=5000
3744 \ptexraggedright
3747 % Macros to be used within @titlepage:
3749 \let\subtitlerm=\rmfont
3750 \def\subtitlefont{\subtitlerm \normalbaselineskip = 13pt \normalbaselines}
3752 \parseargdef\title{%
3753 \checkenv\titlepage
3754 \vbox{\titlefonts \raggedtitlesettings #1\par}%
3755 % print a rule at the page bottom also.
3756 \finishedtitlepagefalse
3757 \vskip4pt \hrule height 4pt width \hsize \vskip4pt
3760 \parseargdef\subtitle{%
3761 \checkenv\titlepage
3762 {\subtitlefont \rightline{#1}}%
3765 % @author should come last, but may come many times.
3766 % It can also be used inside @quotation.
3768 \parseargdef\author{%
3769 \def\temp{\quotation}%
3770 \ifx\thisenv\temp
3771 \def\quotationauthor{#1}% printed in \Equotation.
3772 \else
3773 \checkenv\titlepage
3774 \ifseenauthor\else \vskip 0pt plus 1filll \seenauthortrue \fi
3775 {\secfonts\rm \leftline{#1}}%
3780 % Set up page headings and footings.
3782 \let\thispage=\folio
3784 \newtoks\evenheadline % headline on even pages
3785 \newtoks\oddheadline % headline on odd pages
3786 \newtoks\evenfootline % footline on even pages
3787 \newtoks\oddfootline % footline on odd pages
3789 % Now make \makeheadline and \makefootline in Plain TeX use those variables
3790 \headline={{\textfonts\rm \ifodd\pageno \the\oddheadline
3791 \else \the\evenheadline \fi}}
3792 \footline={{\textfonts\rm \ifodd\pageno \the\oddfootline
3793 \else \the\evenfootline \fi}\HEADINGShook}
3794 \let\HEADINGShook=\relax
3796 % Commands to set those variables.
3797 % For example, this is what @headings on does
3798 % @evenheading @thistitle|@thispage|@thischapter
3799 % @oddheading @thischapter|@thispage|@thistitle
3800 % @evenfooting @thisfile||
3801 % @oddfooting ||@thisfile
3804 \def\evenheading{\parsearg\evenheadingxxx}
3805 \def\evenheadingxxx #1{\evenheadingyyy #1\|\|\|\|\finish}
3806 \def\evenheadingyyy #1\|#2\|#3\|#4\finish{%
3807 \global\evenheadline={\rlap{\centerline{#2}}\line{#1\hfil#3}}}
3809 \def\oddheading{\parsearg\oddheadingxxx}
3810 \def\oddheadingxxx #1{\oddheadingyyy #1\|\|\|\|\finish}
3811 \def\oddheadingyyy #1\|#2\|#3\|#4\finish{%
3812 \global\oddheadline={\rlap{\centerline{#2}}\line{#1\hfil#3}}}
3814 \parseargdef\everyheading{\oddheadingxxx{#1}\evenheadingxxx{#1}}%
3816 \def\evenfooting{\parsearg\evenfootingxxx}
3817 \def\evenfootingxxx #1{\evenfootingyyy #1\|\|\|\|\finish}
3818 \def\evenfootingyyy #1\|#2\|#3\|#4\finish{%
3819 \global\evenfootline={\rlap{\centerline{#2}}\line{#1\hfil#3}}}
3821 \def\oddfooting{\parsearg\oddfootingxxx}
3822 \def\oddfootingxxx #1{\oddfootingyyy #1\|\|\|\|\finish}
3823 \def\oddfootingyyy #1\|#2\|#3\|#4\finish{%
3824 \global\oddfootline = {\rlap{\centerline{#2}}\line{#1\hfil#3}}%
3826 % Leave some space for the footline. Hopefully ok to assume
3827 % @evenfooting will not be used by itself.
3828 \global\advance\txipageheight by -12pt
3829 \global\advance\vsize by -12pt
3832 \parseargdef\everyfooting{\oddfootingxxx{#1}\evenfootingxxx{#1}}
3834 % @evenheadingmarks top \thischapter <- chapter at the top of a page
3835 % @evenheadingmarks bottom \thischapter <- chapter at the bottom of a page
3837 % The same set of arguments for:
3839 % @oddheadingmarks
3840 % @evenfootingmarks
3841 % @oddfootingmarks
3842 % @everyheadingmarks
3843 % @everyfootingmarks
3845 % These define \getoddheadingmarks, \getevenheadingmarks,
3846 % \getoddfootingmarks, and \getevenfootingmarks, each to one of
3847 % \gettopheadingmarks, \getbottomheadingmarks.
3849 \def\evenheadingmarks{\headingmarks{even}{heading}}
3850 \def\oddheadingmarks{\headingmarks{odd}{heading}}
3851 \def\evenfootingmarks{\headingmarks{even}{footing}}
3852 \def\oddfootingmarks{\headingmarks{odd}{footing}}
3853 \parseargdef\everyheadingmarks{\headingmarks{even}{heading}{#1}
3854 \headingmarks{odd}{heading}{#1} }
3855 \parseargdef\everyfootingmarks{\headingmarks{even}{footing}{#1}
3856 \headingmarks{odd}{footing}{#1} }
3857 % #1 = even/odd, #2 = heading/footing, #3 = top/bottom.
3858 \def\headingmarks#1#2#3 {%
3859 \expandafter\let\expandafter\temp \csname get#3headingmarks\endcsname
3860 \global\expandafter\let\csname get#1#2marks\endcsname \temp
3863 \everyheadingmarks bottom
3864 \everyfootingmarks bottom
3866 % @headings double turns headings on for double-sided printing.
3867 % @headings single turns headings on for single-sided printing.
3868 % @headings off turns them off.
3869 % @headings on same as @headings double, retained for compatibility.
3870 % @headings after turns on double-sided headings after this page.
3871 % @headings doubleafter turns on double-sided headings after this page.
3872 % @headings singleafter turns on single-sided headings after this page.
3873 % By default, they are off at the start of a document,
3874 % and turned `on' after @end titlepage.
3876 \parseargdef\headings{\csname HEADINGS#1\endcsname}
3878 \def\headingsoff{% non-global headings elimination
3879 \evenheadline={\hfil}\evenfootline={\hfil}%
3880 \oddheadline={\hfil}\oddfootline={\hfil}%
3883 \def\HEADINGSoff{{\globaldefs=1 \headingsoff}} % global setting
3884 \HEADINGSoff % it's the default
3886 % When we turn headings on, set the page number to 1.
3887 % For double-sided printing, put current file name in lower left corner,
3888 % chapter name on inside top of right hand pages, document
3889 % title on inside top of left hand pages, and page numbers on outside top
3890 % edge of all pages.
3891 \def\HEADINGSdouble{%
3892 \global\pageno=1
3893 \global\evenfootline={\hfil}
3894 \global\oddfootline={\hfil}
3895 \global\evenheadline={\line{\folio\hfil\thistitle}}
3896 \global\oddheadline={\line{\thischapterheading\hfil\folio}}
3897 \global\let\contentsalignmacro = \chapoddpage
3899 \let\contentsalignmacro = \chappager
3901 % For single-sided printing, chapter title goes across top left of page,
3902 % page number on top right.
3903 \def\HEADINGSsingle{%
3904 \global\pageno=1
3905 \global\evenfootline={\hfil}
3906 \global\oddfootline={\hfil}
3907 \global\evenheadline={\line{\thischapterheading\hfil\folio}}
3908 \global\oddheadline={\line{\thischapterheading\hfil\folio}}
3909 \global\let\contentsalignmacro = \chappager
3911 \def\HEADINGSon{\HEADINGSdouble}
3913 \def\HEADINGSafter{\let\HEADINGShook=\HEADINGSdoublex}
3914 \let\HEADINGSdoubleafter=\HEADINGSafter
3915 \def\HEADINGSdoublex{%
3916 \global\evenfootline={\hfil}
3917 \global\oddfootline={\hfil}
3918 \global\evenheadline={\line{\folio\hfil\thistitle}}
3919 \global\oddheadline={\line{\thischapterheading\hfil\folio}}
3920 \global\let\contentsalignmacro = \chapoddpage
3923 \def\HEADINGSsingleafter{\let\HEADINGShook=\HEADINGSsinglex}
3924 \def\HEADINGSsinglex{%
3925 \global\evenfootline={\hfil}
3926 \global\oddfootline={\hfil}
3927 \global\evenheadline={\line{\thischapterheading\hfil\folio}}
3928 \global\oddheadline={\line{\thischapterheading\hfil\folio}}
3929 \global\let\contentsalignmacro = \chappager
3932 % Subroutines used in generating headings
3933 % This produces Day Month Year style of output.
3934 % Only define if not already defined, in case a txi-??.tex file has set
3935 % up a different format (e.g., txi-cs.tex does this).
3936 \ifx\today\thisisundefined
3937 \def\today{%
3938 \number\day\space
3939 \ifcase\month
3940 \or\putwordMJan\or\putwordMFeb\or\putwordMMar\or\putwordMApr
3941 \or\putwordMMay\or\putwordMJun\or\putwordMJul\or\putwordMAug
3942 \or\putwordMSep\or\putwordMOct\or\putwordMNov\or\putwordMDec
3944 \space\number\year}
3947 % @settitle line... specifies the title of the document, for headings.
3948 % It generates no output of its own.
3949 \def\thistitle{\putwordNoTitle}
3950 \def\settitle{\parsearg{\gdef\thistitle}}
3953 \message{tables,}
3954 % Tables -- @table, @ftable, @vtable, @item(x).
3956 % default indentation of table text
3957 \newdimen\tableindent \tableindent=.8in
3958 % default indentation of @itemize and @enumerate text
3959 \newdimen\itemindent \itemindent=.3in
3960 % margin between end of table item and start of table text.
3961 \newdimen\itemmargin \itemmargin=.1in
3963 % used internally for \itemindent minus \itemmargin
3964 \newdimen\itemmax
3966 % Note @table, @ftable, and @vtable define @item, @itemx, etc., with
3967 % these defs.
3968 % They also define \itemindex
3969 % to index the item name in whatever manner is desired (perhaps none).
3971 \newif\ifitemxneedsnegativevskip
3973 \def\itemxpar{\par\ifitemxneedsnegativevskip\nobreak\vskip-\parskip\nobreak\fi}
3975 \def\internalBitem{\smallbreak \parsearg\itemzzz}
3976 \def\internalBitemx{\itemxpar \parsearg\itemzzz}
3978 \def\itemzzz #1{\begingroup %
3979 \advance\hsize by -\rightskip
3980 \advance\hsize by -\tableindent
3981 \setbox0=\hbox{\itemindicate{#1}}%
3982 \itemindex{#1}%
3983 \nobreak % This prevents a break before @itemx.
3985 % If the item text does not fit in the space we have, put it on a line
3986 % by itself, and do not allow a page break either before or after that
3987 % line. We do not start a paragraph here because then if the next
3988 % command is, e.g., @kindex, the whatsit would get put into the
3989 % horizontal list on a line by itself, resulting in extra blank space.
3990 \ifdim \wd0>\itemmax
3992 % Make this a paragraph so we get the \parskip glue and wrapping,
3993 % but leave it ragged-right.
3994 \begingroup
3995 \advance\leftskip by-\tableindent
3996 \advance\hsize by\tableindent
3997 \advance\rightskip by0pt plus1fil\relax
3998 \leavevmode\unhbox0\par
3999 \endgroup
4001 % We're going to be starting a paragraph, but we don't want the
4002 % \parskip glue -- logically it's part of the @item we just started.
4003 \nobreak \vskip-\parskip
4005 % Stop a page break at the \parskip glue coming up. However, if
4006 % what follows is an environment such as @example, there will be no
4007 % \parskip glue; then the negative vskip we just inserted would
4008 % cause the example and the item to crash together. So we use this
4009 % bizarre value of 10001 as a signal to \aboveenvbreak to insert
4010 % \parskip glue after all. Section titles are handled this way also.
4012 \penalty 10001
4013 \endgroup
4014 \itemxneedsnegativevskipfalse
4015 \else
4016 % The item text fits into the space. Start a paragraph, so that the
4017 % following text (if any) will end up on the same line.
4018 \noindent
4019 % Do this with kerns and \unhbox so that if there is a footnote in
4020 % the item text, it can migrate to the main vertical list and
4021 % eventually be printed.
4022 \nobreak\kern-\tableindent
4023 \dimen0 = \itemmax \advance\dimen0 by \itemmargin \advance\dimen0 by -\wd0
4024 \unhbox0
4025 \nobreak\kern\dimen0
4026 \endgroup
4027 \itemxneedsnegativevskiptrue
4031 \def\item{\errmessage{@item while not in a list environment}}
4032 \def\itemx{\errmessage{@itemx while not in a list environment}}
4034 % @table, @ftable, @vtable.
4035 \envdef\table{%
4036 \let\itemindex\gobble
4037 \tablecheck{table}%
4039 \envdef\ftable{%
4040 \def\itemindex ##1{\doind {fn}{\code{##1}}}%
4041 \tablecheck{ftable}%
4043 \envdef\vtable{%
4044 \def\itemindex ##1{\doind {vr}{\code{##1}}}%
4045 \tablecheck{vtable}%
4047 \def\tablecheck#1{%
4048 \ifnum \the\catcode`\^^M=\active
4049 \endgroup
4050 \errmessage{This command won't work in this context; perhaps the problem is
4051 that we are \inenvironment\thisenv}%
4052 \def\next{\doignore{#1}}%
4053 \else
4054 \let\next\tablex
4056 \next
4058 \def\tablex#1{%
4059 \def\itemindicate{#1}%
4060 \parsearg\tabley
4062 \def\tabley#1{%
4064 \makevalueexpandable
4065 \edef\temp{\noexpand\tablez #1\space\space\space}%
4066 \expandafter
4067 }\temp \endtablez
4069 \def\tablez #1 #2 #3 #4\endtablez{%
4070 \aboveenvbreak
4071 \ifnum 0#1>0 \advance \leftskip by #1\mil \fi
4072 \ifnum 0#2>0 \tableindent=#2\mil \fi
4073 \ifnum 0#3>0 \advance \rightskip by #3\mil \fi
4074 \itemmax=\tableindent
4075 \advance \itemmax by -\itemmargin
4076 \advance \leftskip by \tableindent
4077 \exdentamount=\tableindent
4078 \parindent = 0pt
4079 \parskip = \smallskipamount
4080 \ifdim \parskip=0pt \parskip=2pt \fi
4081 \let\item = \internalBitem
4082 \let\itemx = \internalBitemx
4084 \def\Etable{\endgraf\afterenvbreak}
4085 \let\Eftable\Etable
4086 \let\Evtable\Etable
4087 \let\Eitemize\Etable
4088 \let\Eenumerate\Etable
4090 % This is the counter used by @enumerate, which is really @itemize
4092 \newcount \itemno
4094 \envdef\itemize{\parsearg\doitemize}
4096 \def\doitemize#1{%
4097 \aboveenvbreak
4098 \itemmax=\itemindent
4099 \advance\itemmax by -\itemmargin
4100 \advance\leftskip by \itemindent
4101 \exdentamount=\itemindent
4102 \parindent=0pt
4103 \parskip=\smallskipamount
4104 \ifdim\parskip=0pt \parskip=2pt \fi
4106 % Try typesetting the item mark so that if the document erroneously says
4107 % something like @itemize @samp (intending @table), there's an error
4108 % right away at the @itemize. It's not the best error message in the
4109 % world, but it's better than leaving it to the @item. This means if
4110 % the user wants an empty mark, they have to say @w{} not just @w.
4111 \def\itemcontents{#1}%
4112 \setbox0 = \hbox{\itemcontents}%
4114 % @itemize with no arg is equivalent to @itemize @bullet.
4115 \ifx\itemcontents\empty\def\itemcontents{\bullet}\fi
4117 \let\item=\itemizeitem
4120 % Definition of @item while inside @itemize and @enumerate.
4122 \def\itemizeitem{%
4123 \advance\itemno by 1 % for enumerations
4124 {\let\par=\endgraf \smallbreak}% reasonable place to break
4126 % If the document has an @itemize directly after a section title, a
4127 % \nobreak will be last on the list, and \sectionheading will have
4128 % done a \vskip-\parskip. In that case, we don't want to zero
4129 % parskip, or the item text will crash with the heading. On the
4130 % other hand, when there is normal text preceding the item (as there
4131 % usually is), we do want to zero parskip, or there would be too much
4132 % space. In that case, we won't have a \nobreak before. At least
4133 % that's the theory.
4134 \ifnum\lastpenalty<10000 \parskip=0in \fi
4135 \noindent
4136 \hbox to 0pt{\hss \itemcontents \kern\itemmargin}%
4138 \ifinner\else
4139 \vadjust{\penalty 1200}% not good to break after first line of item.
4141 % We can be in inner vertical mode in a footnote, although an
4142 % @itemize looks awful there.
4144 \flushcr
4147 % \splitoff TOKENS\endmark defines \first to be the first token in
4148 % TOKENS, and \rest to be the remainder.
4150 \def\splitoff#1#2\endmark{\def\first{#1}\def\rest{#2}}%
4152 % Allow an optional argument of an uppercase letter, lowercase letter,
4153 % or number, to specify the first label in the enumerated list. No
4154 % argument is the same as `1'.
4156 \envparseargdef\enumerate{\enumeratey #1 \endenumeratey}
4157 \def\enumeratey #1 #2\endenumeratey{%
4158 % If we were given no argument, pretend we were given `1'.
4159 \def\thearg{#1}%
4160 \ifx\thearg\empty \def\thearg{1}\fi
4162 % Detect if the argument is a single token. If so, it might be a
4163 % letter. Otherwise, the only valid thing it can be is a number.
4164 % (We will always have one token, because of the test we just made.
4165 % This is a good thing, since \splitoff doesn't work given nothing at
4166 % all -- the first parameter is undelimited.)
4167 \expandafter\splitoff\thearg\endmark
4168 \ifx\rest\empty
4169 % Only one token in the argument. It could still be anything.
4170 % A ``lowercase letter'' is one whose \lccode is nonzero.
4171 % An ``uppercase letter'' is one whose \lccode is both nonzero, and
4172 % not equal to itself.
4173 % Otherwise, we assume it's a number.
4175 % We need the \relax at the end of the \ifnum lines to stop TeX from
4176 % continuing to look for a <number>.
4178 \ifnum\lccode\expandafter`\thearg=0\relax
4179 \numericenumerate % a number (we hope)
4180 \else
4181 % It's a letter.
4182 \ifnum\lccode\expandafter`\thearg=\expandafter`\thearg\relax
4183 \lowercaseenumerate % lowercase letter
4184 \else
4185 \uppercaseenumerate % uppercase letter
4188 \else
4189 % Multiple tokens in the argument. We hope it's a number.
4190 \numericenumerate
4194 % An @enumerate whose labels are integers. The starting integer is
4195 % given in \thearg.
4197 \def\numericenumerate{%
4198 \itemno = \thearg
4199 \startenumeration{\the\itemno}%
4202 % The starting (lowercase) letter is in \thearg.
4203 \def\lowercaseenumerate{%
4204 \itemno = \expandafter`\thearg
4205 \startenumeration{%
4206 % Be sure we're not beyond the end of the alphabet.
4207 \ifnum\itemno=0
4208 \errmessage{No more lowercase letters in @enumerate; get a bigger
4209 alphabet}%
4211 \char\lccode\itemno
4215 % The starting (uppercase) letter is in \thearg.
4216 \def\uppercaseenumerate{%
4217 \itemno = \expandafter`\thearg
4218 \startenumeration{%
4219 % Be sure we're not beyond the end of the alphabet.
4220 \ifnum\itemno=0
4221 \errmessage{No more uppercase letters in @enumerate; get a bigger
4222 alphabet}
4224 \char\uccode\itemno
4228 % Call \doitemize, adding a period to the first argument and supplying the
4229 % common last two arguments. Also subtract one from the initial value in
4230 % \itemno, since @item increments \itemno.
4232 \def\startenumeration#1{%
4233 \advance\itemno by -1
4234 \doitemize{#1.}\flushcr
4237 % @alphaenumerate and @capsenumerate are abbreviations for giving an arg
4238 % to @enumerate.
4240 \def\alphaenumerate{\enumerate{a}}
4241 \def\capsenumerate{\enumerate{A}}
4242 \def\Ealphaenumerate{\Eenumerate}
4243 \def\Ecapsenumerate{\Eenumerate}
4246 % @multitable macros
4247 % Amy Hendrickson, 8/18/94, 3/6/96
4249 % @multitable ... @end multitable will make as many columns as desired.
4250 % Contents of each column will wrap at width given in preamble. Width
4251 % can be specified either with sample text given in a template line,
4252 % or in percent of \hsize, the current width of text on page.
4254 % Table can continue over pages but will only break between lines.
4256 % To make preamble:
4258 % Either define widths of columns in terms of percent of \hsize:
4259 % @multitable @columnfractions .25 .3 .45
4260 % @item ...
4262 % Numbers following @columnfractions are the percent of the total
4263 % current hsize to be used for each column. You may use as many
4264 % columns as desired.
4267 % Or use a template:
4268 % @multitable {Column 1 template} {Column 2 template} {Column 3 template}
4269 % @item ...
4270 % using the widest term desired in each column.
4272 % Each new table line starts with @item, each subsequent new column
4273 % starts with @tab. Empty columns may be produced by supplying @tab's
4274 % with nothing between them for as many times as empty columns are needed,
4275 % ie, @tab@tab@tab will produce two empty columns.
4277 % @item, @tab do not need to be on their own lines, but it will not hurt
4278 % if they are.
4280 % Sample multitable:
4282 % @multitable {Column 1 template} {Column 2 template} {Column 3 template}
4283 % @item first col stuff @tab second col stuff @tab third col
4284 % @item
4285 % first col stuff
4286 % @tab
4287 % second col stuff
4288 % @tab
4289 % third col
4290 % @item first col stuff @tab second col stuff
4291 % @tab Many paragraphs of text may be used in any column.
4293 % They will wrap at the width determined by the template.
4294 % @item@tab@tab This will be in third column.
4295 % @end multitable
4297 % Default dimensions may be reset by user.
4298 % @multitableparskip is vertical space between paragraphs in table.
4299 % @multitableparindent is paragraph indent in table.
4300 % @multitablecolmargin is horizontal space to be left between columns.
4301 % @multitablelinespace is space to leave between table items, baseline
4302 % to baseline.
4303 % 0pt means it depends on current normal line spacing.
4305 \newskip\multitableparskip
4306 \newskip\multitableparindent
4307 \newdimen\multitablecolspace
4308 \newskip\multitablelinespace
4309 \multitableparskip=0pt
4310 \multitableparindent=6pt
4311 \multitablecolspace=12pt
4312 \multitablelinespace=0pt
4314 % Macros used to set up halign preamble:
4316 \let\endsetuptable\relax
4317 \def\xendsetuptable{\endsetuptable}
4318 \let\columnfractions\relax
4319 \def\xcolumnfractions{\columnfractions}
4320 \newif\ifsetpercent
4322 % #1 is the @columnfraction, usually a decimal number like .5, but might
4323 % be just 1. We just use it, whatever it is.
4325 \def\pickupwholefraction#1 {%
4326 \global\advance\colcount by 1
4327 \expandafter\xdef\csname col\the\colcount\endcsname{#1\hsize}%
4328 \setuptable
4331 \newcount\colcount
4332 \def\setuptable#1{%
4333 \def\firstarg{#1}%
4334 \ifx\firstarg\xendsetuptable
4335 \let\go = \relax
4336 \else
4337 \ifx\firstarg\xcolumnfractions
4338 \global\setpercenttrue
4339 \else
4340 \ifsetpercent
4341 \let\go\pickupwholefraction
4342 \else
4343 \global\advance\colcount by 1
4344 \setbox0=\hbox{#1\unskip\space}% Add a normal word space as a
4345 % separator; typically that is always in the input, anyway.
4346 \expandafter\xdef\csname col\the\colcount\endcsname{\the\wd0}%
4349 \ifx\go\pickupwholefraction
4350 % Put the argument back for the \pickupwholefraction call, so
4351 % we'll always have a period there to be parsed.
4352 \def\go{\pickupwholefraction#1}%
4353 \else
4354 \let\go = \setuptable
4355 \fi%
4360 % multitable-only commands.
4362 % @headitem starts a heading row, which we typeset in bold. Assignments
4363 % have to be global since we are inside the implicit group of an
4364 % alignment entry. \everycr below resets \everytab so we don't have to
4365 % undo it ourselves.
4366 \def\headitemfont{\b}% for people to use in the template row; not changeable
4367 \def\headitem{%
4368 \checkenv\multitable
4369 \crcr
4370 \gdef\headitemcrhook{\nobreak}% attempt to avoid page break after headings
4371 \global\everytab={\bf}% can't use \headitemfont since the parsing differs
4372 \the\everytab % for the first item
4375 % default for tables with no headings.
4376 \let\headitemcrhook=\relax
4378 % A \tab used to include \hskip1sp. But then the space in a template
4379 % line is not enough. That is bad. So let's go back to just `&' until
4380 % we again encounter the problem the 1sp was intended to solve.
4381 % --karl, nathan@acm.org, 20apr99.
4382 \def\tab{\checkenv\multitable &\the\everytab}%
4384 % @multitable ... @end multitable definitions:
4386 \newtoks\everytab % insert after every tab.
4388 \envdef\multitable{%
4389 \vskip\parskip
4390 \startsavinginserts
4392 % @item within a multitable starts a normal row.
4393 % We use \def instead of \let so that if one of the multitable entries
4394 % contains an @itemize, we don't choke on the \item (seen as \crcr aka
4395 % \endtemplate) expanding \doitemize.
4396 \def\item{\crcr}%
4398 \tolerance=9500
4399 \hbadness=9500
4400 \setmultitablespacing
4401 \parskip=\multitableparskip
4402 \parindent=\multitableparindent
4403 \overfullrule=0pt
4404 \global\colcount=0
4406 \everycr = {%
4407 \noalign{%
4408 \global\everytab={}% Reset from possible headitem.
4409 \global\colcount=0 % Reset the column counter.
4411 % Check for saved footnotes, etc.:
4412 \checkinserts
4414 % Perhaps a \nobreak, then reset:
4415 \headitemcrhook
4416 \global\let\headitemcrhook=\relax
4420 \parsearg\domultitable
4422 \def\domultitable#1{%
4423 % To parse everything between @multitable and @item:
4424 \setuptable#1 \endsetuptable
4426 % This preamble sets up a generic column definition, which will
4427 % be used as many times as user calls for columns.
4428 % \vtop will set a single line and will also let text wrap and
4429 % continue for many paragraphs if desired.
4430 \halign\bgroup &%
4431 \global\advance\colcount by 1
4432 \multistrut
4433 \vtop{%
4434 % Use the current \colcount to find the correct column width:
4435 \hsize=\expandafter\csname col\the\colcount\endcsname
4437 % In order to keep entries from bumping into each other
4438 % we will add a \leftskip of \multitablecolspace to all columns after
4439 % the first one.
4441 % If a template has been used, we will add \multitablecolspace
4442 % to the width of each template entry.
4444 % If the user has set preamble in terms of percent of \hsize we will
4445 % use that dimension as the width of the column, and the \leftskip
4446 % will keep entries from bumping into each other. Table will start at
4447 % left margin and final column will justify at right margin.
4449 % Make sure we don't inherit \rightskip from the outer environment.
4450 \rightskip=0pt
4451 \ifnum\colcount=1
4452 % The first column will be indented with the surrounding text.
4453 \advance\hsize by\leftskip
4454 \else
4455 \ifsetpercent \else
4456 % If user has not set preamble in terms of percent of \hsize
4457 % we will advance \hsize by \multitablecolspace.
4458 \advance\hsize by \multitablecolspace
4460 % In either case we will make \leftskip=\multitablecolspace:
4461 \leftskip=\multitablecolspace
4463 % Ignoring space at the beginning and end avoids an occasional spurious
4464 % blank line, when TeX decides to break the line at the space before the
4465 % box from the multistrut, so the strut ends up on a line by itself.
4466 % For example:
4467 % @multitable @columnfractions .11 .89
4468 % @item @code{#}
4469 % @tab Legal holiday which is valid in major parts of the whole country.
4470 % Is automatically provided with highlighting sequences respectively
4471 % marking characters.
4472 \noindent\ignorespaces##\unskip\multistrut
4473 }\cr
4475 \def\Emultitable{%
4476 \crcr
4477 \egroup % end the \halign
4478 \global\setpercentfalse
4481 \def\setmultitablespacing{%
4482 \def\multistrut{\strut}% just use the standard line spacing
4484 % Compute \multitablelinespace (if not defined by user) for use in
4485 % \multitableparskip calculation. We used define \multistrut based on
4486 % this, but (ironically) that caused the spacing to be off.
4487 % See bug-texinfo report from Werner Lemberg, 31 Oct 2004 12:52:20 +0100.
4488 \ifdim\multitablelinespace=0pt
4489 \setbox0=\vbox{X}\global\multitablelinespace=\the\baselineskip
4490 \global\advance\multitablelinespace by-\ht0
4492 % Test to see if parskip is larger than space between lines of
4493 % table. If not, do nothing.
4494 % If so, set to same dimension as multitablelinespace.
4495 \ifdim\multitableparskip>\multitablelinespace
4496 \global\multitableparskip=\multitablelinespace
4497 \global\advance\multitableparskip-7pt % to keep parskip somewhat smaller
4498 % than skip between lines in the table.
4499 \fi%
4500 \ifdim\multitableparskip=0pt
4501 \global\multitableparskip=\multitablelinespace
4502 \global\advance\multitableparskip-7pt % to keep parskip somewhat smaller
4503 % than skip between lines in the table.
4504 \fi}
4507 \message{conditionals,}
4509 % @iftex, @ifnotdocbook, @ifnothtml, @ifnotinfo, @ifnotplaintext,
4510 % @ifnotxml always succeed. They currently do nothing; we don't
4511 % attempt to check whether the conditionals are properly nested. But we
4512 % have to remember that they are conditionals, so that @end doesn't
4513 % attempt to close an environment group.
4515 \def\makecond#1{%
4516 \expandafter\let\csname #1\endcsname = \relax
4517 \expandafter\let\csname iscond.#1\endcsname = 1
4519 \makecond{iftex}
4520 \makecond{ifnotdocbook}
4521 \makecond{ifnothtml}
4522 \makecond{ifnotinfo}
4523 \makecond{ifnotplaintext}
4524 \makecond{ifnotxml}
4526 % Ignore @ignore, @ifhtml, @ifinfo, and the like.
4528 \def\direntry{\doignore{direntry}}
4529 \def\documentdescription{\doignore{documentdescription}}
4530 \def\docbook{\doignore{docbook}}
4531 \def\html{\doignore{html}}
4532 \def\ifdocbook{\doignore{ifdocbook}}
4533 \def\ifhtml{\doignore{ifhtml}}
4534 \def\ifinfo{\doignore{ifinfo}}
4535 \def\ifnottex{\doignore{ifnottex}}
4536 \def\ifplaintext{\doignore{ifplaintext}}
4537 \def\ifxml{\doignore{ifxml}}
4538 \def\ignore{\doignore{ignore}}
4539 \def\menu{\doignore{menu}}
4540 \def\xml{\doignore{xml}}
4542 % Ignore text until a line `@end #1', keeping track of nested conditionals.
4544 % A count to remember the depth of nesting.
4545 \newcount\doignorecount
4547 \def\doignore#1{\begingroup
4548 % Scan in ``verbatim'' mode:
4549 \obeylines
4550 \catcode`\@ = \other
4551 \catcode`\{ = \other
4552 \catcode`\} = \other
4554 % Make sure that spaces turn into tokens that match what \doignoretext wants.
4555 \spaceisspace
4557 % Count number of #1's that we've seen.
4558 \doignorecount = 0
4560 % Swallow text until we reach the matching `@end #1'.
4561 \dodoignore{#1}%
4564 { \catcode`_=11 % We want to use \_STOP_ which cannot appear in texinfo source.
4565 \obeylines %
4567 \gdef\dodoignore#1{%
4568 % #1 contains the command name as a string, e.g., `ifinfo'.
4570 % Define a command to find the next `@end #1'.
4571 \long\def\doignoretext##1^^M@end #1{%
4572 \doignoretextyyy##1^^M@#1\_STOP_}%
4574 % And this command to find another #1 command, at the beginning of a
4575 % line. (Otherwise, we would consider a line `@c @ifset', for
4576 % example, to count as an @ifset for nesting.)
4577 \long\def\doignoretextyyy##1^^M@#1##2\_STOP_{\doignoreyyy{##2}\_STOP_}%
4579 % And now expand that command.
4580 \doignoretext ^^M%
4584 \def\doignoreyyy#1{%
4585 \def\temp{#1}%
4586 \ifx\temp\empty % Nothing found.
4587 \let\next\doignoretextzzz
4588 \else % Found a nested condition, ...
4589 \advance\doignorecount by 1
4590 \let\next\doignoretextyyy % ..., look for another.
4591 % If we're here, #1 ends with ^^M\ifinfo (for example).
4593 \next #1% the token \_STOP_ is present just after this macro.
4596 % We have to swallow the remaining "\_STOP_".
4598 \def\doignoretextzzz#1{%
4599 \ifnum\doignorecount = 0 % We have just found the outermost @end.
4600 \let\next\enddoignore
4601 \else % Still inside a nested condition.
4602 \advance\doignorecount by -1
4603 \let\next\doignoretext % Look for the next @end.
4605 \next
4608 % Finish off ignored text.
4609 { \obeylines%
4610 % Ignore anything after the last `@end #1'; this matters in verbatim
4611 % environments, where otherwise the newline after an ignored conditional
4612 % would result in a blank line in the output.
4613 \gdef\enddoignore#1^^M{\endgroup\ignorespaces}%
4617 % @set VAR sets the variable VAR to an empty value.
4618 % @set VAR REST-OF-LINE sets VAR to the value REST-OF-LINE.
4620 % Since we want to separate VAR from REST-OF-LINE (which might be
4621 % empty), we can't just use \parsearg; we have to insert a space of our
4622 % own to delimit the rest of the line, and then take it out again if we
4623 % didn't need it.
4624 % We rely on the fact that \parsearg sets \catcode`\ =10.
4626 \parseargdef\set{\setyyy#1 \endsetyyy}
4627 \def\setyyy#1 #2\endsetyyy{%
4629 \makevalueexpandable
4630 \def\temp{#2}%
4631 \edef\next{\gdef\makecsname{SET#1}}%
4632 \ifx\temp\empty
4633 \next{}%
4634 \else
4635 \setzzz#2\endsetzzz
4639 % Remove the trailing space \setxxx inserted.
4640 \def\setzzz#1 \endsetzzz{\next{#1}}
4642 % @clear VAR clears (i.e., unsets) the variable VAR.
4644 \parseargdef\clear{%
4646 \makevalueexpandable
4647 \global\expandafter\let\csname SET#1\endcsname=\relax
4651 % @value{foo} gets the text saved in variable foo.
4652 \def\value{\begingroup\makevalueexpandable\valuexxx}
4653 \def\valuexxx#1{\expandablevalue{#1}\endgroup}
4655 \catcode`\-=\active \catcode`\_=\active
4657 \gdef\makevalueexpandable{%
4658 \let\value = \expandablevalue
4659 % We don't want these characters active, ...
4660 \catcode`\-=\other \catcode`\_=\other
4661 % ..., but we might end up with active ones in the argument if
4662 % we're called from @code, as @code{@value{foo-bar_}}, though.
4663 % So \let them to their normal equivalents.
4664 \let-\normaldash \let_\normalunderscore
4668 % We have this subroutine so that we can handle at least some @value's
4669 % properly in indexes (we call \makevalueexpandable in \indexdummies).
4670 % The command has to be fully expandable (if the variable is set), since
4671 % the result winds up in the index file. This means that if the
4672 % variable's value contains other Texinfo commands, it's almost certain
4673 % it will fail (although perhaps we could fix that with sufficient work
4674 % to do a one-level expansion on the result, instead of complete).
4676 % Unfortunately, this has the consequence that when _ is in the *value*
4677 % of an @set, it does not print properly in the roman fonts (get the cmr
4678 % dot accent at position 126 instead). No fix comes to mind, and it's
4679 % been this way since 2003 or earlier, so just ignore it.
4681 \def\expandablevalue#1{%
4682 \expandafter\ifx\csname SET#1\endcsname\relax
4683 {[No value for ``#1'']}%
4684 \message{Variable `#1', used in @value, is not set.}%
4685 \else
4686 \csname SET#1\endcsname
4690 % Like \expandablevalue, but completely expandable (the \message in the
4691 % definition above operates at the execution level of TeX). Used when
4692 % writing to auxiliary files, due to the expansion that \write does.
4693 % If flag is undefined, pass through an unexpanded @value command: maybe it
4694 % will be set by the time it is read back in.
4696 % NB flag names containing - or _ may not work here.
4697 \def\dummyvalue#1{%
4698 \expandafter\ifx\csname SET#1\endcsname\relax
4699 \noexpand\value{#1}%
4700 \else
4701 \csname SET#1\endcsname
4705 % Used for @value's in index entries to form the sort key: expand the @value
4706 % if possible, otherwise sort late.
4707 \def\indexnofontsvalue#1{%
4708 \expandafter\ifx\csname SET#1\endcsname\relax
4709 ZZZZZZZ
4710 \else
4711 \csname SET#1\endcsname
4715 % @ifset VAR ... @end ifset reads the `...' iff VAR has been defined
4716 % with @set.
4718 % To get the special treatment we need for `@end ifset,' we call
4719 % \makecond and then redefine.
4721 \makecond{ifset}
4722 \def\ifset{\parsearg{\doifset{\let\next=\ifsetfail}}}
4723 \def\doifset#1#2{%
4725 \makevalueexpandable
4726 \let\next=\empty
4727 \expandafter\ifx\csname SET#2\endcsname\relax
4728 #1% If not set, redefine \next.
4730 \expandafter
4731 }\next
4733 \def\ifsetfail{\doignore{ifset}}
4735 % @ifclear VAR ... @end executes the `...' iff VAR has never been
4736 % defined with @set, or has been undefined with @clear.
4738 % The `\else' inside the `\doifset' parameter is a trick to reuse the
4739 % above code: if the variable is not set, do nothing, if it is set,
4740 % then redefine \next to \ifclearfail.
4742 \makecond{ifclear}
4743 \def\ifclear{\parsearg{\doifset{\else \let\next=\ifclearfail}}}
4744 \def\ifclearfail{\doignore{ifclear}}
4746 % @ifcommandisdefined CMD ... @end executes the `...' if CMD (written
4747 % without the @) is in fact defined. We can only feasibly check at the
4748 % TeX level, so something like `mathcode' is going to considered
4749 % defined even though it is not a Texinfo command.
4751 \makecond{ifcommanddefined}
4752 \def\ifcommanddefined{\parsearg{\doifcmddefined{\let\next=\ifcmddefinedfail}}}
4754 \def\doifcmddefined#1#2{{%
4755 \makevalueexpandable
4756 \let\next=\empty
4757 \expandafter\ifx\csname #2\endcsname\relax
4758 #1% If not defined, \let\next as above.
4760 \expandafter
4761 }\next
4763 \def\ifcmddefinedfail{\doignore{ifcommanddefined}}
4765 % @ifcommandnotdefined CMD ... handled similar to @ifclear above.
4766 \makecond{ifcommandnotdefined}
4767 \def\ifcommandnotdefined{%
4768 \parsearg{\doifcmddefined{\else \let\next=\ifcmdnotdefinedfail}}}
4769 \def\ifcmdnotdefinedfail{\doignore{ifcommandnotdefined}}
4771 % Set the `txicommandconditionals' variable, so documents have a way to
4772 % test if the @ifcommand...defined conditionals are available.
4773 \set txicommandconditionals
4775 % @dircategory CATEGORY -- specify a category of the dir file
4776 % which this file should belong to. Ignore this in TeX.
4777 \let\dircategory=\comment
4779 % @defininfoenclose.
4780 \let\definfoenclose=\comment
4783 \message{indexing,}
4784 % Index generation facilities
4786 % Define \newwrite to be identical to plain tex's \newwrite
4787 % except not \outer, so it can be used within macros and \if's.
4788 \edef\newwrite{\makecsname{ptexnewwrite}}
4790 % \newindex {foo} defines an index named IX.
4791 % It automatically defines \IXindex such that
4792 % \IXindex ...rest of line... puts an entry in the index IX.
4793 % It also defines \IXindfile to be the number of the output channel for
4794 % the file that accumulates this index. The file's extension is IX.
4795 % The name of an index should be no more than 2 characters long
4796 % for the sake of vms.
4798 \def\newindex#1{%
4799 \expandafter\chardef\csname#1indfile\endcsname=0
4800 \expandafter\xdef\csname#1index\endcsname{% % Define @#1index
4801 \noexpand\doindex{#1}}
4804 % @defindex foo == \newindex{foo}
4806 \def\defindex{\parsearg\newindex}
4808 % Define @defcodeindex, like @defindex except put all entries in @code.
4810 \def\defcodeindex{\parsearg\newcodeindex}
4812 \def\newcodeindex#1{%
4813 \expandafter\chardef\csname#1indfile\endcsname=0
4814 \expandafter\xdef\csname#1index\endcsname{%
4815 \noexpand\docodeindex{#1}}%
4818 % The default indices:
4819 \newindex{cp}% concepts,
4820 \newcodeindex{fn}% functions,
4821 \newcodeindex{vr}% variables,
4822 \newcodeindex{tp}% types,
4823 \newcodeindex{ky}% keys
4824 \newcodeindex{pg}% and programs.
4827 % @synindex foo bar makes index foo feed into index bar.
4828 % Do this instead of @defindex foo if you don't want it as a separate index.
4830 % @syncodeindex foo bar similar, but put all entries made for index foo
4831 % inside @code.
4833 \def\synindex#1 #2 {\dosynindex\doindex{#1}{#2}}
4834 \def\syncodeindex#1 #2 {\dosynindex\docodeindex{#1}{#2}}
4836 % #1 is \doindex or \docodeindex, #2 the index getting redefined (foo),
4837 % #3 the target index (bar).
4838 \def\dosynindex#1#2#3{%
4839 \requireopenindexfile{#3}%
4840 % redefine \fooindfile:
4841 \expandafter\let\expandafter\temp\expandafter=\csname#3indfile\endcsname
4842 \expandafter\let\csname#2indfile\endcsname=\temp
4843 % redefine \fooindex:
4844 \expandafter\xdef\csname#2index\endcsname{\noexpand#1{#3}}%
4847 % Define \doindex, the driver for all index macros.
4848 % Argument #1 is generated by the calling \fooindex macro,
4849 % and it is the two-letter name of the index.
4851 \def\doindex#1{\edef\indexname{#1}\parsearg\doindexxxx}
4852 \def\doindexxxx #1{\doind{\indexname}{#1}}
4854 % like the previous two, but they put @code around the argument.
4855 \def\docodeindex#1{\edef\indexname{#1}\parsearg\docodeindexxxx}
4856 \def\docodeindexxxx #1{\doind{\indexname}{\code{#1}}}
4859 % Used when writing an index entry out to an index file to prevent
4860 % expansion of Texinfo commands that can appear in an index entry.
4862 \def\indexdummies{%
4863 \escapechar = `\\ % use backslash in output files.
4864 \definedummyletter\@%
4865 \definedummyletter\ %
4867 % For texindex which always views { and } as separators.
4868 \def\{{\lbracechar{}}%
4869 \def\}{\rbracechar{}}%
4871 % Do the redefinitions.
4872 \definedummies
4875 % Used for the aux and toc files, where @ is the escape character.
4877 \def\atdummies{%
4878 \definedummyletter\@%
4879 \definedummyletter\ %
4880 \definedummyletter\{%
4881 \definedummyletter\}%
4883 % Do the redefinitions.
4884 \definedummies
4885 \otherbackslash
4888 % \definedummyword defines \#1 as \string\#1\space, thus effectively
4889 % preventing its expansion. This is used only for control words,
4890 % not control letters, because the \space would be incorrect for
4891 % control characters, but is needed to separate the control word
4892 % from whatever follows.
4894 % These can be used both for control words that take an argument and
4895 % those that do not. If it is followed by {arg} in the input, then
4896 % that will dutifully get written to the index (or wherever).
4898 % For control letters, we have \definedummyletter, which omits the
4899 % space.
4901 \def\definedummyword #1{\def#1{\string#1\space}}%
4902 \def\definedummyletter#1{\def#1{\string#1}}%
4903 \let\definedummyaccent\definedummyletter
4905 % Called from \indexdummies and \atdummies, to effectively prevent
4906 % the expansion of commands.
4908 \def\definedummies{%
4910 \let\commondummyword\definedummyword
4911 \let\commondummyletter\definedummyletter
4912 \let\commondummyaccent\definedummyaccent
4913 \commondummiesnofonts
4915 \definedummyletter\_%
4916 \definedummyletter\-%
4918 % Non-English letters.
4919 \definedummyword\AA
4920 \definedummyword\AE
4921 \definedummyword\DH
4922 \definedummyword\L
4923 \definedummyword\O
4924 \definedummyword\OE
4925 \definedummyword\TH
4926 \definedummyword\aa
4927 \definedummyword\ae
4928 \definedummyword\dh
4929 \definedummyword\exclamdown
4930 \definedummyword\l
4931 \definedummyword\o
4932 \definedummyword\oe
4933 \definedummyword\ordf
4934 \definedummyword\ordm
4935 \definedummyword\questiondown
4936 \definedummyword\ss
4937 \definedummyword\th
4939 % Although these internal commands shouldn't show up, sometimes they do.
4940 \definedummyword\bf
4941 \definedummyword\gtr
4942 \definedummyword\hat
4943 \definedummyword\less
4944 \definedummyword\sf
4945 \definedummyword\sl
4946 \definedummyword\tclose
4947 \definedummyword\tt
4949 \definedummyword\LaTeX
4950 \definedummyword\TeX
4952 % Assorted special characters.
4953 \definedummyword\atchar
4954 \definedummyword\arrow
4955 \definedummyword\bullet
4956 \definedummyword\comma
4957 \definedummyword\copyright
4958 \definedummyword\registeredsymbol
4959 \definedummyword\dots
4960 \definedummyword\enddots
4961 \definedummyword\entrybreak
4962 \definedummyword\equiv
4963 \definedummyword\error
4964 \definedummyword\euro
4965 \definedummyword\expansion
4966 \definedummyword\geq
4967 \definedummyword\guillemetleft
4968 \definedummyword\guillemetright
4969 \definedummyword\guilsinglleft
4970 \definedummyword\guilsinglright
4971 \definedummyword\lbracechar
4972 \definedummyword\leq
4973 \definedummyword\mathopsup
4974 \definedummyword\minus
4975 \definedummyword\ogonek
4976 \definedummyword\pounds
4977 \definedummyword\point
4978 \definedummyword\print
4979 \definedummyword\quotedblbase
4980 \definedummyword\quotedblleft
4981 \definedummyword\quotedblright
4982 \definedummyword\quoteleft
4983 \definedummyword\quoteright
4984 \definedummyword\quotesinglbase
4985 \definedummyword\rbracechar
4986 \definedummyword\result
4987 \definedummyword\sub
4988 \definedummyword\sup
4989 \definedummyword\textdegree
4991 % We want to disable all macros so that they are not expanded by \write.
4992 \macrolist
4993 \let\value\dummyvalue
4995 \normalturnoffactive
4998 % \commondummiesnofonts: common to \definedummies and \indexnofonts.
4999 % Define \commondummyletter, \commondummyaccent and \commondummyword before
5000 % using. Used for accents, font commands, and various control letters.
5002 \def\commondummiesnofonts{%
5003 % Control letters and accents.
5004 \commondummyletter\!%
5005 \commondummyaccent\"%
5006 \commondummyaccent\'%
5007 \commondummyletter\*%
5008 \commondummyaccent\,%
5009 \commondummyletter\.%
5010 \commondummyletter\/%
5011 \commondummyletter\:%
5012 \commondummyaccent\=%
5013 \commondummyletter\?%
5014 \commondummyaccent\^%
5015 \commondummyaccent\`%
5016 \commondummyaccent\~%
5017 \commondummyword\u
5018 \commondummyword\v
5019 \commondummyword\H
5020 \commondummyword\dotaccent
5021 \commondummyword\ogonek
5022 \commondummyword\ringaccent
5023 \commondummyword\tieaccent
5024 \commondummyword\ubaraccent
5025 \commondummyword\udotaccent
5026 \commondummyword\dotless
5028 % Texinfo font commands.
5029 \commondummyword\b
5030 \commondummyword\i
5031 \commondummyword\r
5032 \commondummyword\sansserif
5033 \commondummyword\sc
5034 \commondummyword\slanted
5035 \commondummyword\t
5037 % Commands that take arguments.
5038 \commondummyword\abbr
5039 \commondummyword\acronym
5040 \commondummyword\anchor
5041 \commondummyword\cite
5042 \commondummyword\code
5043 \commondummyword\command
5044 \commondummyword\dfn
5045 \commondummyword\dmn
5046 \commondummyword\email
5047 \commondummyword\emph
5048 \commondummyword\env
5049 \commondummyword\file
5050 \commondummyword\image
5051 \commondummyword\indicateurl
5052 \commondummyword\inforef
5053 \commondummyword\kbd
5054 \commondummyword\key
5055 \commondummyword\math
5056 \commondummyword\option
5057 \commondummyword\pxref
5058 \commondummyword\ref
5059 \commondummyword\samp
5060 \commondummyword\strong
5061 \commondummyword\tie
5062 \commondummyword\U
5063 \commondummyword\uref
5064 \commondummyword\url
5065 \commondummyword\var
5066 \commondummyword\verb
5067 \commondummyword\w
5068 \commondummyword\xref
5071 % For testing: output @{ and @} in index sort strings as \{ and \}.
5072 \newif\ifusebracesinindexes
5074 \let\indexlbrace\relax
5075 \let\indexrbrace\relax
5077 {\catcode`\@=0
5078 \catcode`\\=13
5079 @gdef@backslashdisappear{@def\{}}
5083 \catcode`\<=13
5084 \catcode`\-=13
5085 \catcode`\`=13
5086 \gdef\indexnonalnumdisappear{%
5087 \expandafter\ifx\csname SETtxiindexlquoteignore\endcsname\relax\else
5088 % @set txiindexlquoteignore makes us ignore left quotes in the sort term.
5089 % (Introduced for FSFS 2nd ed.)
5090 \let`=\empty
5093 \expandafter\ifx\csname SETtxiindexbackslashignore\endcsname\relax\else
5094 \backslashdisappear
5097 \expandafter\ifx\csname SETtxiindexhyphenignore\endcsname\relax\else
5098 \def-{}%
5100 \expandafter\ifx\csname SETtxiindexlessthanignore\endcsname\relax\else
5101 \def<{}%
5103 \expandafter\ifx\csname SETtxiindexatsignignore\endcsname\relax\else
5104 \def\@{}%
5108 \gdef\indexnonalnumreappear{%
5109 \useindexbackslash
5110 \let-\normaldash
5111 \let<\normalless
5112 \def\@{@}%
5117 % \indexnofonts is used when outputting the strings to sort the index
5118 % by, and when constructing control sequence names. It eliminates all
5119 % control sequences and just writes whatever the best ASCII sort string
5120 % would be for a given command (usually its argument).
5122 \def\indexnofonts{%
5123 % Accent commands should become @asis.
5124 \def\commondummyaccent##1{\let##1\asis}%
5125 % We can just ignore other control letters.
5126 \def\commondummyletter##1{\let##1\empty}%
5127 % All control words become @asis by default; overrides below.
5128 \let\commondummyword\commondummyaccent
5129 \commondummiesnofonts
5131 % Don't no-op \tt, since it isn't a user-level command
5132 % and is used in the definitions of the active chars like <, >, |, etc.
5133 % Likewise with the other plain tex font commands.
5134 %\let\tt=\asis
5136 \def\ { }%
5137 \def\@{@}%
5138 \def\_{\normalunderscore}%
5139 \def\-{}% @- shouldn't affect sorting
5141 \uccode`\1=`\{ \uppercase{\def\{{1}}%
5142 \uccode`\1=`\} \uppercase{\def\}{1}}%
5143 \let\lbracechar\{%
5144 \let\rbracechar\}%
5146 % Non-English letters.
5147 \def\AA{AA}%
5148 \def\AE{AE}%
5149 \def\DH{DZZ}%
5150 \def\L{L}%
5151 \def\OE{OE}%
5152 \def\O{O}%
5153 \def\TH{TH}%
5154 \def\aa{aa}%
5155 \def\ae{ae}%
5156 \def\dh{dzz}%
5157 \def\exclamdown{!}%
5158 \def\l{l}%
5159 \def\oe{oe}%
5160 \def\ordf{a}%
5161 \def\ordm{o}%
5162 \def\o{o}%
5163 \def\questiondown{?}%
5164 \def\ss{ss}%
5165 \def\th{th}%
5167 \def\LaTeX{LaTeX}%
5168 \def\TeX{TeX}%
5170 % Assorted special characters. \defglyph gives the control sequence a
5171 % definition that removes the {} that follows its use.
5172 \defglyph\atchar{@}%
5173 \defglyph\arrow{->}%
5174 \defglyph\bullet{bullet}%
5175 \defglyph\comma{,}%
5176 \defglyph\copyright{copyright}%
5177 \defglyph\dots{...}%
5178 \defglyph\enddots{...}%
5179 \defglyph\equiv{==}%
5180 \defglyph\error{error}%
5181 \defglyph\euro{euro}%
5182 \defglyph\expansion{==>}%
5183 \defglyph\geq{>=}%
5184 \defglyph\guillemetleft{<<}%
5185 \defglyph\guillemetright{>>}%
5186 \defglyph\guilsinglleft{<}%
5187 \defglyph\guilsinglright{>}%
5188 \defglyph\leq{<=}%
5189 \defglyph\lbracechar{\{}%
5190 \defglyph\minus{-}%
5191 \defglyph\point{.}%
5192 \defglyph\pounds{pounds}%
5193 \defglyph\print{-|}%
5194 \defglyph\quotedblbase{"}%
5195 \defglyph\quotedblleft{"}%
5196 \defglyph\quotedblright{"}%
5197 \defglyph\quoteleft{`}%
5198 \defglyph\quoteright{'}%
5199 \defglyph\quotesinglbase{,}%
5200 \defglyph\rbracechar{\}}%
5201 \defglyph\registeredsymbol{R}%
5202 \defglyph\result{=>}%
5203 \defglyph\textdegree{o}%
5205 % We need to get rid of all macros, leaving only the arguments (if present).
5206 % Of course this is not nearly correct, but it is the best we can do for now.
5207 % makeinfo does not expand macros in the argument to @deffn, which ends up
5208 % writing an index entry, and texindex isn't prepared for an index sort entry
5209 % that starts with \.
5211 % Since macro invocations are followed by braces, we can just redefine them
5212 % to take a single TeX argument. The case of a macro invocation that
5213 % goes to end-of-line is not handled.
5215 \macrolist
5216 \let\value\indexnofontsvalue
5218 \def\defglyph#1#2{\def#1##1{#2}} % see above
5223 \let\SETmarginindex=\relax % put index entries in margin (undocumented)?
5225 % Most index entries go through here, but \dosubind is the general case.
5226 % #1 is the index name, #2 is the entry text.
5227 \def\doind#1#2{\dosubind{#1}{#2}{}}
5229 % There is also \dosubind {index}{topic}{subtopic}
5230 % which makes an entry in a two-level index such as the operation index.
5231 % TODO: Two-level index? Operation index?
5233 % Workhorse for all indexes.
5234 % #1 is name of index, #2 is stuff to put there, #3 is subentry --
5235 % empty if called from \doind, as we usually are (the main exception
5236 % is with most defuns, which call us directly).
5238 \def\dosubind#1#2#3{%
5239 \iflinks
5241 \requireopenindexfile{#1}%
5242 % Store the main index entry text (including the third arg).
5243 \toks0 = {#2}%
5244 % If third arg is present, precede it with a space.
5245 \def\thirdarg{#3}%
5246 \ifx\thirdarg\empty \else
5247 \toks0 = \expandafter{\the\toks0 \space #3}%
5250 \edef\writeto{\csname#1indfile\endcsname}%
5252 \safewhatsit\dosubindwrite
5257 % Check if an index file has been opened, and if not, open it.
5258 \def\requireopenindexfile#1{%
5259 \ifnum\csname #1indfile\endcsname=0
5260 \expandafter\newwrite \csname#1indfile\endcsname
5261 \edef\suffix{#1}%
5262 % A .fls suffix would conflict with the file extension for the output
5263 % of -recorder, so use .f1s instead.
5264 \ifx\suffix\indexisfl\def\suffix{f1}\fi
5265 % Open the file
5266 \immediate\openout\csname#1indfile\endcsname \jobname.\suffix
5267 % Using \immediate above here prevents an object entering into the current
5268 % box, which could confound checks such as those in \safewhatsit for
5269 % preceding skips.
5270 \typeout{Writing index file \jobname.\suffix}%
5271 \fi}
5272 \def\indexisfl{fl}
5274 % Output \ as {\indexbackslash}, because \ is an escape character in
5275 % the index files.
5276 \let\indexbackslash=\relax
5277 {\catcode`\@=0 \catcode`\\=\active
5278 @gdef@useindexbackslash{@def\{{@indexbackslash}}}
5281 % Definition for writing index entry text.
5282 \def\sortas#1{\ignorespaces}%
5284 % Definition for writing index entry sort key. Should occur at the at
5285 % the beginning of the index entry, like
5286 % @cindex @sortas{september} \september
5287 % The \ignorespaces takes care of following space, but there's no way
5288 % to remove space before it.
5290 \catcode`\-=13
5291 \gdef\indexwritesortas{%
5292 \begingroup
5293 \indexnonalnumreappear
5294 \indexwritesortasxxx}
5295 \gdef\indexwritesortasxxx#1{%
5296 \xdef\indexsortkey{#1}\endgroup}
5300 % Write the entry in \toks0 to the index file.
5302 \def\dosubindwrite{%
5303 % Put the index entry in the margin if desired.
5304 \ifx\SETmarginindex\relax\else
5305 \insert\margin{\hbox{\vrule height8pt depth3pt width0pt \the\toks0}}%
5308 % Remember, we are within a group.
5309 \indexdummies % Must do this here, since \bf, etc expand at this stage
5310 \useindexbackslash % \indexbackslash isn't defined now so it will be output
5311 % as is; and it will print as backslash.
5312 % The braces around \indexbrace are recognized by texindex.
5314 % Get the string to sort by, by processing the index entry with all
5315 % font commands turned off.
5316 {\indexnofonts
5317 \def\lbracechar{{\indexlbrace}}%
5318 \def\rbracechar{{\indexrbrace}}%
5319 \let\{=\lbracechar
5320 \let\}=\rbracechar
5321 \indexnonalnumdisappear
5322 \xdef\indexsortkey{}%
5323 \let\sortas=\indexwritesortas
5324 \edef\temp{\the\toks0}%
5325 \setbox\dummybox = \hbox{\temp}% Make sure to execute any \sortas
5326 \ifx\indexsortkey\empty
5327 \xdef\indexsortkey{\temp}%
5328 \ifx\indexsortkey\empty\xdef\indexsortkey{ }\fi
5332 % Set up the complete index entry, with both the sort key and
5333 % the original text, including any font commands. We write
5334 % three arguments to \entry to the .?? file (four in the
5335 % subentry case), texindex reduces to two when writing the .??s
5336 % sorted result.
5337 \edef\temp{%
5338 \write\writeto{%
5339 \string\entry{\indexsortkey}{\noexpand\folio}{\the\toks0}}%
5341 \temp
5343 \newbox\dummybox % used above
5345 % Take care of unwanted page breaks/skips around a whatsit:
5347 % If a skip is the last thing on the list now, preserve it
5348 % by backing up by \lastskip, doing the \write, then inserting
5349 % the skip again. Otherwise, the whatsit generated by the
5350 % \write or \pdfdest will make \lastskip zero. The result is that
5351 % sequences like this:
5352 % @end defun
5353 % @tindex whatever
5354 % @defun ...
5355 % will have extra space inserted, because the \medbreak in the
5356 % start of the @defun won't see the skip inserted by the @end of
5357 % the previous defun.
5359 % But don't do any of this if we're not in vertical mode. We
5360 % don't want to do a \vskip and prematurely end a paragraph.
5362 % Avoid page breaks due to these extra skips, too.
5364 % But wait, there is a catch there:
5365 % We'll have to check whether \lastskip is zero skip. \ifdim is not
5366 % sufficient for this purpose, as it ignores stretch and shrink parts
5367 % of the skip. The only way seems to be to check the textual
5368 % representation of the skip.
5370 % The following is almost like \def\zeroskipmacro{0.0pt} except that
5371 % the ``p'' and ``t'' characters have catcode \other, not 11 (letter).
5373 \edef\zeroskipmacro{\expandafter\the\csname z@skip\endcsname}
5375 \newskip\whatsitskip
5376 \newcount\whatsitpenalty
5378 % ..., ready, GO:
5380 \def\safewhatsit#1{\ifhmode
5382 \else
5383 % \lastskip and \lastpenalty cannot both be nonzero simultaneously.
5384 \whatsitskip = \lastskip
5385 \edef\lastskipmacro{\the\lastskip}%
5386 \whatsitpenalty = \lastpenalty
5388 % If \lastskip is nonzero, that means the last item was a
5389 % skip. And since a skip is discardable, that means this
5390 % -\whatsitskip glue we're inserting is preceded by a
5391 % non-discardable item, therefore it is not a potential
5392 % breakpoint, therefore no \nobreak needed.
5393 \ifx\lastskipmacro\zeroskipmacro
5394 \else
5395 \vskip-\whatsitskip
5400 \ifx\lastskipmacro\zeroskipmacro
5401 % If \lastskip was zero, perhaps the last item was a penalty, and
5402 % perhaps it was >=10000, e.g., a \nobreak. In that case, we want
5403 % to re-insert the same penalty (values >10000 are used for various
5404 % signals); since we just inserted a non-discardable item, any
5405 % following glue (such as a \parskip) would be a breakpoint. For example:
5406 % @deffn deffn-whatever
5407 % @vindex index-whatever
5408 % Description.
5409 % would allow a break between the index-whatever whatsit
5410 % and the "Description." paragraph.
5411 \ifnum\whatsitpenalty>9999 \penalty\whatsitpenalty \fi
5412 \else
5413 % On the other hand, if we had a nonzero \lastskip,
5414 % this make-up glue would be preceded by a non-discardable item
5415 % (the whatsit from the \write), so we must insert a \nobreak.
5416 \nobreak\vskip\whatsitskip
5418 \fi}
5420 % The index entry written in the file actually looks like
5421 % \entry {sortstring}{page}{topic}
5422 % or
5423 % \entry {sortstring}{page}{topic}{subtopic}
5424 % The texindex program reads in these files and writes files
5425 % containing these kinds of lines:
5426 % \initial {c}
5427 % before the first topic whose initial is c
5428 % \entry {topic}{pagelist}
5429 % for a topic that is used without subtopics
5430 % \primary {topic}
5431 % for the beginning of a topic that is used with subtopics
5432 % \secondary {subtopic}{pagelist}
5433 % for each subtopic.
5435 % Define the user-accessible indexing commands
5436 % @findex, @vindex, @kindex, @cindex.
5438 \def\findex {\fnindex}
5439 \def\kindex {\kyindex}
5440 \def\cindex {\cpindex}
5441 \def\vindex {\vrindex}
5442 \def\tindex {\tpindex}
5443 \def\pindex {\pgindex}
5445 \def\cindexsub {\begingroup\obeylines\cindexsub}
5446 {\obeylines %
5447 \gdef\cindexsub "#1" #2^^M{\endgroup %
5448 \dosubind{cp}{#2}{#1}}}
5450 % Define the macros used in formatting output of the sorted index material.
5452 % @printindex causes a particular index (the ??s file) to get printed.
5453 % It does not print any chapter heading (usually an @unnumbered).
5455 \parseargdef\printindex{\begingroup
5456 \dobreak \chapheadingskip{10000}%
5458 \smallfonts \rm
5459 \tolerance = 9500
5460 \plainfrenchspacing
5461 \everypar = {}% don't want the \kern\-parindent from indentation suppression.
5463 % See if the index file exists and is nonempty.
5464 % Change catcode of @ here so that if the index file contains
5465 % \initial {@}
5466 % as its first line, TeX doesn't complain about mismatched braces
5467 % (because it thinks @} is a control sequence).
5468 \catcode`\@ = 12
5469 % See comment in \requireopenindexfile.
5470 \def\indexname{#1}\ifx\indexname\indexisfl\def\indexname{f1}\fi
5471 \openin 1 \jobname.\indexname s
5472 \ifeof 1
5473 % \enddoublecolumns gets confused if there is no text in the index,
5474 % and it loses the chapter title and the aux file entries for the
5475 % index. The easiest way to prevent this problem is to make sure
5476 % there is some text.
5477 \putwordIndexNonexistent
5478 \typeout{No file \jobname.\indexname s.}%
5479 \else
5480 \catcode`\\ = 0
5482 % If the index file exists but is empty, then \openin leaves \ifeof
5483 % false. We have to make TeX try to read something from the file, so
5484 % it can discover if there is anything in it.
5485 \read 1 to \thisline
5486 \ifeof 1
5487 \putwordIndexIsEmpty
5488 \else
5489 % Index files are almost Texinfo source, but we use \ as the escape
5490 % character. It would be better to use @, but that's too big a change
5491 % to make right now.
5492 \def\indexbackslash{\ttbackslash}%
5493 \let\indexlbrace\{ % Likewise, set these sequences for braces
5494 \let\indexrbrace\} % used in the sort key.
5495 \begindoublecolumns
5496 \let\dotheinsertentrybox\dotheinsertentryboxwithpenalty
5498 % Read input from the index file line by line.
5499 \loopdo
5500 \ifeof1 \else
5501 \read 1 to \nextline
5504 \indexinputprocessing
5505 \thisline
5507 \ifeof1\else
5508 \let\thisline\nextline
5509 \repeat
5511 \enddoublecolumns
5514 \closein 1
5515 \endgroup}
5516 \def\loopdo#1\repeat{\def\body{#1}\loopdoxxx}
5517 \def\loopdoxxx{\let\next=\relax\body\let\next=\loopdoxxx\fi\next}
5519 \def\indexinputprocessing{%
5520 \ifeof1
5521 \let\firsttoken\relax
5522 \else
5523 \edef\act{\gdef\noexpand\firsttoken{\getfirsttoken\nextline}}%
5524 \act
5527 \def\getfirsttoken#1{\expandafter\getfirsttokenx#1\endfirsttoken}
5528 \long\def\getfirsttokenx#1#2\endfirsttoken{\noexpand#1}
5531 % These macros are used by the sorted index file itself.
5532 % Change them to control the appearance of the index.
5534 {\catcode`\/=13 \catcode`\-=13 \catcode`\^=13 \catcode`\~=13 \catcode`\_=13
5535 \catcode`\|=13 \catcode`\<=13 \catcode`\>=13 \catcode`\+=13 \catcode`\"=13
5536 \catcode`\$=3
5537 \gdef\initialglyphs{%
5538 % Some changes for non-alphabetic characters. Using the glyphs from the
5539 % math fonts looks more consistent than the typewriter font used elsewhere
5540 % for these characters.
5541 \def\indexbackslash{\math{\backslash}}%
5542 \let\\=\indexbackslash
5544 % Can't get bold backslash so don't use bold forward slash
5545 \catcode`\/=13
5546 \def/{{\secrmnotbold \normalslash}}%
5547 \def-{{\normaldash\normaldash}}% en dash `--'
5548 \def^{{\chapbf \normalcaret}}%
5549 \def~{{\chapbf \normaltilde}}%
5550 \def\_{%
5551 \leavevmode \kern.07em \vbox{\hrule width.3em height.1ex}\kern .07em }%
5552 \def|{$\vert$}%
5553 \def<{$\less$}%
5554 \def>{$\gtr$}%
5555 \def+{$\normalplus$}%
5558 \def\initial{%
5559 \bgroup
5560 \initialglyphs
5561 \initialx
5564 \def\initialx#1{%
5565 % Remove any glue we may have, we'll be inserting our own.
5566 \removelastskip
5568 % We like breaks before the index initials, so insert a bonus.
5569 % The glue before the bonus allows a little bit of space at the
5570 % bottom of a column to reduce an increase in inter-line spacing.
5571 \nobreak
5572 \vskip 0pt plus 5\baselineskip
5573 \penalty -300
5574 \vskip 0pt plus -5\baselineskip
5576 % Typeset the initial. Making this add up to a whole number of
5577 % baselineskips increases the chance of the dots lining up from column
5578 % to column. It still won't often be perfect, because of the stretch
5579 % we need before each entry, but it's better.
5581 % No shrink because it confuses \balancecolumns.
5582 \vskip 1.67\baselineskip plus 1\baselineskip
5583 \leftline{\secfonts \kern-0.05em \secbf #1}%
5584 % \secfonts is inside the argument of \leftline so that the change of
5585 % \baselineskip will not affect any glue inserted before the vbox that
5586 % \leftline creates.
5587 % Do our best not to break after the initial.
5588 \nobreak
5589 \vskip .33\baselineskip plus .1\baselineskip
5590 \egroup % \initialglyphs
5593 \newdimen\entryrightmargin
5594 \entryrightmargin=0pt
5596 % \entry typesets a paragraph consisting of the text (#1), dot leaders, and
5597 % then page number (#2) flushed to the right margin. It is used for index
5598 % and table of contents entries. The paragraph is indented by \leftskip.
5600 \def\entry{%
5601 \begingroup
5603 % For pdfTeX and XeTeX.
5604 % The redefinition of \domark stops marks being added in \pdflink to
5605 % preserve coloured links across page boundaries. Otherwise the marks
5606 % would get in the way of \lastbox in \insertentrybox.
5607 \let\domark\relax
5609 % Start a new paragraph if necessary, so our assignments below can't
5610 % affect previous text.
5611 \par
5613 % No extra space above this paragraph.
5614 \parskip = 0in
5616 % When reading the text of entry, convert explicit line breaks
5617 % from @* into spaces. The user might give these in long section
5618 % titles, for instance.
5619 \def\*{\unskip\space\ignorespaces}%
5620 \def\entrybreak{\hfil\break}% An undocumented command
5622 % Swallow the left brace of the text (first parameter):
5623 \afterassignment\doentry
5624 \let\temp =
5626 \def\entrybreak{\unskip\space\ignorespaces}%
5627 \def\doentry{%
5628 % Save the text of the entry
5629 \global\setbox\boxA=\hbox\bgroup
5630 \bgroup % Instead of the swallowed brace.
5631 \noindent
5632 \aftergroup\finishentry
5633 % And now comes the text of the entry.
5634 % Not absorbing as a macro argument reduces the chance of problems
5635 % with catcodes occurring.
5637 {\catcode`\@=11
5638 \gdef\finishentry#1{%
5639 \egroup % end box A
5640 \dimen@ = \wd\boxA % Length of text of entry
5641 \global\setbox\boxA=\hbox\bgroup\unhbox\boxA
5642 % #1 is the page number.
5644 % Get the width of the page numbers, and only use
5645 % leaders if they are present.
5646 \global\setbox\boxB = \hbox{#1}%
5647 \ifdim\wd\boxB = 0pt
5648 \null\nobreak\hfill\ %
5649 \else
5651 \null\nobreak\indexdotfill % Have leaders before the page number.
5653 \ifpdf
5654 \pdfgettoks#1.%
5655 \hskip\skip\thinshrinkable\the\toksA
5656 \else
5657 \ifx\XeTeXrevision\thisisundefined
5658 \hskip\skip\thinshrinkable #1%
5659 \else
5660 \pdfgettoks#1.%
5661 \hskip\skip\thinshrinkable\the\toksA
5665 \egroup % end \boxA
5666 \ifdim\wd\boxB = 0pt
5667 \global\setbox\entrybox=\vbox{\unhbox\boxA}%
5668 \else
5669 \global\setbox\entrybox=\vbox\bgroup
5670 % We want the text of the entries to be aligned to the left, and the
5671 % page numbers to be aligned to the right.
5673 \parindent = 0pt
5674 \advance\leftskip by 0pt plus 1fil
5675 \advance\leftskip by 0pt plus -1fill
5676 \rightskip = 0pt plus -1fil
5677 \advance\rightskip by 0pt plus 1fill
5678 % Cause last line, which could consist of page numbers on their own
5679 % if the list of page numbers is long, to be aligned to the right.
5680 \parfillskip=0pt plus -1fill
5682 \advance\rightskip by \entryrightmargin
5683 % Determine how far we can stretch into the margin.
5684 % This allows, e.g., "Appendix H GNU Free Documentation License" to
5685 % fit on one line in @letterpaper format.
5686 \ifdim\entryrightmargin>2.1em
5687 \dimen@i=2.1em
5688 \else
5689 \dimen@i=0em
5691 \advance \parfillskip by 0pt minus 1\dimen@i
5693 \dimen@ii = \hsize
5694 \advance\dimen@ii by -1\leftskip
5695 \advance\dimen@ii by -1\entryrightmargin
5696 \advance\dimen@ii by 1\dimen@i
5697 \ifdim\wd\boxA > \dimen@ii % If the entry doesn't fit in one line
5698 \ifdim\dimen@ > 0.8\dimen@ii % due to long index text
5699 % Try to split the text roughly evenly. \dimen@ will be the length of
5700 % the first line.
5701 \dimen@ = 0.7\dimen@
5702 \dimen@ii = \hsize
5703 \ifnum\dimen@>\dimen@ii
5704 % If the entry is too long (for example, if it needs more than
5705 % two lines), use all the space in the first line.
5706 \dimen@ = \dimen@ii
5708 \advance\leftskip by 0pt plus 1fill % ragged right
5709 \advance \dimen@ by 1\rightskip
5710 \parshape = 2 0pt \dimen@ 0em \dimen@ii
5711 % Ideally we'd add a finite glue at the end of the first line only,
5712 % instead of using \parshape with explicit line lengths, but TeX
5713 % doesn't seem to provide a way to do such a thing.
5715 % Indent all lines but the first one.
5716 \advance\leftskip by 1em
5717 \advance\parindent by -1em
5718 \fi\fi
5719 \indent % start paragraph
5720 \unhbox\boxA
5722 % Do not prefer a separate line ending with a hyphen to fewer lines.
5723 \finalhyphendemerits = 0
5725 % Word spacing - no stretch
5726 \spaceskip=\fontdimen2\font minus \fontdimen4\font
5728 \linepenalty=1000 % Discourage line breaks.
5729 \hyphenpenalty=5000 % Discourage hyphenation.
5731 \par % format the paragraph
5732 \egroup % The \vbox
5734 \endgroup
5735 \dotheinsertentrybox
5738 \newskip\thinshrinkable
5739 \skip\thinshrinkable=.15em minus .15em
5741 \newbox\entrybox
5742 \def\insertentrybox{%
5743 \ourunvbox\entrybox
5746 % default definition
5747 \let\dotheinsertentrybox\insertentrybox
5749 % Use \lastbox to take apart vbox box by box, and add each sub-box
5750 % to the current vertical list.
5751 \def\ourunvbox#1{%
5752 \bgroup % for local binding of \delayedbox
5753 % Remove the last box from box #1
5754 \global\setbox#1=\vbox{%
5755 \unvbox#1%
5756 \unskip % remove any glue
5757 \unpenalty
5758 \global\setbox\interbox=\lastbox
5760 \setbox\delayedbox=\box\interbox
5761 \ifdim\ht#1=0pt\else
5762 \ourunvbox#1 % Repeat on what's left of the box
5763 \nobreak
5765 \box\delayedbox
5766 \egroup
5768 \newbox\delayedbox
5769 \newbox\interbox
5771 % Used from \printindex. \firsttoken should be the first token
5772 % after the \entry. If it's not another \entry, we are at the last
5773 % line of a group of index entries, so insert a penalty to discourage
5774 % widowed index entries.
5775 \def\dotheinsertentryboxwithpenalty{%
5776 \ifx\firsttoken\isentry
5777 \else
5778 \penalty 9000
5780 \insertentrybox
5782 \def\isentry{\entry}%
5784 % Like plain.tex's \dotfill, except uses up at least 1 em.
5785 % The filll stretch here overpowers both the fil and fill stretch to push
5786 % the page number to the right.
5787 \def\indexdotfill{\cleaders
5788 \hbox{$\mathsurround=0pt \mkern1.5mu.\mkern1.5mu$}\hskip 1em plus 1filll}
5791 \def\primary #1{\line{#1\hfil}}
5793 \newskip\secondaryindent \secondaryindent=0.5cm
5794 \def\secondary#1#2{{%
5795 \parfillskip=0in
5796 \parskip=0in
5797 \hangindent=1in
5798 \hangafter=1
5799 \noindent\hskip\secondaryindent\hbox{#1}\indexdotfill
5800 \ifpdf
5801 \pdfgettoks#2.\ \the\toksA % The page number ends the paragraph.
5802 \else
5803 \ifx\XeTeXrevision\thisisundefined
5805 \else
5806 \pdfgettoks#2.\ \the\toksA % The page number ends the paragraph.
5809 \par
5812 % Define two-column mode, which we use to typeset indexes.
5813 % Adapted from the TeXbook, page 416, which is to say,
5814 % the manmac.tex format used to print the TeXbook itself.
5815 \catcode`\@=11 % private names
5817 \newbox\partialpage
5818 \newdimen\doublecolumnhsize
5820 % Use inside an output routine to save \topmark and \firstmark
5821 \def\savemarks{%
5822 \global\savedtopmark=\expandafter{\topmark }%
5823 \global\savedfirstmark=\expandafter{\firstmark }%
5825 \newtoks\savedtopmark
5826 \newtoks\savedfirstmark
5828 % Set \topmark and \firstmark for next time \output runs.
5829 % Can't be run from withinside \output (because any material
5830 % added while an output routine is active, including
5831 % penalties, is saved for after it finishes). The page so far
5832 % should be empty, otherwise what's on it will be thrown away.
5833 \def\restoremarks{%
5834 \mark{\the\savedtopmark}%
5835 \bgroup\output = {%
5836 \setbox\dummybox=\box\PAGE
5837 }abc\eject\egroup
5838 % "abc" because output routine doesn't fire for a completely empty page.
5839 \mark{\the\savedfirstmark}%
5842 \def\begindoublecolumns{\begingroup % ended by \enddoublecolumns
5843 % If not much space left on page, start a new page.
5844 \ifdim\pagetotal>0.8\vsize\vfill\eject\fi
5846 % Grab any single-column material above us.
5847 \output = {%
5849 % Here is a possibility not foreseen in manmac: if we accumulate a
5850 % whole lot of material, we might end up calling this \output
5851 % routine twice in a row (see the doublecol-lose test, which is
5852 % essentially a couple of indexes with @setchapternewpage off). In
5853 % that case we just ship out what is in \partialpage with the normal
5854 % output routine. Generally, \partialpage will be empty when this
5855 % runs and this will be a no-op. See the indexspread.tex test case.
5856 \ifvoid\partialpage \else
5857 \onepageout{\pagecontents\partialpage}%
5860 \global\setbox\partialpage = \vbox{%
5861 % Unvbox the main output page.
5862 \unvbox\PAGE
5863 \kern-\topskip \kern\baselineskip
5865 \savemarks
5867 \eject % run that output routine to set \partialpage
5868 \restoremarks
5870 % We recover the two marks that the last output routine saved in order
5871 % to propagate the information in marks added around a chapter heading,
5872 % which could be otherwise be lost by the time the final page is output.
5875 % Use the double-column output routine for subsequent pages.
5876 \output = {\doublecolumnout}%
5878 % Change the page size parameters. We could do this once outside this
5879 % routine, in each of @smallbook, @afourpaper, and the default 8.5x11
5880 % format, but then we repeat the same computation. Repeating a couple
5881 % of assignments once per index is clearly meaningless for the
5882 % execution time, so we may as well do it in one place.
5884 % First we halve the line length, less a little for the gutter between
5885 % the columns. We compute the gutter based on the line length, so it
5886 % changes automatically with the paper format. The magic constant
5887 % below is chosen so that the gutter has the same value (well, +-<1pt)
5888 % as it did when we hard-coded it.
5890 % We put the result in a separate register, \doublecolumhsize, so we
5891 % can restore it in \pagesofar, after \hsize itself has (potentially)
5892 % been clobbered.
5894 \doublecolumnhsize = \hsize
5895 \advance\doublecolumnhsize by -.04154\hsize
5896 \divide\doublecolumnhsize by 2
5897 \hsize = \doublecolumnhsize
5899 % Double the \vsize as well.
5900 \advance\vsize by -\ht\partialpage
5901 \vsize = 2\vsize
5903 % For the benefit of balancing columns
5904 \advance\baselineskip by 0pt plus 0.5pt
5907 % The double-column output routine for all double-column pages except
5908 % the last, which is done by \balancecolumns.
5910 \def\doublecolumnout{%
5912 \splittopskip=\topskip \splitmaxdepth=\maxdepth
5913 % Get the available space for the double columns -- the normal
5914 % (undoubled) page height minus any material left over from the
5915 % previous page.
5916 \dimen@ = \vsize
5917 \divide\dimen@ by 2
5919 % box0 will be the left-hand column, box2 the right.
5920 \setbox0=\vsplit\PAGE to\dimen@ \setbox2=\vsplit\PAGE to\dimen@
5921 \global\advance\vsize by 2\ht\partialpage
5922 \onepageout\pagesofar
5923 \unvbox\PAGE
5924 \penalty\outputpenalty
5927 % Re-output the contents of the output page -- any previous material,
5928 % followed by the two boxes we just split, in box0 and box2.
5929 \def\pagesofar{%
5930 \unvbox\partialpage
5932 \hsize = \doublecolumnhsize
5933 \wd0=\hsize \wd2=\hsize
5934 \hbox to\txipagewidth{\box0\hfil\box2}%
5938 % Finished with with double columns.
5939 \def\enddoublecolumns{%
5940 % The following penalty ensures that the page builder is exercised
5941 % _before_ we change the output routine. This is necessary in the
5942 % following situation:
5944 % The last section of the index consists only of a single entry.
5945 % Before this section, \pagetotal is less than \pagegoal, so no
5946 % break occurs before the last section starts. However, the last
5947 % section, consisting of \initial and the single \entry, does not
5948 % fit on the page and has to be broken off. Without the following
5949 % penalty the page builder will not be exercised until \eject
5950 % below, and by that time we'll already have changed the output
5951 % routine to the \balancecolumns version, so the next-to-last
5952 % double-column page will be processed with \balancecolumns, which
5953 % is wrong: The two columns will go to the main vertical list, with
5954 % the broken-off section in the recent contributions. As soon as
5955 % the output routine finishes, TeX starts reconsidering the page
5956 % break. The two columns and the broken-off section both fit on the
5957 % page, because the two columns now take up only half of the page
5958 % goal. When TeX sees \eject from below which follows the final
5959 % section, it invokes the new output routine that we've set after
5960 % \balancecolumns below; \onepageout will try to fit the two columns
5961 % and the final section into the vbox of \txipageheight (see
5962 % \pagebody), causing an overfull box.
5964 % Note that glue won't work here, because glue does not exercise the
5965 % page builder, unlike penalties (see The TeXbook, pp. 280-281).
5966 \penalty0
5968 \output = {%
5969 % Split the last of the double-column material.
5970 \savemarks
5971 \balancecolumns
5973 % Having called \balancecolumns once, we do not
5974 % want to call it again. Therefore, reset \output to its normal
5975 % definition right away.
5976 \global\output = {\onepageout{\pagecontents\PAGE}}%
5978 \eject
5979 \endgroup % started in \begindoublecolumns
5980 \restoremarks
5981 % Leave the double-column material on the current page, no automatic
5982 % page break.
5983 \box\balancedcolumns
5985 % \pagegoal was set to the doubled \vsize above, since we restarted
5986 % the current page. We're now back to normal single-column
5987 % typesetting, so reset \pagegoal to the normal \vsize.
5988 \global\vsize = \txipageheight %
5989 \pagegoal = \txipageheight %
5991 \newbox\balancedcolumns
5992 \setbox\balancedcolumns=\vbox{shouldnt see this}%
5994 % Only called for the last of the double column material. \doublecolumnout
5995 % does the others.
5996 \def\balancecolumns{%
5997 \setbox0 = \vbox{\unvbox\PAGE}% like \box255 but more efficient, see p.120.
5998 \dimen@ = \ht0
5999 \advance\dimen@ by \topskip
6000 \advance\dimen@ by-\baselineskip
6001 \ifdim\dimen@<5\baselineskip
6002 % Don't split a short final column in two.
6003 \setbox2=\vbox{}%
6004 \else
6005 \divide\dimen@ by 2 % target to split to
6006 \dimen@ii = \dimen@
6007 \splittopskip = \topskip
6008 % Loop until left column is at least as high as the right column.
6010 \vbadness = 10000
6011 \loop
6012 \global\setbox3 = \copy0
6013 \global\setbox1 = \vsplit3 to \dimen@
6014 \ifdim\ht1<\ht3
6015 \global\advance\dimen@ by 1pt
6016 \repeat
6018 % Now the left column is in box 1, and the right column in box 3.
6019 % Check whether the left column has come out higher than the page itself.
6020 % (Note that we have doubled \vsize for the double columns, so
6021 % the actual height of the page is 0.5\vsize).
6022 \ifdim2\ht1>\vsize
6023 % Just split the last of the double column material roughly in half.
6024 \setbox2=\box0
6025 \setbox0 = \vsplit2 to \dimen@ii
6026 \setbox0=\vbox to \dimen@ii {\unvbox0\vfill}%
6027 \setbox2=\vbox to \dimen@ii {\unvbox2\vfill}%
6028 \else
6029 % Compare the heights of the two columns.
6030 \ifdim4\ht1>5\ht3
6031 % Column heights are too different, so don't make their bottoms
6032 % flush with each other.
6033 \setbox2=\vbox to \ht1 {\unvbox3\vfill}%
6034 \setbox0=\vbox to \ht1 {\unvbox1\vfill}%
6035 \else
6036 % Make column bottoms flush with each other.
6037 \setbox2=\vbox to\ht1{\unvbox3\unskip}%
6038 \setbox0=\vbox to\ht1{\unvbox1\unskip}%
6043 \global\setbox\balancedcolumns=\vbox{\pagesofar}%
6045 \catcode`\@ = \other
6048 \message{sectioning,}
6049 % Chapters, sections, etc.
6051 % Let's start with @part.
6052 \outer\parseargdef\part{\partzzz{#1}}
6053 \def\partzzz#1{%
6054 \chapoddpage
6055 \null
6056 \vskip.3\vsize % move it down on the page a bit
6057 \begingroup
6058 \noindent \titlefonts\rm #1\par % the text
6059 \let\lastnode=\empty % no node to associate with
6060 \writetocentry{part}{#1}{}% but put it in the toc
6061 \headingsoff % no headline or footline on the part page
6062 % This outputs a mark at the end of the page that clears \thischapter
6063 % and \thissection, as is done in \startcontents.
6064 \let\pchapsepmacro\relax
6065 \chapmacro{}{Yomitfromtoc}{}%
6066 \chapoddpage
6067 \endgroup
6070 % \unnumberedno is an oxymoron. But we count the unnumbered
6071 % sections so that we can refer to them unambiguously in the pdf
6072 % outlines by their "section number". We avoid collisions with chapter
6073 % numbers by starting them at 10000. (If a document ever has 10000
6074 % chapters, we're in trouble anyway, I'm sure.)
6075 \newcount\unnumberedno \unnumberedno = 10000
6076 \newcount\chapno
6077 \newcount\secno \secno=0
6078 \newcount\subsecno \subsecno=0
6079 \newcount\subsubsecno \subsubsecno=0
6081 % This counter is funny since it counts through charcodes of letters A, B, ...
6082 \newcount\appendixno \appendixno = `\@
6084 % \def\appendixletter{\char\the\appendixno}
6085 % We do the following ugly conditional instead of the above simple
6086 % construct for the sake of pdftex, which needs the actual
6087 % letter in the expansion, not just typeset.
6089 \def\appendixletter{%
6090 \ifnum\appendixno=`A A%
6091 \else\ifnum\appendixno=`B B%
6092 \else\ifnum\appendixno=`C C%
6093 \else\ifnum\appendixno=`D D%
6094 \else\ifnum\appendixno=`E E%
6095 \else\ifnum\appendixno=`F F%
6096 \else\ifnum\appendixno=`G G%
6097 \else\ifnum\appendixno=`H H%
6098 \else\ifnum\appendixno=`I I%
6099 \else\ifnum\appendixno=`J J%
6100 \else\ifnum\appendixno=`K K%
6101 \else\ifnum\appendixno=`L L%
6102 \else\ifnum\appendixno=`M M%
6103 \else\ifnum\appendixno=`N N%
6104 \else\ifnum\appendixno=`O O%
6105 \else\ifnum\appendixno=`P P%
6106 \else\ifnum\appendixno=`Q Q%
6107 \else\ifnum\appendixno=`R R%
6108 \else\ifnum\appendixno=`S S%
6109 \else\ifnum\appendixno=`T T%
6110 \else\ifnum\appendixno=`U U%
6111 \else\ifnum\appendixno=`V V%
6112 \else\ifnum\appendixno=`W W%
6113 \else\ifnum\appendixno=`X X%
6114 \else\ifnum\appendixno=`Y Y%
6115 \else\ifnum\appendixno=`Z Z%
6116 % The \the is necessary, despite appearances, because \appendixletter is
6117 % expanded while writing the .toc file. \char\appendixno is not
6118 % expandable, thus it is written literally, thus all appendixes come out
6119 % with the same letter (or @) in the toc without it.
6120 \else\char\the\appendixno
6121 \fi\fi\fi\fi\fi\fi\fi\fi\fi\fi\fi\fi\fi
6122 \fi\fi\fi\fi\fi\fi\fi\fi\fi\fi\fi\fi\fi}
6124 % Each @chapter defines these (using marks) as the number+name, number
6125 % and name of the chapter. Page headings and footings can use
6126 % these. @section does likewise.
6127 \def\thischapter{}
6128 \def\thischapternum{}
6129 \def\thischaptername{}
6130 \def\thissection{}
6131 \def\thissectionnum{}
6132 \def\thissectionname{}
6134 \newcount\absseclevel % used to calculate proper heading level
6135 \newcount\secbase\secbase=0 % @raisesections/@lowersections modify this count
6137 % @raisesections: treat @section as chapter, @subsection as section, etc.
6138 \def\raisesections{\global\advance\secbase by -1}
6139 \let\up=\raisesections % original BFox name
6141 % @lowersections: treat @chapter as section, @section as subsection, etc.
6142 \def\lowersections{\global\advance\secbase by 1}
6143 \let\down=\lowersections % original BFox name
6145 % we only have subsub.
6146 \chardef\maxseclevel = 3
6148 % A numbered section within an unnumbered changes to unnumbered too.
6149 % To achieve this, remember the "biggest" unnum. sec. we are currently in:
6150 \chardef\unnlevel = \maxseclevel
6152 % Trace whether the current chapter is an appendix or not:
6153 % \chapheadtype is "N" or "A", unnumbered chapters are ignored.
6154 \def\chapheadtype{N}
6156 % Choose a heading macro
6157 % #1 is heading type
6158 % #2 is heading level
6159 % #3 is text for heading
6160 \def\genhead#1#2#3{%
6161 % Compute the abs. sec. level:
6162 \absseclevel=#2
6163 \advance\absseclevel by \secbase
6164 % Make sure \absseclevel doesn't fall outside the range:
6165 \ifnum \absseclevel < 0
6166 \absseclevel = 0
6167 \else
6168 \ifnum \absseclevel > 3
6169 \absseclevel = 3
6172 % The heading type:
6173 \def\headtype{#1}%
6174 \if \headtype U%
6175 \ifnum \absseclevel < \unnlevel
6176 \chardef\unnlevel = \absseclevel
6178 \else
6179 % Check for appendix sections:
6180 \ifnum \absseclevel = 0
6181 \edef\chapheadtype{\headtype}%
6182 \else
6183 \if \headtype A\if \chapheadtype N%
6184 \errmessage{@appendix... within a non-appendix chapter}%
6185 \fi\fi
6187 % Check for numbered within unnumbered:
6188 \ifnum \absseclevel > \unnlevel
6189 \def\headtype{U}%
6190 \else
6191 \chardef\unnlevel = 3
6194 % Now print the heading:
6195 \if \headtype U%
6196 \ifcase\absseclevel
6197 \unnumberedzzz{#3}%
6198 \or \unnumberedseczzz{#3}%
6199 \or \unnumberedsubseczzz{#3}%
6200 \or \unnumberedsubsubseczzz{#3}%
6202 \else
6203 \if \headtype A%
6204 \ifcase\absseclevel
6205 \appendixzzz{#3}%
6206 \or \appendixsectionzzz{#3}%
6207 \or \appendixsubseczzz{#3}%
6208 \or \appendixsubsubseczzz{#3}%
6210 \else
6211 \ifcase\absseclevel
6212 \chapterzzz{#3}%
6213 \or \seczzz{#3}%
6214 \or \numberedsubseczzz{#3}%
6215 \or \numberedsubsubseczzz{#3}%
6219 \suppressfirstparagraphindent
6222 % an interface:
6223 \def\numhead{\genhead N}
6224 \def\apphead{\genhead A}
6225 \def\unnmhead{\genhead U}
6227 % @chapter, @appendix, @unnumbered. Increment top-level counter, reset
6228 % all lower-level sectioning counters to zero.
6230 % Also set \chaplevelprefix, which we prepend to @float sequence numbers
6231 % (e.g., figures), q.v. By default (before any chapter), that is empty.
6232 \let\chaplevelprefix = \empty
6234 \outer\parseargdef\chapter{\numhead0{#1}} % normally numhead0 calls chapterzzz
6235 \def\chapterzzz#1{%
6236 % section resetting is \global in case the chapter is in a group, such
6237 % as an @include file.
6238 \global\secno=0 \global\subsecno=0 \global\subsubsecno=0
6239 \global\advance\chapno by 1
6241 % Used for \float.
6242 \gdef\chaplevelprefix{\the\chapno.}%
6243 \resetallfloatnos
6245 % \putwordChapter can contain complex things in translations.
6246 \toks0=\expandafter{\putwordChapter}%
6247 \message{\the\toks0 \space \the\chapno}%
6249 % Write the actual heading.
6250 \chapmacro{#1}{Ynumbered}{\the\chapno}%
6252 % So @section and the like are numbered underneath this chapter.
6253 \global\let\section = \numberedsec
6254 \global\let\subsection = \numberedsubsec
6255 \global\let\subsubsection = \numberedsubsubsec
6258 \outer\parseargdef\appendix{\apphead0{#1}} % normally calls appendixzzz
6260 \def\appendixzzz#1{%
6261 \global\secno=0 \global\subsecno=0 \global\subsubsecno=0
6262 \global\advance\appendixno by 1
6263 \gdef\chaplevelprefix{\appendixletter.}%
6264 \resetallfloatnos
6266 % \putwordAppendix can contain complex things in translations.
6267 \toks0=\expandafter{\putwordAppendix}%
6268 \message{\the\toks0 \space \appendixletter}%
6270 \chapmacro{#1}{Yappendix}{\appendixletter}%
6272 \global\let\section = \appendixsec
6273 \global\let\subsection = \appendixsubsec
6274 \global\let\subsubsection = \appendixsubsubsec
6277 % normally unnmhead0 calls unnumberedzzz:
6278 \outer\parseargdef\unnumbered{\unnmhead0{#1}}
6279 \def\unnumberedzzz#1{%
6280 \global\secno=0 \global\subsecno=0 \global\subsubsecno=0
6281 \global\advance\unnumberedno by 1
6283 % Since an unnumbered has no number, no prefix for figures.
6284 \global\let\chaplevelprefix = \empty
6285 \resetallfloatnos
6287 % This used to be simply \message{#1}, but TeX fully expands the
6288 % argument to \message. Therefore, if #1 contained @-commands, TeX
6289 % expanded them. For example, in `@unnumbered The @cite{Book}', TeX
6290 % expanded @cite (which turns out to cause errors because \cite is meant
6291 % to be executed, not expanded).
6293 % Anyway, we don't want the fully-expanded definition of @cite to appear
6294 % as a result of the \message, we just want `@cite' itself. We use
6295 % \the<toks register> to achieve this: TeX expands \the<toks> only once,
6296 % simply yielding the contents of <toks register>. (We also do this for
6297 % the toc entries.)
6298 \toks0 = {#1}%
6299 \message{(\the\toks0)}%
6301 \chapmacro{#1}{Ynothing}{\the\unnumberedno}%
6303 \global\let\section = \unnumberedsec
6304 \global\let\subsection = \unnumberedsubsec
6305 \global\let\subsubsection = \unnumberedsubsubsec
6308 % @centerchap is like @unnumbered, but the heading is centered.
6309 \outer\parseargdef\centerchap{%
6310 \let\centerparametersmaybe = \centerparameters
6311 \unnmhead0{#1}%
6312 \let\centerparametersmaybe = \relax
6315 % @top is like @unnumbered.
6316 \let\top\unnumbered
6318 % Sections.
6320 \outer\parseargdef\numberedsec{\numhead1{#1}} % normally calls seczzz
6321 \def\seczzz#1{%
6322 \global\subsecno=0 \global\subsubsecno=0 \global\advance\secno by 1
6323 \sectionheading{#1}{sec}{Ynumbered}{\the\chapno.\the\secno}%
6326 % normally calls appendixsectionzzz:
6327 \outer\parseargdef\appendixsection{\apphead1{#1}}
6328 \def\appendixsectionzzz#1{%
6329 \global\subsecno=0 \global\subsubsecno=0 \global\advance\secno by 1
6330 \sectionheading{#1}{sec}{Yappendix}{\appendixletter.\the\secno}%
6332 \let\appendixsec\appendixsection
6334 % normally calls unnumberedseczzz:
6335 \outer\parseargdef\unnumberedsec{\unnmhead1{#1}}
6336 \def\unnumberedseczzz#1{%
6337 \global\subsecno=0 \global\subsubsecno=0 \global\advance\secno by 1
6338 \sectionheading{#1}{sec}{Ynothing}{\the\unnumberedno.\the\secno}%
6341 % Subsections.
6343 % normally calls numberedsubseczzz:
6344 \outer\parseargdef\numberedsubsec{\numhead2{#1}}
6345 \def\numberedsubseczzz#1{%
6346 \global\subsubsecno=0 \global\advance\subsecno by 1
6347 \sectionheading{#1}{subsec}{Ynumbered}{\the\chapno.\the\secno.\the\subsecno}%
6350 % normally calls appendixsubseczzz:
6351 \outer\parseargdef\appendixsubsec{\apphead2{#1}}
6352 \def\appendixsubseczzz#1{%
6353 \global\subsubsecno=0 \global\advance\subsecno by 1
6354 \sectionheading{#1}{subsec}{Yappendix}%
6355 {\appendixletter.\the\secno.\the\subsecno}%
6358 % normally calls unnumberedsubseczzz:
6359 \outer\parseargdef\unnumberedsubsec{\unnmhead2{#1}}
6360 \def\unnumberedsubseczzz#1{%
6361 \global\subsubsecno=0 \global\advance\subsecno by 1
6362 \sectionheading{#1}{subsec}{Ynothing}%
6363 {\the\unnumberedno.\the\secno.\the\subsecno}%
6366 % Subsubsections.
6368 % normally numberedsubsubseczzz:
6369 \outer\parseargdef\numberedsubsubsec{\numhead3{#1}}
6370 \def\numberedsubsubseczzz#1{%
6371 \global\advance\subsubsecno by 1
6372 \sectionheading{#1}{subsubsec}{Ynumbered}%
6373 {\the\chapno.\the\secno.\the\subsecno.\the\subsubsecno}%
6376 % normally appendixsubsubseczzz:
6377 \outer\parseargdef\appendixsubsubsec{\apphead3{#1}}
6378 \def\appendixsubsubseczzz#1{%
6379 \global\advance\subsubsecno by 1
6380 \sectionheading{#1}{subsubsec}{Yappendix}%
6381 {\appendixletter.\the\secno.\the\subsecno.\the\subsubsecno}%
6384 % normally unnumberedsubsubseczzz:
6385 \outer\parseargdef\unnumberedsubsubsec{\unnmhead3{#1}}
6386 \def\unnumberedsubsubseczzz#1{%
6387 \global\advance\subsubsecno by 1
6388 \sectionheading{#1}{subsubsec}{Ynothing}%
6389 {\the\unnumberedno.\the\secno.\the\subsecno.\the\subsubsecno}%
6392 % These macros control what the section commands do, according
6393 % to what kind of chapter we are in (ordinary, appendix, or unnumbered).
6394 % Define them by default for a numbered chapter.
6395 \let\section = \numberedsec
6396 \let\subsection = \numberedsubsec
6397 \let\subsubsection = \numberedsubsubsec
6399 % Define @majorheading, @heading and @subheading
6401 \def\majorheading{%
6402 {\advance\chapheadingskip by 10pt \chapbreak }%
6403 \parsearg\chapheadingzzz
6406 \def\chapheading{\chapbreak \parsearg\chapheadingzzz}
6407 \def\chapheadingzzz#1{%
6408 \vbox{\chapfonts \raggedtitlesettings #1\par}%
6409 \nobreak\bigskip \nobreak
6410 \suppressfirstparagraphindent
6413 % @heading, @subheading, @subsubheading.
6414 \parseargdef\heading{\sectionheading{#1}{sec}{Yomitfromtoc}{}
6415 \suppressfirstparagraphindent}
6416 \parseargdef\subheading{\sectionheading{#1}{subsec}{Yomitfromtoc}{}
6417 \suppressfirstparagraphindent}
6418 \parseargdef\subsubheading{\sectionheading{#1}{subsubsec}{Yomitfromtoc}{}
6419 \suppressfirstparagraphindent}
6421 % These macros generate a chapter, section, etc. heading only
6422 % (including whitespace, linebreaking, etc. around it),
6423 % given all the information in convenient, parsed form.
6425 % Args are the skip and penalty (usually negative)
6426 \def\dobreak#1#2{\par\ifdim\lastskip<#1\removelastskip\penalty#2\vskip#1\fi}
6428 % Parameter controlling skip before chapter headings (if needed)
6429 \newskip\chapheadingskip
6431 % Define plain chapter starts, and page on/off switching for it.
6432 \def\chapbreak{\dobreak \chapheadingskip {-4000}}
6434 % Start a new page
6435 \def\chappager{\par\vfill\supereject}
6437 % \chapoddpage - start on an odd page for a new chapter
6438 % Because \domark is called before \chapoddpage, the filler page will
6439 % get the headings for the next chapter, which is wrong. But we don't
6440 % care -- we just disable all headings on the filler page.
6441 \def\chapoddpage{%
6442 \chappager
6443 \ifodd\pageno \else
6444 \begingroup
6445 \headingsoff
6446 \null
6447 \chappager
6448 \endgroup
6452 \parseargdef\setchapternewpage{\csname CHAPPAG#1\endcsname}
6454 \def\CHAPPAGoff{%
6455 \global\let\contentsalignmacro = \chappager
6456 \global\let\pchapsepmacro=\chapbreak
6457 \global\let\pagealignmacro=\chappager}
6459 \def\CHAPPAGon{%
6460 \global\let\contentsalignmacro = \chappager
6461 \global\let\pchapsepmacro=\chappager
6462 \global\let\pagealignmacro=\chappager
6463 \global\def\HEADINGSon{\HEADINGSsingle}}
6465 \def\CHAPPAGodd{%
6466 \global\let\contentsalignmacro = \chapoddpage
6467 \global\let\pchapsepmacro=\chapoddpage
6468 \global\let\pagealignmacro=\chapoddpage
6469 \global\def\HEADINGSon{\HEADINGSdouble}}
6471 \CHAPPAGon
6473 % \chapmacro - Chapter opening.
6475 % #1 is the text, #2 is the section type (Ynumbered, Ynothing,
6476 % Yappendix, Yomitfromtoc), #3 the chapter number.
6477 % Not used for @heading series.
6479 % To test against our argument.
6480 \def\Ynothingkeyword{Ynothing}
6481 \def\Yappendixkeyword{Yappendix}
6482 \def\Yomitfromtockeyword{Yomitfromtoc}
6484 \def\chapmacro#1#2#3{%
6485 \expandafter\ifx\thisenv\titlepage\else
6486 \checkenv{}% chapters, etc., should not start inside an environment.
6488 % FIXME: \chapmacro is currently called from inside \titlepage when
6489 % \setcontentsaftertitlepage to print the "Table of Contents" heading, but
6490 % this should probably be done by \sectionheading with an option to print
6491 % in chapter size.
6493 % Insert the first mark before the heading break (see notes for \domark).
6494 \let\prevchapterdefs=\lastchapterdefs
6495 \let\prevsectiondefs=\lastsectiondefs
6496 \gdef\lastsectiondefs{\gdef\thissectionname{}\gdef\thissectionnum{}%
6497 \gdef\thissection{}}%
6499 \def\temptype{#2}%
6500 \ifx\temptype\Ynothingkeyword
6501 \gdef\lastchapterdefs{\gdef\thischaptername{#1}\gdef\thischapternum{}%
6502 \gdef\thischapter{\thischaptername}}%
6503 \else\ifx\temptype\Yomitfromtockeyword
6504 \gdef\lastchapterdefs{\gdef\thischaptername{#1}\gdef\thischapternum{}%
6505 \gdef\thischapter{}}%
6506 \else\ifx\temptype\Yappendixkeyword
6507 \toks0={#1}%
6508 \xdef\lastchapterdefs{%
6509 \gdef\noexpand\thischaptername{\the\toks0}%
6510 \gdef\noexpand\thischapternum{\appendixletter}%
6511 % \noexpand\putwordAppendix avoids expanding indigestible
6512 % commands in some of the translations.
6513 \gdef\noexpand\thischapter{\noexpand\putwordAppendix{}
6514 \noexpand\thischapternum:
6515 \noexpand\thischaptername}%
6517 \else
6518 \toks0={#1}%
6519 \xdef\lastchapterdefs{%
6520 \gdef\noexpand\thischaptername{\the\toks0}%
6521 \gdef\noexpand\thischapternum{\the\chapno}%
6522 % \noexpand\putwordChapter avoids expanding indigestible
6523 % commands in some of the translations.
6524 \gdef\noexpand\thischapter{\noexpand\putwordChapter{}
6525 \noexpand\thischapternum:
6526 \noexpand\thischaptername}%
6528 \fi\fi\fi
6530 % Output the mark. Pass it through \safewhatsit, to take care of
6531 % the preceding space.
6532 \safewhatsit\domark
6534 % Insert the chapter heading break.
6535 \pchapsepmacro
6537 % Now the second mark, after the heading break. No break points
6538 % between here and the heading.
6539 \let\prevchapterdefs=\lastchapterdefs
6540 \let\prevsectiondefs=\lastsectiondefs
6541 \domark
6544 \chapfonts \rm
6545 \let\footnote=\errfootnoteheading % give better error message
6547 % Have to define \lastsection before calling \donoderef, because the
6548 % xref code eventually uses it. On the other hand, it has to be called
6549 % after \pchapsepmacro, or the headline will change too soon.
6550 \gdef\lastsection{#1}%
6552 % Only insert the separating space if we have a chapter/appendix
6553 % number, and don't print the unnumbered ``number''.
6554 \ifx\temptype\Ynothingkeyword
6555 \setbox0 = \hbox{}%
6556 \def\toctype{unnchap}%
6557 \else\ifx\temptype\Yomitfromtockeyword
6558 \setbox0 = \hbox{}% contents like unnumbered, but no toc entry
6559 \def\toctype{omit}%
6560 \else\ifx\temptype\Yappendixkeyword
6561 \setbox0 = \hbox{\putwordAppendix{} #3\enspace}%
6562 \def\toctype{app}%
6563 \else
6564 \setbox0 = \hbox{#3\enspace}%
6565 \def\toctype{numchap}%
6566 \fi\fi\fi
6568 % Write the toc entry for this chapter. Must come before the
6569 % \donoderef, because we include the current node name in the toc
6570 % entry, and \donoderef resets it to empty.
6571 \writetocentry{\toctype}{#1}{#3}%
6573 % For pdftex, we have to write out the node definition (aka, make
6574 % the pdfdest) after any page break, but before the actual text has
6575 % been typeset. If the destination for the pdf outline is after the
6576 % text, then jumping from the outline may wind up with the text not
6577 % being visible, for instance under high magnification.
6578 \donoderef{#2}%
6580 % Typeset the actual heading.
6581 \nobreak % Avoid page breaks at the interline glue.
6582 \vbox{\raggedtitlesettings \hangindent=\wd0 \centerparametersmaybe
6583 \unhbox0 #1\par}%
6585 \nobreak\bigskip % no page break after a chapter title
6586 \nobreak
6589 % @centerchap -- centered and unnumbered.
6590 \let\centerparametersmaybe = \relax
6591 \def\centerparameters{%
6592 \advance\rightskip by 3\rightskip
6593 \leftskip = \rightskip
6594 \parfillskip = 0pt
6598 % Section titles. These macros combine the section number parts and
6599 % call the generic \sectionheading to do the printing.
6601 \newskip\secheadingskip
6602 \def\secheadingbreak{\dobreak \secheadingskip{-1000}}
6604 % Subsection titles.
6605 \newskip\subsecheadingskip
6606 \def\subsecheadingbreak{\dobreak \subsecheadingskip{-500}}
6608 % Subsubsection titles.
6609 \def\subsubsecheadingskip{\subsecheadingskip}
6610 \def\subsubsecheadingbreak{\subsecheadingbreak}
6613 % Print any size, any type, section title.
6615 % #1 is the text of the title,
6616 % #2 is the section level (sec/subsec/subsubsec),
6617 % #3 is the section type (Ynumbered, Ynothing, Yappendix, Yomitfromtoc),
6618 % #4 is the section number.
6620 \def\seckeyword{sec}
6622 \def\sectionheading#1#2#3#4{%
6624 \def\sectionlevel{#2}%
6625 \def\temptype{#3}%
6627 % It is ok for the @heading series commands to appear inside an
6628 % environment (it's been historically allowed, though the logic is
6629 % dubious), but not the others.
6630 \ifx\temptype\Yomitfromtockeyword\else
6631 \checkenv{}% non-@*heading should not be in an environment.
6633 \let\footnote=\errfootnoteheading
6635 % Switch to the right set of fonts.
6636 \csname #2fonts\endcsname \rm
6638 % Insert first mark before the heading break (see notes for \domark).
6639 \let\prevsectiondefs=\lastsectiondefs
6640 \ifx\temptype\Ynothingkeyword
6641 \ifx\sectionlevel\seckeyword
6642 \gdef\lastsectiondefs{\gdef\thissectionname{#1}\gdef\thissectionnum{}%
6643 \gdef\thissection{\thissectionname}}%
6645 \else\ifx\temptype\Yomitfromtockeyword
6646 % Don't redefine \thissection.
6647 \else\ifx\temptype\Yappendixkeyword
6648 \ifx\sectionlevel\seckeyword
6649 \toks0={#1}%
6650 \xdef\lastsectiondefs{%
6651 \gdef\noexpand\thissectionname{\the\toks0}%
6652 \gdef\noexpand\thissectionnum{#4}%
6653 % \noexpand\putwordSection avoids expanding indigestible
6654 % commands in some of the translations.
6655 \gdef\noexpand\thissection{\noexpand\putwordSection{}
6656 \noexpand\thissectionnum:
6657 \noexpand\thissectionname}%
6660 \else
6661 \ifx\sectionlevel\seckeyword
6662 \toks0={#1}%
6663 \xdef\lastsectiondefs{%
6664 \gdef\noexpand\thissectionname{\the\toks0}%
6665 \gdef\noexpand\thissectionnum{#4}%
6666 % \noexpand\putwordSection avoids expanding indigestible
6667 % commands in some of the translations.
6668 \gdef\noexpand\thissection{\noexpand\putwordSection{}
6669 \noexpand\thissectionnum:
6670 \noexpand\thissectionname}%
6673 \fi\fi\fi
6675 % Go into vertical mode. Usually we'll already be there, but we
6676 % don't want the following whatsit to end up in a preceding paragraph
6677 % if the document didn't happen to have a blank line.
6678 \par
6680 % Output the mark. Pass it through \safewhatsit, to take care of
6681 % the preceding space.
6682 \safewhatsit\domark
6684 % Insert space above the heading.
6685 \csname #2headingbreak\endcsname
6687 % Now the second mark, after the heading break. No break points
6688 % between here and the heading.
6689 \global\let\prevsectiondefs=\lastsectiondefs
6690 \domark
6692 % Only insert the space after the number if we have a section number.
6693 \ifx\temptype\Ynothingkeyword
6694 \setbox0 = \hbox{}%
6695 \def\toctype{unn}%
6696 \gdef\lastsection{#1}%
6697 \else\ifx\temptype\Yomitfromtockeyword
6698 % for @headings -- no section number, don't include in toc,
6699 % and don't redefine \lastsection.
6700 \setbox0 = \hbox{}%
6701 \def\toctype{omit}%
6702 \let\sectionlevel=\empty
6703 \else\ifx\temptype\Yappendixkeyword
6704 \setbox0 = \hbox{#4\enspace}%
6705 \def\toctype{app}%
6706 \gdef\lastsection{#1}%
6707 \else
6708 \setbox0 = \hbox{#4\enspace}%
6709 \def\toctype{num}%
6710 \gdef\lastsection{#1}%
6711 \fi\fi\fi
6713 % Write the toc entry (before \donoderef). See comments in \chapmacro.
6714 \writetocentry{\toctype\sectionlevel}{#1}{#4}%
6716 % Write the node reference (= pdf destination for pdftex).
6717 % Again, see comments in \chapmacro.
6718 \donoderef{#3}%
6720 % Interline glue will be inserted when the vbox is completed.
6721 % That glue will be a valid breakpoint for the page, since it'll be
6722 % preceded by a whatsit (usually from the \donoderef, or from the
6723 % \writetocentry if there was no node). We don't want to allow that
6724 % break, since then the whatsits could end up on page n while the
6725 % section is on page n+1, thus toc/etc. are wrong. Debian bug 276000.
6726 \nobreak
6728 % Output the actual section heading.
6729 \vbox{\hyphenpenalty=10000 \tolerance=5000 \parindent=0pt \ptexraggedright
6730 \hangindent=\wd0 % zero if no section number
6731 \unhbox0 #1}%
6733 % Add extra space after the heading -- half of whatever came above it.
6734 % Don't allow stretch, though.
6735 \kern .5 \csname #2headingskip\endcsname
6737 % Do not let the kern be a potential breakpoint, as it would be if it
6738 % was followed by glue.
6739 \nobreak
6741 % We'll almost certainly start a paragraph next, so don't let that
6742 % glue accumulate. (Not a breakpoint because it's preceded by a
6743 % discardable item.) However, when a paragraph is not started next
6744 % (\startdefun, \cartouche, \center, etc.), this needs to be wiped out
6745 % or the negative glue will cause weirdly wrong output, typically
6746 % obscuring the section heading with something else.
6747 \vskip-\parskip
6749 % This is so the last item on the main vertical list is a known
6750 % \penalty > 10000, so \startdefun, etc., can recognize the situation
6751 % and do the needful.
6752 \penalty 10001
6756 \message{toc,}
6757 % Table of contents.
6758 \newwrite\tocfile
6760 % Write an entry to the toc file, opening it if necessary.
6761 % Called from @chapter, etc.
6763 % Example usage: \writetocentry{sec}{Section Name}{\the\chapno.\the\secno}
6764 % We append the current node name (if any) and page number as additional
6765 % arguments for the \{chap,sec,...}entry macros which will eventually
6766 % read this. The node name is used in the pdf outlines as the
6767 % destination to jump to.
6769 % We open the .toc file for writing here instead of at @setfilename (or
6770 % any other fixed time) so that @contents can be anywhere in the document.
6771 % But if #1 is `omit', then we don't do anything. This is used for the
6772 % table of contents chapter openings themselves.
6774 \newif\iftocfileopened
6775 \def\omitkeyword{omit}%
6777 \def\writetocentry#1#2#3{%
6778 \edef\writetoctype{#1}%
6779 \ifx\writetoctype\omitkeyword \else
6780 \iftocfileopened\else
6781 \immediate\openout\tocfile = \jobname.toc
6782 \global\tocfileopenedtrue
6785 \iflinks
6786 {\atdummies
6787 \edef\temp{%
6788 \write\tocfile{@#1entry{#2}{#3}{\lastnode}{\noexpand\folio}}}%
6789 \temp
6794 % Tell \shipout to create a pdf destination on each page, if we're
6795 % writing pdf. These are used in the table of contents. We can't
6796 % just write one on every page because the title pages are numbered
6797 % 1 and 2 (the page numbers aren't printed), and so are the first
6798 % two pages of the document. Thus, we'd have two destinations named
6799 % `1', and two named `2'.
6800 \ifpdf
6801 \global\pdfmakepagedesttrue
6802 \else
6803 \ifx\XeTeXrevision\thisisundefined
6804 \else
6805 \global\pdfmakepagedesttrue
6811 % These characters do not print properly in the Computer Modern roman
6812 % fonts, so we must take special care. This is more or less redundant
6813 % with the Texinfo input format setup at the end of this file.
6815 \def\activecatcodes{%
6816 \catcode`\"=\active
6817 \catcode`\$=\active
6818 \catcode`\<=\active
6819 \catcode`\>=\active
6820 \catcode`\\=\active
6821 \catcode`\^=\active
6822 \catcode`\_=\active
6823 \catcode`\|=\active
6824 \catcode`\~=\active
6828 % Read the toc file, which is essentially Texinfo input.
6829 \def\readtocfile{%
6830 \setupdatafile
6831 \activecatcodes
6832 \input \tocreadfilename
6835 \newskip\contentsrightmargin \contentsrightmargin=1in
6836 \newcount\savepageno
6837 \newcount\lastnegativepageno \lastnegativepageno = -1
6839 % Prepare to read what we've written to \tocfile.
6841 \def\startcontents#1{%
6842 % If @setchapternewpage on, and @headings double, the contents should
6843 % start on an odd page, unlike chapters. Thus, we maintain
6844 % \contentsalignmacro in parallel with \pagealignmacro.
6845 % From: Torbjorn Granlund <tege@matematik.su.se>
6846 \contentsalignmacro
6847 \immediate\closeout\tocfile
6849 % Don't need to put `Contents' or `Short Contents' in the headline.
6850 % It is abundantly clear what they are.
6851 \chapmacro{#1}{Yomitfromtoc}{}%
6853 \savepageno = \pageno
6854 \begingroup % Set up to handle contents files properly.
6855 \raggedbottom % Worry more about breakpoints than the bottom.
6856 \entryrightmargin=\contentsrightmargin % Don't use the full line length.
6858 % Roman numerals for page numbers.
6859 \ifnum \pageno>0 \global\pageno = \lastnegativepageno \fi
6862 % redefined for the two-volume lispref. We always output on
6863 % \jobname.toc even if this is redefined.
6865 \def\tocreadfilename{\jobname.toc}
6867 % Normal (long) toc.
6869 \def\contents{%
6870 \startcontents{\putwordTOC}%
6871 \openin 1 \tocreadfilename\space
6872 \ifeof 1 \else
6873 \readtocfile
6875 \vfill \eject
6876 \contentsalignmacro % in case @setchapternewpage odd is in effect
6877 \ifeof 1 \else
6878 \pdfmakeoutlines
6880 \closein 1
6881 \endgroup
6882 \lastnegativepageno = \pageno
6883 \global\pageno = \savepageno
6886 % And just the chapters.
6887 \def\summarycontents{%
6888 \startcontents{\putwordShortTOC}%
6890 \let\partentry = \shortpartentry
6891 \let\numchapentry = \shortchapentry
6892 \let\appentry = \shortchapentry
6893 \let\unnchapentry = \shortunnchapentry
6894 % We want a true roman here for the page numbers.
6895 \secfonts
6896 \let\rm=\shortcontrm \let\bf=\shortcontbf
6897 \let\sl=\shortcontsl \let\tt=\shortconttt
6899 \hyphenpenalty = 10000
6900 \advance\baselineskip by 1pt % Open it up a little.
6901 \def\numsecentry##1##2##3##4{}
6902 \let\appsecentry = \numsecentry
6903 \let\unnsecentry = \numsecentry
6904 \let\numsubsecentry = \numsecentry
6905 \let\appsubsecentry = \numsecentry
6906 \let\unnsubsecentry = \numsecentry
6907 \let\numsubsubsecentry = \numsecentry
6908 \let\appsubsubsecentry = \numsecentry
6909 \let\unnsubsubsecentry = \numsecentry
6910 \openin 1 \tocreadfilename\space
6911 \ifeof 1 \else
6912 \readtocfile
6914 \closein 1
6915 \vfill \eject
6916 \contentsalignmacro % in case @setchapternewpage odd is in effect
6917 \endgroup
6918 \lastnegativepageno = \pageno
6919 \global\pageno = \savepageno
6921 \let\shortcontents = \summarycontents
6923 % Typeset the label for a chapter or appendix for the short contents.
6924 % The arg is, e.g., `A' for an appendix, or `3' for a chapter.
6926 \def\shortchaplabel#1{%
6927 % This space should be enough, since a single number is .5em, and the
6928 % widest letter (M) is 1em, at least in the Computer Modern fonts.
6929 % But use \hss just in case.
6930 % (This space doesn't include the extra space that gets added after
6931 % the label; that gets put in by \shortchapentry above.)
6933 % We'd like to right-justify chapter numbers, but that looks strange
6934 % with appendix letters. And right-justifying numbers and
6935 % left-justifying letters looks strange when there is less than 10
6936 % chapters. Have to read the whole toc once to know how many chapters
6937 % there are before deciding ...
6938 \hbox to 1em{#1\hss}%
6941 % These macros generate individual entries in the table of contents.
6942 % The first argument is the chapter or section name.
6943 % The last argument is the page number.
6944 % The arguments in between are the chapter number, section number, ...
6946 % Parts, in the main contents. Replace the part number, which doesn't
6947 % exist, with an empty box. Let's hope all the numbers have the same width.
6948 % Also ignore the page number, which is conventionally not printed.
6949 \def\numeralbox{\setbox0=\hbox{8}\hbox to \wd0{\hfil}}
6950 \def\partentry#1#2#3#4{%
6951 % Add stretch and a bonus for breaking the page before the part heading.
6952 % This reduces the chance of the page being broken immediately after the
6953 % part heading, before a following chapter heading.
6954 \vskip 0pt plus 5\baselineskip
6955 \penalty-300
6956 \vskip 0pt plus -5\baselineskip
6957 \dochapentry{\numeralbox\labelspace#1}{}%
6960 % Parts, in the short toc.
6961 \def\shortpartentry#1#2#3#4{%
6962 \penalty-300
6963 \vskip.5\baselineskip plus.15\baselineskip minus.1\baselineskip
6964 \shortchapentry{{\bf #1}}{\numeralbox}{}{}%
6967 % Chapters, in the main contents.
6968 \def\numchapentry#1#2#3#4{\dochapentry{#2\labelspace#1}{#4}}
6970 % Chapters, in the short toc.
6971 % See comments in \dochapentry re vbox and related settings.
6972 \def\shortchapentry#1#2#3#4{%
6973 \tocentry{\shortchaplabel{#2}\labelspace #1}{\doshortpageno\bgroup#4\egroup}%
6976 % Appendices, in the main contents.
6977 % Need the word Appendix, and a fixed-size box.
6979 \def\appendixbox#1{%
6980 % We use M since it's probably the widest letter.
6981 \setbox0 = \hbox{\putwordAppendix{} M}%
6982 \hbox to \wd0{\putwordAppendix{} #1\hss}}
6984 \def\appentry#1#2#3#4{\dochapentry{\appendixbox{#2}\hskip.7em#1}{#4}}
6986 % Unnumbered chapters.
6987 \def\unnchapentry#1#2#3#4{\dochapentry{#1}{#4}}
6988 \def\shortunnchapentry#1#2#3#4{\tocentry{#1}{\doshortpageno\bgroup#4\egroup}}
6990 % Sections.
6991 \def\numsecentry#1#2#3#4{\dosecentry{#2\labelspace#1}{#4}}
6992 \let\appsecentry=\numsecentry
6993 \def\unnsecentry#1#2#3#4{\dosecentry{#1}{#4}}
6995 % Subsections.
6996 \def\numsubsecentry#1#2#3#4{\dosubsecentry{#2\labelspace#1}{#4}}
6997 \let\appsubsecentry=\numsubsecentry
6998 \def\unnsubsecentry#1#2#3#4{\dosubsecentry{#1}{#4}}
7000 % And subsubsections.
7001 \def\numsubsubsecentry#1#2#3#4{\dosubsubsecentry{#2\labelspace#1}{#4}}
7002 \let\appsubsubsecentry=\numsubsubsecentry
7003 \def\unnsubsubsecentry#1#2#3#4{\dosubsubsecentry{#1}{#4}}
7005 % This parameter controls the indentation of the various levels.
7006 % Same as \defaultparindent.
7007 \newdimen\tocindent \tocindent = 15pt
7009 % Now for the actual typesetting. In all these, #1 is the text and #2 is the
7010 % page number.
7012 % If the toc has to be broken over pages, we want it to be at chapters
7013 % if at all possible; hence the \penalty.
7014 \def\dochapentry#1#2{%
7015 \penalty-300 \vskip1\baselineskip plus.33\baselineskip minus.25\baselineskip
7016 \begingroup
7017 % Move the page numbers slightly to the right
7018 \advance\entryrightmargin by -0.05em
7019 \chapentryfonts
7020 \tocentry{#1}{\dopageno\bgroup#2\egroup}%
7021 \endgroup
7022 \nobreak\vskip .25\baselineskip plus.1\baselineskip
7025 \def\dosecentry#1#2{\begingroup
7026 \secentryfonts \leftskip=\tocindent
7027 \tocentry{#1}{\dopageno\bgroup#2\egroup}%
7028 \endgroup}
7030 \def\dosubsecentry#1#2{\begingroup
7031 \subsecentryfonts \leftskip=2\tocindent
7032 \tocentry{#1}{\dopageno\bgroup#2\egroup}%
7033 \endgroup}
7035 \def\dosubsubsecentry#1#2{\begingroup
7036 \subsubsecentryfonts \leftskip=3\tocindent
7037 \tocentry{#1}{\dopageno\bgroup#2\egroup}%
7038 \endgroup}
7040 % We use the same \entry macro as for the index entries.
7041 \let\tocentry = \entry
7043 % Space between chapter (or whatever) number and the title.
7044 \def\labelspace{\hskip1em \relax}
7046 \def\dopageno#1{{\rm #1}}
7047 \def\doshortpageno#1{{\rm #1}}
7049 \def\chapentryfonts{\secfonts \rm}
7050 \def\secentryfonts{\textfonts}
7051 \def\subsecentryfonts{\textfonts}
7052 \def\subsubsecentryfonts{\textfonts}
7055 \message{environments,}
7056 % @foo ... @end foo.
7058 % @tex ... @end tex escapes into raw TeX temporarily.
7059 % One exception: @ is still an escape character, so that @end tex works.
7060 % But \@ or @@ will get a plain @ character.
7062 \envdef\tex{%
7063 \setupmarkupstyle{tex}%
7064 \catcode `\\=0 \catcode `\{=1 \catcode `\}=2
7065 \catcode `\$=3 \catcode `\&=4 \catcode `\#=6
7066 \catcode `\^=7 \catcode `\_=8 \catcode `\~=\active \let~=\tie
7067 \catcode `\%=14
7068 \catcode `\+=\other
7069 \catcode `\"=\other
7070 \catcode `\|=\other
7071 \catcode `\<=\other
7072 \catcode `\>=\other
7073 \catcode `\`=\other
7074 \catcode `\'=\other
7076 % ' is active in math mode (mathcode"8000). So reset it, and all our
7077 % other math active characters (just in case), to plain's definitions.
7078 \mathactive
7080 % Inverse of the list at the beginning of the file.
7081 \let\b=\ptexb
7082 \let\bullet=\ptexbullet
7083 \let\c=\ptexc
7084 \let\,=\ptexcomma
7085 \let\.=\ptexdot
7086 \let\dots=\ptexdots
7087 \let\equiv=\ptexequiv
7088 \let\!=\ptexexclam
7089 \let\i=\ptexi
7090 \let\indent=\ptexindent
7091 \let\noindent=\ptexnoindent
7092 \let\{=\ptexlbrace
7093 \let\+=\tabalign
7094 \let\}=\ptexrbrace
7095 \let\/=\ptexslash
7096 \let\sp=\ptexsp
7097 \let\*=\ptexstar
7098 %\let\sup=\ptexsup % do not redefine, we want @sup to work in math mode
7099 \let\t=\ptext
7100 \expandafter \let\csname top\endcsname=\ptextop % we've made it outer
7101 \let\frenchspacing=\plainfrenchspacing
7103 \def\endldots{\mathinner{\ldots\ldots\ldots\ldots}}%
7104 \def\enddots{\relax\ifmmode\endldots\else$\mathsurround=0pt \endldots\,$\fi}%
7105 \def\@{@}%
7107 % There is no need to define \Etex.
7109 % Define @lisp ... @end lisp.
7110 % @lisp environment forms a group so it can rebind things,
7111 % including the definition of @end lisp (which normally is erroneous).
7113 % Amount to narrow the margins by for @lisp.
7114 \newskip\lispnarrowing \lispnarrowing=0.4in
7116 % This is the definition that ^^M gets inside @lisp, @example, and other
7117 % such environments. \null is better than a space, since it doesn't
7118 % have any width.
7119 \def\lisppar{\null\endgraf}
7121 % This space is always present above and below environments.
7122 \newskip\envskipamount \envskipamount = 0pt
7124 % Make spacing and below environment symmetrical. We use \parskip here
7125 % to help in doing that, since in @example-like environments \parskip
7126 % is reset to zero; thus the \afterenvbreak inserts no space -- but the
7127 % start of the next paragraph will insert \parskip.
7129 \def\aboveenvbreak{{%
7130 % =10000 instead of <10000 because of a special case in \itemzzz and
7131 % \sectionheading, q.v.
7132 \ifnum \lastpenalty=10000 \else
7133 \advance\envskipamount by \parskip
7134 \endgraf
7135 \ifdim\lastskip<\envskipamount
7136 \removelastskip
7137 \ifnum\lastpenalty<10000
7138 % Penalize breaking before the environment, because preceding text
7139 % often leads into it.
7140 \penalty100
7142 \vskip\envskipamount
7147 \def\afterenvbreak{{%
7148 % =10000 instead of <10000 because of a special case in \itemzzz and
7149 % \sectionheading, q.v.
7150 \ifnum \lastpenalty=10000 \else
7151 \advance\envskipamount by \parskip
7152 \endgraf
7153 \ifdim\lastskip<\envskipamount
7154 \removelastskip
7155 % it's not a good place to break if the last penalty was \nobreak
7156 % or better ...
7157 \ifnum\lastpenalty<10000 \penalty-50 \fi
7158 \vskip\envskipamount
7163 % \nonarrowing is a flag. If "set", @lisp etc don't narrow margins; it will
7164 % also clear it, so that its embedded environments do the narrowing again.
7165 \let\nonarrowing=\relax
7167 % @cartouche ... @end cartouche: draw rectangle w/rounded corners around
7168 % environment contents.
7169 \font\circle=lcircle10
7170 \newdimen\circthick
7171 \newdimen\cartouter\newdimen\cartinner
7172 \newskip\normbskip\newskip\normpskip\newskip\normlskip
7173 \circthick=\fontdimen8\circle
7175 \def\ctl{{\circle\char'013\hskip -6pt}}% 6pt from pl file: 1/2charwidth
7176 \def\ctr{{\hskip 6pt\circle\char'010}}
7177 \def\cbl{{\circle\char'012\hskip -6pt}}
7178 \def\cbr{{\hskip 6pt\circle\char'011}}
7179 \def\carttop{\hbox to \cartouter{\hskip\lskip
7180 \ctl\leaders\hrule height\circthick\hfil\ctr
7181 \hskip\rskip}}
7182 \def\cartbot{\hbox to \cartouter{\hskip\lskip
7183 \cbl\leaders\hrule height\circthick\hfil\cbr
7184 \hskip\rskip}}
7186 \newskip\lskip\newskip\rskip
7188 \envdef\cartouche{%
7189 \ifhmode\par\fi % can't be in the midst of a paragraph.
7190 \startsavinginserts
7191 \lskip=\leftskip \rskip=\rightskip
7192 \leftskip=0pt\rightskip=0pt % we want these *outside*.
7193 \cartinner=\hsize \advance\cartinner by-\lskip
7194 \advance\cartinner by-\rskip
7195 \cartouter=\hsize
7196 \advance\cartouter by 18.4pt % allow for 3pt kerns on either
7197 % side, and for 6pt waste from
7198 % each corner char, and rule thickness
7199 \normbskip=\baselineskip \normpskip=\parskip \normlskip=\lineskip
7201 % If this cartouche directly follows a sectioning command, we need the
7202 % \parskip glue (backspaced over by default) or the cartouche can
7203 % collide with the section heading.
7204 \ifnum\lastpenalty>10000 \vskip\parskip \penalty\lastpenalty \fi
7206 \setbox\groupbox=\vbox\bgroup
7207 \baselineskip=0pt\parskip=0pt\lineskip=0pt
7208 \carttop
7209 \hbox\bgroup
7210 \hskip\lskip
7211 \vrule\kern3pt
7212 \vbox\bgroup
7213 \kern3pt
7214 \hsize=\cartinner
7215 \baselineskip=\normbskip
7216 \lineskip=\normlskip
7217 \parskip=\normpskip
7218 \vskip -\parskip
7219 \comment % For explanation, see the end of def\group.
7221 \def\Ecartouche{%
7222 \ifhmode\par\fi
7223 \kern3pt
7224 \egroup
7225 \kern3pt\vrule
7226 \hskip\rskip
7227 \egroup
7228 \cartbot
7229 \egroup
7230 \addgroupbox
7231 \checkinserts
7235 % This macro is called at the beginning of all the @example variants,
7236 % inside a group.
7237 \newdimen\nonfillparindent
7238 \def\nonfillstart{%
7239 \aboveenvbreak
7240 \ifdim\hfuzz < 12pt \hfuzz = 12pt \fi % Don't be fussy
7241 \sepspaces % Make spaces be word-separators rather than space tokens.
7242 \let\par = \lisppar % don't ignore blank lines
7243 \obeylines % each line of input is a line of output
7244 \parskip = 0pt
7245 % Turn off paragraph indentation but redefine \indent to emulate
7246 % the normal \indent.
7247 \nonfillparindent=\parindent
7248 \parindent = 0pt
7249 \let\indent\nonfillindent
7251 \emergencystretch = 0pt % don't try to avoid overfull boxes
7252 \ifx\nonarrowing\relax
7253 \advance \leftskip by \lispnarrowing
7254 \exdentamount=\lispnarrowing
7255 \else
7256 \let\nonarrowing = \relax
7258 \let\exdent=\nofillexdent
7261 \begingroup
7262 \obeyspaces
7263 % We want to swallow spaces (but not other tokens) after the fake
7264 % @indent in our nonfill-environments, where spaces are normally
7265 % active and set to @tie, resulting in them not being ignored after
7266 % @indent.
7267 \gdef\nonfillindent{\futurelet\temp\nonfillindentcheck}%
7268 \gdef\nonfillindentcheck{%
7269 \ifx\temp %
7270 \expandafter\nonfillindentgobble%
7271 \else%
7272 \leavevmode\nonfillindentbox%
7273 \fi%
7275 \endgroup
7276 \def\nonfillindentgobble#1{\nonfillindent}
7277 \def\nonfillindentbox{\hbox to \nonfillparindent{\hss}}
7279 % If you want all examples etc. small: @set dispenvsize small.
7280 % If you want even small examples the full size: @set dispenvsize nosmall.
7281 % This affects the following displayed environments:
7282 % @example, @display, @format, @lisp
7284 \def\smallword{small}
7285 \def\nosmallword{nosmall}
7286 \let\SETdispenvsize\relax
7287 \def\setnormaldispenv{%
7288 \ifx\SETdispenvsize\smallword
7289 % end paragraph for sake of leading, in case document has no blank
7290 % line. This is redundant with what happens in \aboveenvbreak, but
7291 % we need to do it before changing the fonts, and it's inconvenient
7292 % to change the fonts afterward.
7293 \ifnum \lastpenalty=10000 \else \endgraf \fi
7294 \smallexamplefonts \rm
7297 \def\setsmalldispenv{%
7298 \ifx\SETdispenvsize\nosmallword
7299 \else
7300 \ifnum \lastpenalty=10000 \else \endgraf \fi
7301 \smallexamplefonts \rm
7305 % We often define two environments, @foo and @smallfoo.
7306 % Let's do it in one command. #1 is the env name, #2 the definition.
7307 \def\makedispenvdef#1#2{%
7308 \expandafter\envdef\csname#1\endcsname {\setnormaldispenv #2}%
7309 \expandafter\envdef\csname small#1\endcsname {\setsmalldispenv #2}%
7310 \expandafter\let\csname E#1\endcsname \afterenvbreak
7311 \expandafter\let\csname Esmall#1\endcsname \afterenvbreak
7314 % Define two environment synonyms (#1 and #2) for an environment.
7315 \def\maketwodispenvdef#1#2#3{%
7316 \makedispenvdef{#1}{#3}%
7317 \makedispenvdef{#2}{#3}%
7320 % @lisp: indented, narrowed, typewriter font;
7321 % @example: same as @lisp.
7323 % @smallexample and @smalllisp: use smaller fonts.
7324 % Originally contributed by Pavel@xerox.
7326 \maketwodispenvdef{lisp}{example}{%
7327 \nonfillstart
7328 \tt\setupmarkupstyle{example}%
7329 \let\kbdfont = \kbdexamplefont % Allow @kbd to do something special.
7330 \gobble % eat return
7332 % @display/@smalldisplay: same as @lisp except keep current font.
7334 \makedispenvdef{display}{%
7335 \nonfillstart
7336 \gobble
7339 % @format/@smallformat: same as @display except don't narrow margins.
7341 \makedispenvdef{format}{%
7342 \let\nonarrowing = t%
7343 \nonfillstart
7344 \gobble
7347 % @flushleft: same as @format, but doesn't obey \SETdispenvsize.
7348 \envdef\flushleft{%
7349 \let\nonarrowing = t%
7350 \nonfillstart
7351 \gobble
7353 \let\Eflushleft = \afterenvbreak
7355 % @flushright.
7357 \envdef\flushright{%
7358 \let\nonarrowing = t%
7359 \nonfillstart
7360 \advance\leftskip by 0pt plus 1fill\relax
7361 \gobble
7363 \let\Eflushright = \afterenvbreak
7366 % @raggedright does more-or-less normal line breaking but no right
7367 % justification. From plain.tex. Don't stretch around special
7368 % characters in urls in this environment, since the stretch at the right
7369 % should be enough.
7370 \envdef\raggedright{%
7371 \rightskip0pt plus2.4em \spaceskip.3333em \xspaceskip.5em\relax
7372 \def\urefprestretchamount{0pt}%
7373 \def\urefpoststretchamount{0pt}%
7375 \let\Eraggedright\par
7377 \envdef\raggedleft{%
7378 \parindent=0pt \leftskip0pt plus2em
7379 \spaceskip.3333em \xspaceskip.5em \parfillskip=0pt
7380 \hbadness=10000 % Last line will usually be underfull, so turn off
7381 % badness reporting.
7383 \let\Eraggedleft\par
7385 \envdef\raggedcenter{%
7386 \parindent=0pt \rightskip0pt plus1em \leftskip0pt plus1em
7387 \spaceskip.3333em \xspaceskip.5em \parfillskip=0pt
7388 \hbadness=10000 % Last line will usually be underfull, so turn off
7389 % badness reporting.
7391 \let\Eraggedcenter\par
7394 % @quotation does normal linebreaking (hence we can't use \nonfillstart)
7395 % and narrows the margins. We keep \parskip nonzero in general, since
7396 % we're doing normal filling. So, when using \aboveenvbreak and
7397 % \afterenvbreak, temporarily make \parskip 0.
7399 \makedispenvdef{quotation}{\quotationstart}
7401 \def\quotationstart{%
7402 \indentedblockstart % same as \indentedblock, but increase right margin too.
7403 \ifx\nonarrowing\relax
7404 \advance\rightskip by \lispnarrowing
7406 \parsearg\quotationlabel
7409 % We have retained a nonzero parskip for the environment, since we're
7410 % doing normal filling.
7412 \def\Equotation{%
7413 \par
7414 \ifx\quotationauthor\thisisundefined\else
7415 % indent a bit.
7416 \leftline{\kern 2\leftskip \sl ---\quotationauthor}%
7418 {\parskip=0pt \afterenvbreak}%
7420 \def\Esmallquotation{\Equotation}
7422 % If we're given an argument, typeset it in bold with a colon after.
7423 \def\quotationlabel#1{%
7424 \def\temp{#1}%
7425 \ifx\temp\empty \else
7426 {\bf #1: }%
7430 % @indentedblock is like @quotation, but indents only on the left and
7431 % has no optional argument.
7433 \makedispenvdef{indentedblock}{\indentedblockstart}
7435 \def\indentedblockstart{%
7436 {\parskip=0pt \aboveenvbreak}% because \aboveenvbreak inserts \parskip
7437 \parindent=0pt
7439 % @cartouche defines \nonarrowing to inhibit narrowing at next level down.
7440 \ifx\nonarrowing\relax
7441 \advance\leftskip by \lispnarrowing
7442 \exdentamount = \lispnarrowing
7443 \else
7444 \let\nonarrowing = \relax
7448 % Keep a nonzero parskip for the environment, since we're doing normal filling.
7450 \def\Eindentedblock{%
7451 \par
7452 {\parskip=0pt \afterenvbreak}%
7454 \def\Esmallindentedblock{\Eindentedblock}
7457 % LaTeX-like @verbatim...@end verbatim and @verb{<char>...<char>}
7458 % If we want to allow any <char> as delimiter,
7459 % we need the curly braces so that makeinfo sees the @verb command, eg:
7460 % `@verbx...x' would look like the '@verbx' command. --janneke@gnu.org
7462 % [Knuth]: Donald Ervin Knuth, 1996. The TeXbook.
7464 % [Knuth] p.344; only we need to do the other characters Texinfo sets
7465 % active too. Otherwise, they get lost as the first character on a
7466 % verbatim line.
7467 \def\dospecials{%
7468 \do\ \do\\\do\{\do\}\do\$\do\&%
7469 \do\#\do\^\do\^^K\do\_\do\^^A\do\%\do\~%
7470 \do\<\do\>\do\|\do\@\do+\do\"%
7471 % Don't do the quotes -- if we do, @set txicodequoteundirected and
7472 % @set txicodequotebacktick will not have effect on @verb and
7473 % @verbatim, and ?` and !` ligatures won't get disabled.
7474 %\do\`\do\'%
7477 % [Knuth] p. 380
7478 \def\uncatcodespecials{%
7479 \def\do##1{\catcode`##1=\other}\dospecials}
7481 % Setup for the @verb command.
7483 % Eight spaces for a tab
7484 \begingroup
7485 \catcode`\^^I=\active
7486 \gdef\tabeightspaces{\catcode`\^^I=\active\def^^I{\ \ \ \ \ \ \ \ }}
7487 \endgroup
7489 \def\setupverb{%
7490 \tt % easiest (and conventionally used) font for verbatim
7491 \def\par{\leavevmode\endgraf}%
7492 \setupmarkupstyle{verb}%
7493 \tabeightspaces
7494 % Respect line breaks,
7495 % print special symbols as themselves, and
7496 % make each space count
7497 % must do in this order:
7498 \obeylines \uncatcodespecials \sepspaces
7501 % Setup for the @verbatim environment
7503 % Real tab expansion.
7504 \newdimen\tabw \setbox0=\hbox{\tt\space} \tabw=8\wd0 % tab amount
7506 % We typeset each line of the verbatim in an \hbox, so we can handle
7507 % tabs. The \global is in case the verbatim line starts with an accent,
7508 % or some other command that starts with a begin-group. Otherwise, the
7509 % entire \verbbox would disappear at the corresponding end-group, before
7510 % it is typeset. Meanwhile, we can't have nested verbatim commands
7511 % (can we?), so the \global won't be overwriting itself.
7512 \newbox\verbbox
7513 \def\starttabbox{\global\setbox\verbbox=\hbox\bgroup}
7515 \begingroup
7516 \catcode`\^^I=\active
7517 \gdef\tabexpand{%
7518 \catcode`\^^I=\active
7519 \def^^I{\leavevmode\egroup
7520 \dimen\verbbox=\wd\verbbox % the width so far, or since the previous tab
7521 \divide\dimen\verbbox by\tabw
7522 \multiply\dimen\verbbox by\tabw % compute previous multiple of \tabw
7523 \advance\dimen\verbbox by\tabw % advance to next multiple of \tabw
7524 \wd\verbbox=\dimen\verbbox \box\verbbox \starttabbox
7527 \endgroup
7529 % start the verbatim environment.
7530 \def\setupverbatim{%
7531 \let\nonarrowing = t%
7532 \nonfillstart
7533 \tt % easiest (and conventionally used) font for verbatim
7534 % The \leavevmode here is for blank lines. Otherwise, we would
7535 % never \starttabox and the \egroup would end verbatim mode.
7536 \def\par{\leavevmode\egroup\box\verbbox\endgraf}%
7537 \tabexpand
7538 \setupmarkupstyle{verbatim}%
7539 % Respect line breaks,
7540 % print special symbols as themselves, and
7541 % make each space count.
7542 % Must do in this order:
7543 \obeylines \uncatcodespecials \sepspaces
7544 \everypar{\starttabbox}%
7547 % Do the @verb magic: verbatim text is quoted by unique
7548 % delimiter characters. Before first delimiter expect a
7549 % right brace, after last delimiter expect closing brace:
7551 % \def\doverb'{'<char>#1<char>'}'{#1}
7553 % [Knuth] p. 382; only eat outer {}
7554 \begingroup
7555 \catcode`[=1\catcode`]=2\catcode`\{=\other\catcode`\}=\other
7556 \gdef\doverb{#1[\def\next##1#1}[##1\endgroup]\next]
7557 \endgroup
7559 \def\verb{\begingroup\setupverb\doverb}
7562 % Do the @verbatim magic: define the macro \doverbatim so that
7563 % the (first) argument ends when '@end verbatim' is reached, ie:
7565 % \def\doverbatim#1@end verbatim{#1}
7567 % For Texinfo it's a lot easier than for LaTeX,
7568 % because texinfo's \verbatim doesn't stop at '\end{verbatim}':
7569 % we need not redefine '\', '{' and '}'.
7571 % Inspired by LaTeX's verbatim command set [latex.ltx]
7573 \begingroup
7574 \catcode`\ =\active
7575 \obeylines %
7576 % ignore everything up to the first ^^M, that's the newline at the end
7577 % of the @verbatim input line itself. Otherwise we get an extra blank
7578 % line in the output.
7579 \xdef\doverbatim#1^^M#2@end verbatim{#2\noexpand\end\gobble verbatim}%
7580 % We really want {...\end verbatim} in the body of the macro, but
7581 % without the active space; thus we have to use \xdef and \gobble.
7582 \endgroup
7584 \envdef\verbatim{%
7585 \setupverbatim\doverbatim
7587 \let\Everbatim = \afterenvbreak
7590 % @verbatiminclude FILE - insert text of file in verbatim environment.
7592 \def\verbatiminclude{\parseargusing\filenamecatcodes\doverbatiminclude}
7594 \def\doverbatiminclude#1{%
7596 \makevalueexpandable
7597 \setupverbatim
7598 \indexnofonts % Allow `@@' and other weird things in file names.
7599 \wlog{texinfo.tex: doing @verbatiminclude of #1^^J}%
7600 \input #1
7601 \afterenvbreak
7605 % @copying ... @end copying.
7606 % Save the text away for @insertcopying later.
7608 % We save the uninterpreted tokens, rather than creating a box.
7609 % Saving the text in a box would be much easier, but then all the
7610 % typesetting commands (@smallbook, font changes, etc.) have to be done
7611 % beforehand -- and a) we want @copying to be done first in the source
7612 % file; b) letting users define the frontmatter in as flexible order as
7613 % possible is desirable.
7615 \def\copying{\checkenv{}\begingroup\scanargctxt\docopying}
7616 \def\docopying#1@end copying{\endgroup\def\copyingtext{#1}}
7618 \def\insertcopying{%
7619 \begingroup
7620 \parindent = 0pt % paragraph indentation looks wrong on title page
7621 \scanexp\copyingtext
7622 \endgroup
7626 \message{defuns,}
7627 % @defun etc.
7629 \newskip\defbodyindent \defbodyindent=.4in
7630 \newskip\defargsindent \defargsindent=50pt
7631 \newskip\deflastargmargin \deflastargmargin=18pt
7632 \newcount\defunpenalty
7634 % Start the processing of @deffn:
7635 \def\startdefun{%
7636 \ifnum\lastpenalty<10000
7637 \medbreak
7638 \defunpenalty=10003 % Will keep this @deffn together with the
7639 % following @def command, see below.
7640 \else
7641 % If there are two @def commands in a row, we'll have a \nobreak,
7642 % which is there to keep the function description together with its
7643 % header. But if there's nothing but headers, we need to allow a
7644 % break somewhere. Check specifically for penalty 10002, inserted
7645 % by \printdefunline, instead of 10000, since the sectioning
7646 % commands also insert a nobreak penalty, and we don't want to allow
7647 % a break between a section heading and a defun.
7649 % As a further refinement, we avoid "club" headers by signalling
7650 % with penalty of 10003 after the very first @deffn in the
7651 % sequence (see above), and penalty of 10002 after any following
7652 % @def command.
7653 \ifnum\lastpenalty=10002 \penalty2000 \else \defunpenalty=10002 \fi
7655 % Similarly, after a section heading, do not allow a break.
7656 % But do insert the glue.
7657 \medskip % preceded by discardable penalty, so not a breakpoint
7660 \parindent=0in
7661 \advance\leftskip by \defbodyindent
7662 \exdentamount=\defbodyindent
7665 \def\dodefunx#1{%
7666 % First, check whether we are in the right environment:
7667 \checkenv#1%
7669 % As above, allow line break if we have multiple x headers in a row.
7670 % It's not a great place, though.
7671 \ifnum\lastpenalty=10002 \penalty3000 \else \defunpenalty=10002 \fi
7673 % And now, it's time to reuse the body of the original defun:
7674 \expandafter\gobbledefun#1%
7676 \def\gobbledefun#1\startdefun{}
7678 % \printdefunline \deffnheader{text}
7680 \def\printdefunline#1#2{%
7681 \begingroup
7682 % call \deffnheader:
7683 #1#2 \endheader
7684 % common ending:
7685 \interlinepenalty = 10000
7686 \advance\rightskip by 0pt plus 1fil\relax
7687 \endgraf
7688 \nobreak\vskip -\parskip
7689 \penalty\defunpenalty % signal to \startdefun and \dodefunx
7690 % Some of the @defun-type tags do not enable magic parentheses,
7691 % rendering the following check redundant. But we don't optimize.
7692 \checkparencounts
7693 \endgroup
7696 \def\Edefun{\endgraf\medbreak}
7698 % \makedefun{deffn} creates \deffn, \deffnx and \Edeffn;
7699 % the only thing remaining is to define \deffnheader.
7701 \def\makedefun#1{%
7702 \expandafter\let\csname E#1\endcsname = \Edefun
7703 \edef\temp{\noexpand\domakedefun
7704 \makecsname{#1}\makecsname{#1x}\makecsname{#1header}}%
7705 \temp
7708 % \domakedefun \deffn \deffnx \deffnheader { (defn. of \deffnheader) }
7710 % Define \deffn and \deffnx, without parameters.
7711 % \deffnheader has to be defined explicitly.
7713 \def\domakedefun#1#2#3{%
7714 \envdef#1{%
7715 \startdefun
7716 \doingtypefnfalse % distinguish typed functions from all else
7717 \parseargusing\activeparens{\printdefunline#3}%
7719 \def#2{\dodefunx#1}%
7720 \def#3%
7723 \newif\ifdoingtypefn % doing typed function?
7724 \newif\ifrettypeownline % typeset return type on its own line?
7726 % @deftypefnnewline on|off says whether the return type of typed functions
7727 % are printed on their own line. This affects @deftypefn, @deftypefun,
7728 % @deftypeop, and @deftypemethod.
7730 \parseargdef\deftypefnnewline{%
7731 \def\temp{#1}%
7732 \ifx\temp\onword
7733 \expandafter\let\csname SETtxideftypefnnl\endcsname
7734 = \empty
7735 \else\ifx\temp\offword
7736 \expandafter\let\csname SETtxideftypefnnl\endcsname
7737 = \relax
7738 \else
7739 \errhelp = \EMsimple
7740 \errmessage{Unknown @txideftypefnnl value `\temp',
7741 must be on|off}%
7742 \fi\fi
7745 % Untyped functions:
7747 % @deffn category name args
7748 \makedefun{deffn}{\deffngeneral{}}
7750 % @deffn category class name args
7751 \makedefun{defop}#1 {\defopon{#1\ \putwordon}}
7753 % \defopon {category on}class name args
7754 \def\defopon#1#2 {\deffngeneral{\putwordon\ \code{#2}}{#1\ \code{#2}} }
7756 % \deffngeneral {subind}category name args
7758 \def\deffngeneral#1#2 #3 #4\endheader{%
7759 % Remember that \dosubind{fn}{foo}{} is equivalent to \doind{fn}{foo}.
7760 \dosubind{fn}{\code{#3}}{#1}%
7761 \defname{#2}{}{#3}\magicamp\defunargs{#4\unskip}%
7764 % Typed functions:
7766 % @deftypefn category type name args
7767 \makedefun{deftypefn}{\deftypefngeneral{}}
7769 % @deftypeop category class type name args
7770 \makedefun{deftypeop}#1 {\deftypeopon{#1\ \putwordon}}
7772 % \deftypeopon {category on}class type name args
7773 \def\deftypeopon#1#2 {\deftypefngeneral{\putwordon\ \code{#2}}{#1\ \code{#2}} }
7775 % \deftypefngeneral {subind}category type name args
7777 \def\deftypefngeneral#1#2 #3 #4 #5\endheader{%
7778 \dosubind{fn}{\code{#4}}{#1}%
7779 \doingtypefntrue
7780 \defname{#2}{#3}{#4}\defunargs{#5\unskip}%
7783 % Typed variables:
7785 % @deftypevr category type var args
7786 \makedefun{deftypevr}{\deftypecvgeneral{}}
7788 % @deftypecv category class type var args
7789 \makedefun{deftypecv}#1 {\deftypecvof{#1\ \putwordof}}
7791 % \deftypecvof {category of}class type var args
7792 \def\deftypecvof#1#2 {\deftypecvgeneral{\putwordof\ \code{#2}}{#1\ \code{#2}} }
7794 % \deftypecvgeneral {subind}category type var args
7796 \def\deftypecvgeneral#1#2 #3 #4 #5\endheader{%
7797 \dosubind{vr}{\code{#4}}{#1}%
7798 \defname{#2}{#3}{#4}\defunargs{#5\unskip}%
7801 % Untyped variables:
7803 % @defvr category var args
7804 \makedefun{defvr}#1 {\deftypevrheader{#1} {} }
7806 % @defcv category class var args
7807 \makedefun{defcv}#1 {\defcvof{#1\ \putwordof}}
7809 % \defcvof {category of}class var args
7810 \def\defcvof#1#2 {\deftypecvof{#1}#2 {} }
7812 % Types:
7814 % @deftp category name args
7815 \makedefun{deftp}#1 #2 #3\endheader{%
7816 \doind{tp}{\code{#2}}%
7817 \defname{#1}{}{#2}\defunargs{#3\unskip}%
7820 % Remaining @defun-like shortcuts:
7821 \makedefun{defun}{\deffnheader{\putwordDeffunc} }
7822 \makedefun{defmac}{\deffnheader{\putwordDefmac} }
7823 \makedefun{defspec}{\deffnheader{\putwordDefspec} }
7824 \makedefun{deftypefun}{\deftypefnheader{\putwordDeffunc} }
7825 \makedefun{defvar}{\defvrheader{\putwordDefvar} }
7826 \makedefun{defopt}{\defvrheader{\putwordDefopt} }
7827 \makedefun{deftypevar}{\deftypevrheader{\putwordDefvar} }
7828 \makedefun{defmethod}{\defopon\putwordMethodon}
7829 \makedefun{deftypemethod}{\deftypeopon\putwordMethodon}
7830 \makedefun{defivar}{\defcvof\putwordInstanceVariableof}
7831 \makedefun{deftypeivar}{\deftypecvof\putwordInstanceVariableof}
7833 % \defname, which formats the name of the @def (not the args).
7834 % #1 is the category, such as "Function".
7835 % #2 is the return type, if any.
7836 % #3 is the function name.
7838 % We are followed by (but not passed) the arguments, if any.
7840 \def\defname#1#2#3{%
7841 \par
7842 % Get the values of \leftskip and \rightskip as they were outside the @def...
7843 \advance\leftskip by -\defbodyindent
7845 % Determine if we are typesetting the return type of a typed function
7846 % on a line by itself.
7847 \rettypeownlinefalse
7848 \ifdoingtypefn % doing a typed function specifically?
7849 % then check user option for putting return type on its own line:
7850 \expandafter\ifx\csname SETtxideftypefnnl\endcsname\relax \else
7851 \rettypeownlinetrue
7855 % How we'll format the category name. Putting it in brackets helps
7856 % distinguish it from the body text that may end up on the next line
7857 % just below it.
7858 \def\temp{#1}%
7859 \setbox0=\hbox{\kern\deflastargmargin \ifx\temp\empty\else [\rm\temp]\fi}
7861 % Figure out line sizes for the paragraph shape. We'll always have at
7862 % least two.
7863 \tempnum = 2
7865 % The first line needs space for \box0; but if \rightskip is nonzero,
7866 % we need only space for the part of \box0 which exceeds it:
7867 \dimen0=\hsize \advance\dimen0 by -\wd0 \advance\dimen0 by \rightskip
7869 % If doing a return type on its own line, we'll have another line.
7870 \ifrettypeownline
7871 \advance\tempnum by 1
7872 \def\maybeshapeline{0in \hsize}%
7873 \else
7874 \def\maybeshapeline{}%
7877 % The continuations:
7878 \dimen2=\hsize \advance\dimen2 by -\defargsindent
7880 % The final paragraph shape:
7881 \parshape \tempnum 0in \dimen0 \maybeshapeline \defargsindent \dimen2
7883 % Put the category name at the right margin.
7884 \noindent
7885 \hbox to 0pt{%
7886 \hfil\box0 \kern-\hsize
7887 % \hsize has to be shortened this way:
7888 \kern\leftskip
7889 % Intentionally do not respect \rightskip, since we need the space.
7892 % Allow all lines to be underfull without complaint:
7893 \tolerance=10000 \hbadness=10000
7894 \exdentamount=\defbodyindent
7896 % defun fonts. We use typewriter by default (used to be bold) because:
7897 % . we're printing identifiers, they should be in tt in principle.
7898 % . in languages with many accents, such as Czech or French, it's
7899 % common to leave accents off identifiers. The result looks ok in
7900 % tt, but exceedingly strange in rm.
7901 % . we don't want -- and --- to be treated as ligatures.
7902 % . this still does not fix the ?` and !` ligatures, but so far no
7903 % one has made identifiers using them :).
7904 \df \tt
7905 \def\temp{#2}% text of the return type
7906 \ifx\temp\empty\else
7907 \tclose{\temp}% typeset the return type
7908 \ifrettypeownline
7909 % put return type on its own line; prohibit line break following:
7910 \hfil\vadjust{\nobreak}\break
7911 \else
7912 \space % type on same line, so just followed by a space
7914 \fi % no return type
7915 #3% output function name
7917 {\rm\enskip}% hskip 0.5 em of \rmfont
7919 \boldbrax
7920 % arguments will be output next, if any.
7923 % Print arguments in slanted roman (not ttsl), inconsistently with using
7924 % tt for the name. This is because literal text is sometimes needed in
7925 % the argument list (groff manual), and ttsl and tt are not very
7926 % distinguishable. Prevent hyphenation at `-' chars.
7928 \def\defunargs#1{%
7929 % use sl by default (not ttsl),
7930 % tt for the names.
7931 \df \sl \hyphenchar\font=0
7933 % On the other hand, if an argument has two dashes (for instance), we
7934 % want a way to get ttsl. We used to recommend @var for that, so
7935 % leave the code in, but it's strange for @var to lead to typewriter.
7936 % Nowadays we recommend @code, since the difference between a ttsl hyphen
7937 % and a tt hyphen is pretty tiny. @code also disables ?` !`.
7938 \def\var##1{{\setupmarkupstyle{var}\ttslanted{##1}}}%
7940 \sl\hyphenchar\font=45
7943 % We want ()&[] to print specially on the defun line.
7945 \def\activeparens{%
7946 \catcode`\(=\active \catcode`\)=\active
7947 \catcode`\[=\active \catcode`\]=\active
7948 \catcode`\&=\active
7951 % Make control sequences which act like normal parenthesis chars.
7952 \let\lparen = ( \let\rparen = )
7954 % Be sure that we always have a definition for `(', etc. For example,
7955 % if the fn name has parens in it, \boldbrax will not be in effect yet,
7956 % so TeX would otherwise complain about undefined control sequence.
7958 \activeparens
7959 \global\let(=\lparen \global\let)=\rparen
7960 \global\let[=\lbrack \global\let]=\rbrack
7961 \global\let& = \&
7963 \gdef\boldbrax{\let(=\opnr\let)=\clnr\let[=\lbrb\let]=\rbrb}
7964 \gdef\magicamp{\let&=\amprm}
7967 \newcount\parencount
7969 % If we encounter &foo, then turn on ()-hacking afterwards
7970 \newif\ifampseen
7971 \def\amprm#1 {\ampseentrue{\bf\&#1 }}
7973 \def\parenfont{%
7974 \ifampseen
7975 % At the first level, print parens in roman,
7976 % otherwise use the default font.
7977 \ifnum \parencount=1 \rm \fi
7978 \else
7979 % The \sf parens (in \boldbrax) actually are a little bolder than
7980 % the contained text. This is especially needed for [ and ] .
7984 \def\infirstlevel#1{%
7985 \ifampseen
7986 \ifnum\parencount=1
7991 \def\bfafterword#1 {#1 \bf}
7993 \def\opnr{%
7994 \global\advance\parencount by 1
7995 {\parenfont(}%
7996 \infirstlevel \bfafterword
7998 \def\clnr{%
7999 {\parenfont)}%
8000 \infirstlevel \sl
8001 \global\advance\parencount by -1
8004 \newcount\brackcount
8005 \def\lbrb{%
8006 \global\advance\brackcount by 1
8007 {\bf[}%
8009 \def\rbrb{%
8010 {\bf]}%
8011 \global\advance\brackcount by -1
8014 \def\checkparencounts{%
8015 \ifnum\parencount=0 \else \badparencount \fi
8016 \ifnum\brackcount=0 \else \badbrackcount \fi
8018 % these should not use \errmessage; the glibc manual, at least, actually
8019 % has such constructs (when documenting function pointers).
8020 \def\badparencount{%
8021 \message{Warning: unbalanced parentheses in @def...}%
8022 \global\parencount=0
8024 \def\badbrackcount{%
8025 \message{Warning: unbalanced square brackets in @def...}%
8026 \global\brackcount=0
8030 \message{macros,}
8031 % @macro.
8033 % To do this right we need a feature of e-TeX, \scantokens,
8034 % which we arrange to emulate with a temporary file in ordinary TeX.
8035 \ifx\eTeXversion\thisisundefined
8036 \newwrite\macscribble
8037 \def\scantokens#1{%
8038 \toks0={#1}%
8039 \immediate\openout\macscribble=\jobname.tmp
8040 \immediate\write\macscribble{\the\toks0}%
8041 \immediate\closeout\macscribble
8042 \input \jobname.tmp
8046 % alias because \c means cedilla in @tex or @math
8047 \let\texinfoc=\c
8049 \newcount\savedcatcodeone
8050 \newcount\savedcatcodetwo
8052 % Used at the time of macro expansion.
8053 % Argument is macro body with arguments substituted
8054 \def\scanmacro#1{%
8055 \newlinechar`\^^M
8056 \def\xeatspaces{\eatspaces}%
8058 % Temporarily undo catcode changes of \printindex. Set catcode of @ to
8059 % 0 so that @-commands in macro expansions aren't printed literally when
8060 % formatting an index file, where \ is used as the escape character.
8061 \savedcatcodeone=\catcode`\@
8062 \savedcatcodetwo=\catcode`\\
8063 \catcode`\@=0
8064 \catcode`\\=\active
8066 % Process the macro body under the current catcode regime.
8067 \scantokens{#1@texinfoc}%
8069 \catcode`\@=\savedcatcodeone
8070 \catcode`\\=\savedcatcodetwo
8072 % The \texinfoc is to remove the \newlinechar added by \scantokens, and
8073 % can be noticed by \parsearg.
8074 % We avoid surrounding the call to \scantokens with \bgroup and \egroup
8075 % to allow macros to open or close groups themselves.
8078 % Used for copying and captions
8079 \def\scanexp#1{%
8080 \expandafter\scanmacro\expandafter{#1}%
8083 \newcount\paramno % Count of parameters
8084 \newtoks\macname % Macro name
8085 \newif\ifrecursive % Is it recursive?
8087 % List of all defined macros in the form
8088 % \commondummyword\macro1\commondummyword\macro2...
8089 % Currently is also contains all @aliases; the list can be split
8090 % if there is a need.
8091 \def\macrolist{}
8093 % Add the macro to \macrolist
8094 \def\addtomacrolist#1{\expandafter \addtomacrolistxxx \csname#1\endcsname}
8095 \def\addtomacrolistxxx#1{%
8096 \toks0 = \expandafter{\macrolist\commondummyword#1}%
8097 \xdef\macrolist{\the\toks0}%
8100 % Utility routines.
8101 % This does \let #1 = #2, with \csnames; that is,
8102 % \let \csname#1\endcsname = \csname#2\endcsname
8103 % (except of course we have to play expansion games).
8105 \def\cslet#1#2{%
8106 \expandafter\let
8107 \csname#1\expandafter\endcsname
8108 \csname#2\endcsname
8111 % Trim leading and trailing spaces off a string.
8112 % Concepts from aro-bend problem 15 (see CTAN).
8113 {\catcode`\@=11
8114 \gdef\eatspaces #1{\expandafter\trim@\expandafter{#1 }}
8115 \gdef\trim@ #1{\trim@@ @#1 @ #1 @ @@}
8116 \gdef\trim@@ #1@ #2@ #3@@{\trim@@@\empty #2 @}
8117 \def\unbrace#1{#1}
8118 \unbrace{\gdef\trim@@@ #1 } #2@{#1}
8121 % Trim a single trailing ^^M off a string.
8122 {\catcode`\^^M=\other \catcode`\Q=3%
8123 \gdef\eatcr #1{\eatcra #1Q^^MQ}%
8124 \gdef\eatcra#1^^MQ{\eatcrb#1Q}%
8125 \gdef\eatcrb#1Q#2Q{#1}%
8128 % Macro bodies are absorbed as an argument in a context where
8129 % all characters are catcode 10, 11 or 12, except \ which is active
8130 % (as in normal texinfo). It is necessary to change the definition of \
8131 % to recognize macro arguments; this is the job of \mbodybackslash.
8133 % Non-ASCII encodings make 8-bit characters active, so un-activate
8134 % them to avoid their expansion. Must do this non-globally, to
8135 % confine the change to the current group.
8137 % It's necessary to have hard CRs when the macro is executed. This is
8138 % done by making ^^M (\endlinechar) catcode 12 when reading the macro
8139 % body, and then making it the \newlinechar in \scanmacro.
8141 \def\scanctxt{% used as subroutine
8142 \catcode`\"=\other
8143 \catcode`\+=\other
8144 \catcode`\<=\other
8145 \catcode`\>=\other
8146 \catcode`\^=\other
8147 \catcode`\_=\other
8148 \catcode`\|=\other
8149 \catcode`\~=\other
8150 \passthroughcharstrue
8153 \def\scanargctxt{% used for copying and captions, not macros.
8154 \scanctxt
8155 \catcode`\@=\other
8156 \catcode`\\=\other
8157 \catcode`\^^M=\other
8160 \def\macrobodyctxt{% used for @macro definitions
8161 \scanctxt
8162 \catcode`\ =\other
8163 \catcode`\@=\other
8164 \catcode`\{=\other
8165 \catcode`\}=\other
8166 \catcode`\^^M=\other
8167 \usembodybackslash
8170 % Used when scanning braced macro arguments. Note, however, that catcode
8171 % changes here are ineffectual if the macro invocation was nested inside
8172 % an argument to another Texinfo command.
8173 \def\macroargctxt{%
8174 \scanctxt
8175 \catcode`\ =\active
8176 \catcode`\^^M=\other
8177 \catcode`\\=\active
8180 \def\macrolineargctxt{% used for whole-line arguments without braces
8181 \scanctxt
8182 \catcode`\{=\other
8183 \catcode`\}=\other
8186 % \mbodybackslash is the definition of \ in @macro bodies.
8187 % It maps \foo\ => \csname macarg.foo\endcsname => #N
8188 % where N is the macro parameter number.
8189 % We define \csname macarg.\endcsname to be \realbackslash, so
8190 % \\ in macro replacement text gets you a backslash.
8192 {\catcode`@=0 @catcode`@\=@active
8193 @gdef@usembodybackslash{@let\=@mbodybackslash}
8194 @gdef@mbodybackslash#1\{@csname macarg.#1@endcsname}
8196 \expandafter\def\csname macarg.\endcsname{\realbackslash}
8198 \def\margbackslash#1{\char`\#1 }
8200 \def\macro{\recursivefalse\parsearg\macroxxx}
8201 \def\rmacro{\recursivetrue\parsearg\macroxxx}
8203 \def\macroxxx#1{%
8204 \getargs{#1}% now \macname is the macname and \argl the arglist
8205 \ifx\argl\empty % no arguments
8206 \paramno=0\relax
8207 \else
8208 \expandafter\parsemargdef \argl;%
8209 \if\paramno>256\relax
8210 \ifx\eTeXversion\thisisundefined
8211 \errhelp = \EMsimple
8212 \errmessage{You need eTeX to compile a file with macros with more than 256 arguments}
8216 \if1\csname ismacro.\the\macname\endcsname
8217 \message{Warning: redefining \the\macname}%
8218 \else
8219 \expandafter\ifx\csname \the\macname\endcsname \relax
8220 \else \errmessage{Macro name \the\macname\space already defined}\fi
8221 \global\cslet{macsave.\the\macname}{\the\macname}%
8222 \global\expandafter\let\csname ismacro.\the\macname\endcsname=1%
8223 \addtomacrolist{\the\macname}%
8225 \begingroup \macrobodyctxt
8226 \ifrecursive \expandafter\parsermacbody
8227 \else \expandafter\parsemacbody
8228 \fi}
8230 \parseargdef\unmacro{%
8231 \if1\csname ismacro.#1\endcsname
8232 \global\cslet{#1}{macsave.#1}%
8233 \global\expandafter\let \csname ismacro.#1\endcsname=0%
8234 % Remove the macro name from \macrolist:
8235 \begingroup
8236 \expandafter\let\csname#1\endcsname \relax
8237 \let\commondummyword\unmacrodo
8238 \xdef\macrolist{\macrolist}%
8239 \endgroup
8240 \else
8241 \errmessage{Macro #1 not defined}%
8245 % Called by \do from \dounmacro on each macro. The idea is to omit any
8246 % macro definitions that have been changed to \relax.
8248 \def\unmacrodo#1{%
8249 \ifx #1\relax
8250 % remove this
8251 \else
8252 \noexpand\commondummyword \noexpand#1%
8256 % \getargs -- Parse the arguments to a @macro line. Set \macname to
8257 % the name of the macro, and \argl to the braced argument list.
8258 \def\getargs#1{\getargsxxx#1{}}
8259 \def\getargsxxx#1#{\getmacname #1 \relax\getmacargs}
8260 \def\getmacname#1 #2\relax{\macname={#1}}
8261 \def\getmacargs#1{\def\argl{#1}}
8262 % This made use of the feature that if the last token of a
8263 % <parameter list> is #, then the preceding argument is delimited by
8264 % an opening brace, and that opening brace is not consumed.
8266 % Parse the optional {params} list to @macro or @rmacro.
8267 % Set \paramno to the number of arguments,
8268 % and \paramlist to a parameter text for the macro (e.g. #1,#2,#3 for a
8269 % three-param macro.) Define \macarg.BLAH for each BLAH in the params
8270 % list to some hook where the argument is to be expanded. If there are
8271 % less than 10 arguments that hook is to be replaced by ##N where N
8272 % is the position in that list, that is to say the macro arguments are to be
8273 % defined `a la TeX in the macro body.
8275 % That gets used by \mbodybackslash (above).
8277 % If there are 10 or more arguments, a different technique is used: see
8278 % \parsemmanyargdef.
8280 \def\parsemargdef#1;{%
8281 \paramno=0\def\paramlist{}%
8282 \let\hash\relax
8283 % \hash is redefined to `#' later to get it into definitions
8284 \let\xeatspaces\relax
8285 \parsemargdefxxx#1,;,%
8286 \ifnum\paramno<10\relax\else
8287 \paramno0\relax
8288 \parsemmanyargdef@@#1,;,% 10 or more arguments
8291 \def\parsemargdefxxx#1,{%
8292 \if#1;\let\next=\relax
8293 \else \let\next=\parsemargdefxxx
8294 \advance\paramno by 1
8295 \expandafter\edef\csname macarg.\eatspaces{#1}\endcsname
8296 {\xeatspaces{\hash\the\paramno}}%
8297 \edef\paramlist{\paramlist\hash\the\paramno,}%
8298 \fi\next}
8300 % \parsemacbody, \parsermacbody
8302 % Read recursive and nonrecursive macro bodies. (They're different since
8303 % rec and nonrec macros end differently.)
8305 % We are in \macrobodyctxt, and the \xdef causes backslashshes in the macro
8306 % body to be transformed.
8307 % Set \macrobody to the body of the macro, and call \defmacro.
8309 {\catcode`\ =\other\long\gdef\parsemacbody#1@end macro{%
8310 \xdef\macrobody{\eatcr{#1}}\endgroup\defmacro}}%
8311 {\catcode`\ =\other\long\gdef\parsermacbody#1@end rmacro{%
8312 \xdef\macrobody{\eatcr{#1}}\endgroup\defmacro}}%
8314 % Make @ a letter, so that we can make private-to-Texinfo macro names.
8315 \edef\texiatcatcode{\the\catcode`\@}
8316 \catcode `@=11\relax
8318 %%%%%%%%%%%%%% Code for > 10 arguments only %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
8320 % If there are 10 or more arguments, a different technique is used, where the
8321 % hook remains in the body, and when macro is to be expanded the body is
8322 % processed again to replace the arguments.
8324 % In that case, the hook is \the\toks N-1, and we simply set \toks N-1 to the
8325 % argument N value and then \edef the body (nothing else will expand because of
8326 % the catcode regime under which the body was input).
8328 % If you compile with TeX (not eTeX), and you have macros with 10 or more
8329 % arguments, no macro can have more than 256 arguments (else error).
8331 % In case that there are 10 or more arguments we parse again the arguments
8332 % list to set new definitions for the \macarg.BLAH macros corresponding to
8333 % each BLAH argument. It was anyhow needed to parse already once this list
8334 % in order to count the arguments, and as macros with at most 9 arguments
8335 % are by far more frequent than macro with 10 or more arguments, defining
8336 % twice the \macarg.BLAH macros does not cost too much processing power.
8337 \def\parsemmanyargdef@@#1,{%
8338 \if#1;\let\next=\relax
8339 \else
8340 \let\next=\parsemmanyargdef@@
8341 \edef\tempb{\eatspaces{#1}}%
8342 \expandafter\def\expandafter\tempa
8343 \expandafter{\csname macarg.\tempb\endcsname}%
8344 % Note that we need some extra \noexpand\noexpand, this is because we
8345 % don't want \the to be expanded in the \parsermacbody as it uses an
8346 % \xdef .
8347 \expandafter\edef\tempa
8348 {\noexpand\noexpand\noexpand\the\toks\the\paramno}%
8349 \advance\paramno by 1\relax
8350 \fi\next}
8353 \let\endargs@\relax
8354 \let\nil@\relax
8355 \def\nilm@{\nil@}%
8356 \long\def\nillm@{\nil@}%
8358 % This macro is expanded during the Texinfo macro expansion, not during its
8359 % definition. It gets all the arguments' values and assigns them to macros
8360 % macarg.ARGNAME
8362 % #1 is the macro name
8363 % #2 is the list of argument names
8364 % #3 is the list of argument values
8365 \def\getargvals@#1#2#3{%
8366 \def\macargdeflist@{}%
8367 \def\saveparamlist@{#2}% Need to keep a copy for parameter expansion.
8368 \def\paramlist{#2,\nil@}%
8369 \def\macroname{#1}%
8370 \begingroup
8371 \macroargctxt
8372 \def\argvaluelist{#3,\nil@}%
8373 \def\@tempa{#3}%
8374 \ifx\@tempa\empty
8375 \setemptyargvalues@
8376 \else
8377 \getargvals@@
8380 \def\getargvals@@{%
8381 \ifx\paramlist\nilm@
8382 % Some sanity check needed here that \argvaluelist is also empty.
8383 \ifx\argvaluelist\nillm@
8384 \else
8385 \errhelp = \EMsimple
8386 \errmessage{Too many arguments in macro `\macroname'!}%
8388 \let\next\macargexpandinbody@
8389 \else
8390 \ifx\argvaluelist\nillm@
8391 % No more arguments values passed to macro. Set remaining named-arg
8392 % macros to empty.
8393 \let\next\setemptyargvalues@
8394 \else
8395 % pop current arg name into \@tempb
8396 \def\@tempa##1{\pop@{\@tempb}{\paramlist}##1\endargs@}%
8397 \expandafter\@tempa\expandafter{\paramlist}%
8398 % pop current argument value into \@tempc
8399 \def\@tempa##1{\longpop@{\@tempc}{\argvaluelist}##1\endargs@}%
8400 \expandafter\@tempa\expandafter{\argvaluelist}%
8401 % Here \@tempb is the current arg name and \@tempc is the current arg value.
8402 % First place the new argument macro definition into \@tempd
8403 \expandafter\macname\expandafter{\@tempc}%
8404 \expandafter\let\csname macarg.\@tempb\endcsname\relax
8405 \expandafter\def\expandafter\@tempe\expandafter{%
8406 \csname macarg.\@tempb\endcsname}%
8407 \edef\@tempd{\long\def\@tempe{\the\macname}}%
8408 \push@\@tempd\macargdeflist@
8409 \let\next\getargvals@@
8412 \next
8415 \def\push@#1#2{%
8416 \expandafter\expandafter\expandafter\def
8417 \expandafter\expandafter\expandafter#2%
8418 \expandafter\expandafter\expandafter{%
8419 \expandafter#1#2}%
8422 % Replace arguments by their values in the macro body, and place the result
8423 % in macro \@tempa.
8425 \def\macvalstoargs@{%
8426 % To do this we use the property that token registers that are \the'ed
8427 % within an \edef expand only once. So we are going to place all argument
8428 % values into respective token registers.
8430 % First we save the token context, and initialize argument numbering.
8431 \begingroup
8432 \paramno0\relax
8433 % Then, for each argument number #N, we place the corresponding argument
8434 % value into a new token list register \toks#N
8435 \expandafter\putargsintokens@\saveparamlist@,;,%
8436 % Then, we expand the body so that argument are replaced by their
8437 % values. The trick for values not to be expanded themselves is that they
8438 % are within tokens and that tokens expand only once in an \edef .
8439 \edef\@tempc{\csname mac.\macroname .body\endcsname}%
8440 % Now we restore the token stack pointer to free the token list registers
8441 % which we have used, but we make sure that expanded body is saved after
8442 % group.
8443 \expandafter
8444 \endgroup
8445 \expandafter\def\expandafter\@tempa\expandafter{\@tempc}%
8448 % Define the named-macro outside of this group and then close this group.
8450 \def\macargexpandinbody@{%
8451 \expandafter
8452 \endgroup
8453 \macargdeflist@
8454 % First the replace in body the macro arguments by their values, the result
8455 % is in \@tempa .
8456 \macvalstoargs@
8457 % Then we point at the \norecurse or \gobble (for recursive) macro value
8458 % with \@tempb .
8459 \expandafter\let\expandafter\@tempb\csname mac.\macroname .recurse\endcsname
8460 % Depending on whether it is recursive or not, we need some tailing
8461 % \egroup .
8462 \ifx\@tempb\gobble
8463 \let\@tempc\relax
8464 \else
8465 \let\@tempc\egroup
8467 % And now we do the real job:
8468 \edef\@tempd{\noexpand\@tempb{\macroname}\noexpand\scanmacro{\@tempa}\@tempc}%
8469 \@tempd
8472 \def\putargsintokens@#1,{%
8473 \if#1;\let\next\relax
8474 \else
8475 \let\next\putargsintokens@
8476 % First we allocate the new token list register, and give it a temporary
8477 % alias \@tempb .
8478 \toksdef\@tempb\the\paramno
8479 % Then we place the argument value into that token list register.
8480 \expandafter\let\expandafter\@tempa\csname macarg.#1\endcsname
8481 \expandafter\@tempb\expandafter{\@tempa}%
8482 \advance\paramno by 1\relax
8484 \next
8487 % Trailing missing arguments are set to empty.
8489 \def\setemptyargvalues@{%
8490 \ifx\paramlist\nilm@
8491 \let\next\macargexpandinbody@
8492 \else
8493 \expandafter\setemptyargvaluesparser@\paramlist\endargs@
8494 \let\next\setemptyargvalues@
8496 \next
8499 \def\setemptyargvaluesparser@#1,#2\endargs@{%
8500 \expandafter\def\expandafter\@tempa\expandafter{%
8501 \expandafter\def\csname macarg.#1\endcsname{}}%
8502 \push@\@tempa\macargdeflist@
8503 \def\paramlist{#2}%
8506 % #1 is the element target macro
8507 % #2 is the list macro
8508 % #3,#4\endargs@ is the list value
8509 \def\pop@#1#2#3,#4\endargs@{%
8510 \def#1{#3}%
8511 \def#2{#4}%
8513 \long\def\longpop@#1#2#3,#4\endargs@{%
8514 \long\def#1{#3}%
8515 \long\def#2{#4}%
8519 %%%%%%%%%%%%%% End of code for > 10 arguments %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
8522 % This defines a Texinfo @macro or @rmacro, called by \parsemacbody.
8523 % \macrobody has the body of the macro in it, with placeholders for
8524 % its parameters, looking like "\xeatspaces{\hash 1}".
8525 % \paramno is the number of parameters
8526 % \paramlist is a TeX parameter text, e.g. "#1,#2,#3,"
8527 % There are four cases: macros of zero, one, up to nine, and many arguments.
8528 % \xdef is used so that macro definitions will survive the file
8529 % they're defined in: @include reads the file inside a group.
8531 \def\defmacro{%
8532 \let\hash=##% convert placeholders to macro parameter chars
8533 \ifnum\paramno=1
8534 \def\xeatspaces##1{##1}%
8535 % This removes the pair of braces around the argument. We don't
8536 % use \eatspaces, because this can cause ends of lines to be lost
8537 % when the argument to \eatspaces is read, leading to line-based
8538 % commands like "@itemize" not being read correctly.
8539 \else
8540 \let\xeatspaces\relax % suppress expansion
8542 \ifcase\paramno
8544 \expandafter\xdef\csname\the\macname\endcsname{%
8545 \bgroup
8546 \noexpand\spaceisspace
8547 \noexpand\endlineisspace
8548 \noexpand\expandafter % skip any whitespace after the macro name.
8549 \expandafter\noexpand\csname\the\macname @@@\endcsname}%
8550 \expandafter\xdef\csname\the\macname @@@\endcsname{%
8551 \egroup
8552 \noexpand\scanmacro{\macrobody}}%
8553 \or % 1
8554 \expandafter\xdef\csname\the\macname\endcsname{%
8555 \bgroup
8556 \noexpand\braceorline
8557 \expandafter\noexpand\csname\the\macname @@@\endcsname}%
8558 \expandafter\xdef\csname\the\macname @@@\endcsname##1{%
8559 \egroup
8560 \noexpand\scanmacro{\macrobody}%
8562 \else % at most 9
8563 \ifnum\paramno<10\relax
8564 % @MACNAME sets the context for reading the macro argument
8565 % @MACNAME@@ gets the argument, processes backslashes and appends a
8566 % comma.
8567 % @MACNAME@@@ removes braces surrounding the argument list.
8568 % @MACNAME@@@@ scans the macro body with arguments substituted.
8569 \expandafter\xdef\csname\the\macname\endcsname{%
8570 \bgroup
8571 \noexpand\expandafter % This \expandafter skip any spaces after the
8572 \noexpand\macroargctxt % macro before we change the catcode of space.
8573 \noexpand\expandafter
8574 \expandafter\noexpand\csname\the\macname @@\endcsname}%
8575 \expandafter\xdef\csname\the\macname @@\endcsname##1{%
8576 \noexpand\passargtomacro
8577 \expandafter\noexpand\csname\the\macname @@@\endcsname{##1,}}%
8578 \expandafter\xdef\csname\the\macname @@@\endcsname##1{%
8579 \expandafter\noexpand\csname\the\macname @@@@\endcsname ##1}%
8580 \expandafter\expandafter
8581 \expandafter\xdef
8582 \expandafter\expandafter
8583 \csname\the\macname @@@@\endcsname\paramlist{%
8584 \egroup\noexpand\scanmacro{\macrobody}}%
8585 \else % 10 or more:
8586 \expandafter\xdef\csname\the\macname\endcsname{%
8587 \noexpand\getargvals@{\the\macname}{\argl}%
8589 \global\expandafter\let\csname mac.\the\macname .body\endcsname\macrobody
8590 \global\expandafter\let\csname mac.\the\macname .recurse\endcsname\gobble
8592 \fi}
8594 \catcode `\@\texiatcatcode\relax % end private-to-Texinfo catcodes
8596 \def\norecurse#1{\bgroup\cslet{#1}{macsave.#1}}
8599 %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
8601 {\catcode`\@=0 \catcode`\\=13 % We need to manipulate \ so use @ as escape
8602 @catcode`@_=11 % private names
8603 @catcode`@!=11 % used as argument separator
8605 % \passargtomacro#1#2 -
8606 % Call #1 with a list of tokens #2, with any doubled backslashes in #2
8607 % compressed to one.
8609 % This implementation works by expansion, and not execution (so we cannot use
8610 % \def or similar). This reduces the risk of this failing in contexts where
8611 % complete expansion is done with no execution (for example, in writing out to
8612 % an auxiliary file for an index entry).
8614 % State is kept in the input stream: the argument passed to
8615 % @look_ahead, @gobble_and_check_finish and @add_segment is
8617 % THE_MACRO ARG_RESULT ! {PENDING_BS} NEXT_TOKEN (... rest of input)
8619 % where:
8620 % THE_MACRO - name of the macro we want to call
8621 % ARG_RESULT - argument list we build to pass to that macro
8622 % PENDING_BS - either a backslash or nothing
8623 % NEXT_TOKEN - used to look ahead in the input stream to see what's coming next
8625 @gdef@passargtomacro#1#2{%
8626 @add_segment #1!{}@relax#2\@_finish\%
8628 @gdef@_finish{@_finishx} @global@let@_finishx@relax
8630 % #1 - THE_MACRO ARG_RESULT
8631 % #2 - PENDING_BS
8632 % #3 - NEXT_TOKEN
8633 % #4 used to look ahead
8635 % If the next token is not a backslash, process the rest of the argument;
8636 % otherwise, remove the next token.
8637 @gdef@look_ahead#1!#2#3#4{%
8638 @ifx#4\%
8639 @expandafter@gobble_and_check_finish
8640 @else
8641 @expandafter@add_segment
8642 @fi#1!{#2}#4#4%
8645 % #1 - THE_MACRO ARG_RESULT
8646 % #2 - PENDING_BS
8647 % #3 - NEXT_TOKEN
8648 % #4 should be a backslash, which is gobbled.
8649 % #5 looks ahead
8651 % Double backslash found. Add a single backslash, and look ahead.
8652 @gdef@gobble_and_check_finish#1!#2#3#4#5{%
8653 @add_segment#1\!{}#5#5%
8656 @gdef@is_fi{@fi}
8658 % #1 - THE_MACRO ARG_RESULT
8659 % #2 - PENDING_BS
8660 % #3 - NEXT_TOKEN
8661 % #4 is input stream until next backslash
8663 % Input stream is either at the start of the argument, or just after a
8664 % backslash sequence, either a lone backslash, or a doubled backslash.
8665 % NEXT_TOKEN contains the first token in the input stream: if it is \finish,
8666 % finish; otherwise, append to ARG_RESULT the segment of the argument up until
8667 % the next backslash. PENDING_BACKSLASH contains a backslash to represent
8668 % a backslash just before the start of the input stream that has not been
8669 % added to ARG_RESULT.
8670 @gdef@add_segment#1!#2#3#4\{%
8671 @ifx#3@_finish
8672 @call_the_macro#1!%
8673 @else
8674 % append the pending backslash to the result, followed by the next segment
8675 @expandafter@is_fi@look_ahead#1#2#4!{\}@fi
8676 % this @fi is discarded by @look_ahead.
8677 % we can't get rid of it with \expandafter because we don't know how
8678 % long #4 is.
8681 % #1 - THE_MACRO
8682 % #2 - ARG_RESULT
8683 % #3 discards the res of the conditional in @add_segment, and @is_fi ends the
8684 % conditional.
8685 @gdef@call_the_macro#1#2!#3@fi{@is_fi #1{#2}}
8688 %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
8690 % \braceorline MAC is used for a one-argument macro MAC. It checks
8691 % whether the next non-whitespace character is a {. It sets the context
8692 % for reading the argument (slightly different in the two cases). Then,
8693 % to read the argument, in the whole-line case, it then calls the regular
8694 % \parsearg MAC; in the lbrace case, it calls \passargtomacro MAC.
8696 \def\braceorline#1{\let\macnamexxx=#1\futurelet\nchar\braceorlinexxx}
8697 \def\braceorlinexxx{%
8698 \ifx\nchar\bgroup
8699 \macroargctxt
8700 \expandafter\passargtomacro
8701 \else
8702 \macrolineargctxt\expandafter\parsearg
8703 \fi \macnamexxx}
8706 % @alias.
8707 % We need some trickery to remove the optional spaces around the equal
8708 % sign. Make them active and then expand them all to nothing.
8710 \def\alias{\parseargusing\obeyspaces\aliasxxx}
8711 \def\aliasxxx #1{\aliasyyy#1\relax}
8712 \def\aliasyyy #1=#2\relax{%
8714 \expandafter\let\obeyedspace=\empty
8715 \addtomacrolist{#1}%
8716 \xdef\next{\global\let\makecsname{#1}=\makecsname{#2}}%
8718 \next
8722 \message{cross references,}
8724 \newwrite\auxfile
8725 \newif\ifhavexrefs % True if xref values are known.
8726 \newif\ifwarnedxrefs % True if we warned once that they aren't known.
8728 % @inforef is relatively simple.
8729 \def\inforef #1{\inforefzzz #1,,,,**}
8730 \def\inforefzzz #1,#2,#3,#4**{%
8731 \putwordSee{} \putwordInfo{} \putwordfile{} \file{\ignorespaces #3{}},
8732 node \samp{\ignorespaces#1{}}}
8734 % @node's only job in TeX is to define \lastnode, which is used in
8735 % cross-references. The @node line might or might not have commas, and
8736 % might or might not have spaces before the first comma, like:
8737 % @node foo , bar , ...
8738 % We don't want such trailing spaces in the node name.
8740 \parseargdef\node{\checkenv{}\donode #1 ,\finishnodeparse}
8742 % also remove a trailing comma, in case of something like this:
8743 % @node Help-Cross, , , Cross-refs
8744 \def\donode#1 ,#2\finishnodeparse{\dodonode #1,\finishnodeparse}
8745 \def\dodonode#1,#2\finishnodeparse{\gdef\lastnode{#1}}
8747 \let\nwnode=\node
8748 \let\lastnode=\empty
8750 % Write a cross-reference definition for the current node. #1 is the
8751 % type (Ynumbered, Yappendix, Ynothing).
8753 \def\donoderef#1{%
8754 \ifx\lastnode\empty\else
8755 \setref{\lastnode}{#1}%
8756 \global\let\lastnode=\empty
8760 % @anchor{NAME} -- define xref target at arbitrary point.
8762 \newcount\savesfregister
8764 \def\savesf{\relax \ifhmode \savesfregister=\spacefactor \fi}
8765 \def\restoresf{\relax \ifhmode \spacefactor=\savesfregister \fi}
8766 \def\anchor#1{\savesf \setref{#1}{Ynothing}\restoresf \ignorespaces}
8768 % \setref{NAME}{SNT} defines a cross-reference point NAME (a node or an
8769 % anchor), which consists of three parts:
8770 % 1) NAME-title - the current sectioning name taken from \lastsection,
8771 % or the anchor name.
8772 % 2) NAME-snt - section number and type, passed as the SNT arg, or
8773 % empty for anchors.
8774 % 3) NAME-pg - the page number.
8776 % This is called from \donoderef, \anchor, and \dofloat. In the case of
8777 % floats, there is an additional part, which is not written here:
8778 % 4) NAME-lof - the text as it should appear in a @listoffloats.
8780 \def\setref#1#2{%
8781 \pdfmkdest{#1}%
8782 \iflinks
8784 \requireauxfile
8785 \atdummies % preserve commands, but don't expand them
8786 % match definition in \xrdef, \refx, \xrefX.
8787 \def\value##1{##1}%
8788 \edef\writexrdef##1##2{%
8789 \write\auxfile{@xrdef{#1-% #1 of \setref, expanded by the \edef
8790 ##1}{##2}}% these are parameters of \writexrdef
8792 \toks0 = \expandafter{\lastsection}%
8793 \immediate \writexrdef{title}{\the\toks0 }%
8794 \immediate \writexrdef{snt}{\csname #2\endcsname}% \Ynumbered etc.
8795 \safewhatsit{\writexrdef{pg}{\folio}}% will be written later, at \shipout
8800 % @xrefautosectiontitle on|off says whether @section(ing) names are used
8801 % automatically in xrefs, if the third arg is not explicitly specified.
8802 % This was provided as a "secret" @set xref-automatic-section-title
8803 % variable, now it's official.
8805 \parseargdef\xrefautomaticsectiontitle{%
8806 \def\temp{#1}%
8807 \ifx\temp\onword
8808 \expandafter\let\csname SETxref-automatic-section-title\endcsname
8809 = \empty
8810 \else\ifx\temp\offword
8811 \expandafter\let\csname SETxref-automatic-section-title\endcsname
8812 = \relax
8813 \else
8814 \errhelp = \EMsimple
8815 \errmessage{Unknown @xrefautomaticsectiontitle value `\temp',
8816 must be on|off}%
8817 \fi\fi
8820 % \f
8821 % @xref, @pxref, and @ref generate cross-references. For \xrefX, #1 is
8822 % the node name, #2 the name of the Info cross-reference, #3 the printed
8823 % node name, #4 the name of the Info file, #5 the name of the printed
8824 % manual. All but the node name can be omitted.
8826 \def\pxref{\putwordsee{} \xrefXX}
8827 \def\xref{\putwordSee{} \xrefXX}
8828 \def\ref{\xrefXX}
8830 \def\xrefXX#1{\def\xrefXXarg{#1}\futurelet\tokenafterxref\xrefXXX}
8831 \def\xrefXXX{\expandafter\xrefX\expandafter[\xrefXXarg,,,,,,,]}
8833 \newbox\toprefbox
8834 \newbox\printedrefnamebox
8835 \newbox\infofilenamebox
8836 \newbox\printedmanualbox
8838 \def\xrefX[#1,#2,#3,#4,#5,#6]{\begingroup
8839 \unsepspaces
8841 % Get args without leading/trailing spaces.
8842 \def\printedrefname{\ignorespaces #3}%
8843 \setbox\printedrefnamebox = \hbox{\printedrefname\unskip}%
8845 \def\infofilename{\ignorespaces #4}%
8846 \setbox\infofilenamebox = \hbox{\infofilename\unskip}%
8848 \def\printedmanual{\ignorespaces #5}%
8849 \setbox\printedmanualbox = \hbox{\printedmanual\unskip}%
8851 % If the printed reference name (arg #3) was not explicitly given in
8852 % the @xref, figure out what we want to use.
8853 \ifdim \wd\printedrefnamebox = 0pt
8854 % No printed node name was explicitly given.
8855 \expandafter\ifx\csname SETxref-automatic-section-title\endcsname \relax
8856 % Not auto section-title: use node name inside the square brackets.
8857 \def\printedrefname{\ignorespaces #1}%
8858 \else
8859 % Auto section-title: use chapter/section title inside
8860 % the square brackets if we have it.
8861 \ifdim \wd\printedmanualbox > 0pt
8862 % It is in another manual, so we don't have it; use node name.
8863 \def\printedrefname{\ignorespaces #1}%
8864 \else
8865 \ifhavexrefs
8866 % We (should) know the real title if we have the xref values.
8867 \def\printedrefname{\refx{#1-title}{}}%
8868 \else
8869 % Otherwise just copy the Info node name.
8870 \def\printedrefname{\ignorespaces #1}%
8871 \fi%
8876 % Make link in pdf output.
8877 \ifpdf
8878 % For pdfTeX and LuaTeX
8879 {\indexnofonts
8880 \makevalueexpandable
8881 \turnoffactive
8882 % This expands tokens, so do it after making catcode changes, so _
8883 % etc. don't get their TeX definitions. This ignores all spaces in
8884 % #4, including (wrongly) those in the middle of the filename.
8885 \getfilename{#4}%
8887 % This (wrongly) does not take account of leading or trailing
8888 % spaces in #1, which should be ignored.
8889 \setpdfdestname{#1}%
8891 \ifx\pdfdestname\empty
8892 \def\pdfdestname{Top}% no empty targets
8895 \leavevmode
8896 \startlink attr{/Border [0 0 0]}%
8897 \ifnum\filenamelength>0
8898 goto file{\the\filename.pdf} name{\pdfdestname}%
8899 \else
8900 goto name{\pdfmkpgn{\pdfdestname}}%
8903 \setcolor{\linkcolor}%
8904 \else
8905 \ifx\XeTeXrevision\thisisundefined
8906 \else
8907 % For XeTeX
8908 {\indexnofonts
8909 \makevalueexpandable
8910 \turnoffactive
8911 % This expands tokens, so do it after making catcode changes, so _
8912 % etc. don't get their TeX definitions. This ignores all spaces in
8913 % #4, including (wrongly) those in the middle of the filename.
8914 \getfilename{#4}%
8916 % This (wrongly) does not take account of leading or trailing
8917 % spaces in #1, which should be ignored.
8918 \setpdfdestname{#1}%
8920 \ifx\pdfdestname\empty
8921 \def\pdfdestname{Top}% no empty targets
8924 \leavevmode
8925 \ifnum\filenamelength>0
8926 % With default settings,
8927 % XeTeX (xdvipdfmx) replaces link destination names with integers.
8928 % In this case, the replaced destination names of
8929 % remote PDFs are no longer known. In order to avoid a replacement,
8930 % you can use xdvipdfmx's command line option `-C 0x0010'.
8931 % If you use XeTeX 0.99996+ (TeX Live 2016+),
8932 % this command line option is no longer necessary
8933 % because we can use the `dvipdfmx:config' special.
8934 \special{pdf:bann << /Border [0 0 0] /Type /Annot /Subtype /Link /A
8935 << /S /GoToR /F (\the\filename.pdf) /D (\pdfdestname) >> >>}%
8936 \else
8937 \special{pdf:bann << /Border [0 0 0] /Type /Annot /Subtype /Link /A
8938 << /S /GoTo /D (\pdfdestname) >> >>}%
8941 \setcolor{\linkcolor}%
8945 % Have to otherify everything special to allow the \csname to
8946 % include an _ in the xref name, etc.
8947 \indexnofonts
8948 \turnoffactive
8949 \def\value##1{##1}%
8950 \expandafter\global\expandafter\let\expandafter\Xthisreftitle
8951 \csname XR#1-title\endcsname
8954 % Float references are printed completely differently: "Figure 1.2"
8955 % instead of "[somenode], p.3". \iffloat distinguishes them by
8956 % \Xthisreftitle being set to a magic string.
8957 \iffloat\Xthisreftitle
8958 % If the user specified the print name (third arg) to the ref,
8959 % print it instead of our usual "Figure 1.2".
8960 \ifdim\wd\printedrefnamebox = 0pt
8961 \refx{#1-snt}{}%
8962 \else
8963 \printedrefname
8966 % If the user also gave the printed manual name (fifth arg), append
8967 % "in MANUALNAME".
8968 \ifdim \wd\printedmanualbox > 0pt
8969 \space \putwordin{} \cite{\printedmanual}%
8971 \else
8972 % node/anchor (non-float) references.
8974 % If we use \unhbox to print the node names, TeX does not insert
8975 % empty discretionaries after hyphens, which means that it will not
8976 % find a line break at a hyphen in a node names. Since some manuals
8977 % are best written with fairly long node names, containing hyphens,
8978 % this is a loss. Therefore, we give the text of the node name
8979 % again, so it is as if TeX is seeing it for the first time.
8981 \ifdim \wd\printedmanualbox > 0pt
8982 % Cross-manual reference with a printed manual name.
8984 \crossmanualxref{\cite{\printedmanual\unskip}}%
8986 \else\ifdim \wd\infofilenamebox > 0pt
8987 % Cross-manual reference with only an info filename (arg 4), no
8988 % printed manual name (arg 5). This is essentially the same as
8989 % the case above; we output the filename, since we have nothing else.
8991 \crossmanualxref{\code{\infofilename\unskip}}%
8993 \else
8994 % Reference within this manual.
8996 % _ (for example) has to be the character _ for the purposes of the
8997 % control sequence corresponding to the node, but it has to expand
8998 % into the usual \leavevmode...\vrule stuff for purposes of
8999 % printing. So we \turnoffactive for the \refx-snt, back on for the
9000 % printing, back off for the \refx-pg.
9001 {\turnoffactive
9002 % Only output a following space if the -snt ref is nonempty; for
9003 % @unnumbered and @anchor, it won't be.
9004 \setbox2 = \hbox{\ignorespaces \refx{#1-snt}{}}%
9005 \ifdim \wd2 > 0pt \refx{#1-snt}\space\fi
9007 % output the `[mynode]' via the macro below so it can be overridden.
9008 \xrefprintnodename\printedrefname
9010 % But we always want a comma and a space:
9011 ,\space
9013 % output the `page 3'.
9014 \turnoffactive \putwordpage\tie\refx{#1-pg}{}%
9015 % Add a , if xref followed by a space
9016 \if\space\noexpand\tokenafterxref ,%
9017 \else\ifx\ \tokenafterxref ,% @TAB
9018 \else\ifx\*\tokenafterxref ,% @*
9019 \else\ifx\ \tokenafterxref ,% @SPACE
9020 \else\ifx\
9021 \tokenafterxref ,% @NL
9022 \else\ifx\tie\tokenafterxref ,% @tie
9023 \fi\fi\fi\fi\fi\fi
9024 \fi\fi
9026 \endlink
9027 \endgroup}
9029 % Output a cross-manual xref to #1. Used just above (twice).
9031 % Only include the text "Section ``foo'' in" if the foo is neither
9032 % missing or Top. Thus, @xref{,,,foo,The Foo Manual} outputs simply
9033 % "see The Foo Manual", the idea being to refer to the whole manual.
9035 % But, this being TeX, we can't easily compare our node name against the
9036 % string "Top" while ignoring the possible spaces before and after in
9037 % the input. By adding the arbitrary 7sp below, we make it much less
9038 % likely that a real node name would have the same width as "Top" (e.g.,
9039 % in a monospaced font). Hopefully it will never happen in practice.
9041 % For the same basic reason, we retypeset the "Top" at every
9042 % reference, since the current font is indeterminate.
9044 \def\crossmanualxref#1{%
9045 \setbox\toprefbox = \hbox{Top\kern7sp}%
9046 \setbox2 = \hbox{\ignorespaces \printedrefname \unskip \kern7sp}%
9047 \ifdim \wd2 > 7sp % nonempty?
9048 \ifdim \wd2 = \wd\toprefbox \else % same as Top?
9049 \putwordSection{} ``\printedrefname'' \putwordin{}\space
9055 % This macro is called from \xrefX for the `[nodename]' part of xref
9056 % output. It's a separate macro only so it can be changed more easily,
9057 % since square brackets don't work well in some documents. Particularly
9058 % one that Bob is working on :).
9060 \def\xrefprintnodename#1{[#1]}
9062 % Things referred to by \setref.
9064 \def\Ynothing{}
9065 \def\Yomitfromtoc{}
9066 \def\Ynumbered{%
9067 \ifnum\secno=0
9068 \putwordChapter@tie \the\chapno
9069 \else \ifnum\subsecno=0
9070 \putwordSection@tie \the\chapno.\the\secno
9071 \else \ifnum\subsubsecno=0
9072 \putwordSection@tie \the\chapno.\the\secno.\the\subsecno
9073 \else
9074 \putwordSection@tie \the\chapno.\the\secno.\the\subsecno.\the\subsubsecno
9075 \fi\fi\fi
9077 \def\Yappendix{%
9078 \ifnum\secno=0
9079 \putwordAppendix@tie @char\the\appendixno{}%
9080 \else \ifnum\subsecno=0
9081 \putwordSection@tie @char\the\appendixno.\the\secno
9082 \else \ifnum\subsubsecno=0
9083 \putwordSection@tie @char\the\appendixno.\the\secno.\the\subsecno
9084 \else
9085 \putwordSection@tie
9086 @char\the\appendixno.\the\secno.\the\subsecno.\the\subsubsecno
9087 \fi\fi\fi
9090 % \refx{NAME}{SUFFIX} - reference a cross-reference string named NAME. SUFFIX
9091 % is output afterwards if non-empty.
9092 \def\refx#1#2{%
9093 \requireauxfile
9095 \indexnofonts
9096 \otherbackslash
9097 \def\value##1{##1}%
9098 \expandafter\global\expandafter\let\expandafter\thisrefX
9099 \csname XR#1\endcsname
9101 \ifx\thisrefX\relax
9102 % If not defined, say something at least.
9103 \angleleft un\-de\-fined\angleright
9104 \iflinks
9105 \ifhavexrefs
9106 {\toks0 = {#1}% avoid expansion of possibly-complex value
9107 \message{\linenumber Undefined cross reference `\the\toks0'.}}%
9108 \else
9109 \ifwarnedxrefs\else
9110 \global\warnedxrefstrue
9111 \message{Cross reference values unknown; you must run TeX again.}%
9115 \else
9116 % It's defined, so just use it.
9117 \thisrefX
9119 #2% Output the suffix in any case.
9122 % This is the macro invoked by entries in the aux file. Define a control
9123 % sequence for a cross-reference target (we prepend XR to the control sequence
9124 % name to avoid collisions). The value is the page number. If this is a float
9125 % type, we have more work to do.
9127 \def\xrdef#1#2{%
9128 {% Expand the node or anchor name to remove control sequences.
9129 % \turnoffactive stops 8-bit characters being changed to commands
9130 % like @'e. \refx does the same to retrieve the value in the definition.
9131 \indexnofonts
9132 \turnoffactive
9133 \def\value##1{##1}%
9134 \xdef\safexrefname{#1}%
9137 \bgroup
9138 \expandafter\gdef\csname XR\safexrefname\endcsname{#2}%
9139 \egroup
9140 % We put the \gdef inside a group to avoid the definitions building up on
9141 % TeX's save stack, which can cause it to run out of space for aux files with
9142 % thousands of lines. \gdef doesn't use the save stack, but \csname does
9143 % when it defines an unknown control sequence as \relax.
9145 % Was that xref control sequence that we just defined for a float?
9146 \expandafter\iffloat\csname XR\safexrefname\endcsname
9147 % it was a float, and we have the (safe) float type in \iffloattype.
9148 \expandafter\let\expandafter\floatlist
9149 \csname floatlist\iffloattype\endcsname
9151 % Is this the first time we've seen this float type?
9152 \expandafter\ifx\floatlist\relax
9153 \toks0 = {\do}% yes, so just \do
9154 \else
9155 % had it before, so preserve previous elements in list.
9156 \toks0 = \expandafter{\floatlist\do}%
9159 % Remember this xref in the control sequence \floatlistFLOATTYPE,
9160 % for later use in \listoffloats.
9161 \expandafter\xdef\csname floatlist\iffloattype\endcsname{\the\toks0
9162 {\safexrefname}}%
9166 % If working on a large document in chapters, it is convenient to
9167 % be able to disable indexing, cross-referencing, and contents, for test runs.
9168 % This is done with @novalidate at the beginning of the file.
9170 \newif\iflinks \linkstrue % by default we want the aux files.
9171 \let\novalidate = \linksfalse
9173 % Used when writing to the aux file, or when using data from it.
9174 \def\requireauxfile{%
9175 \iflinks
9176 \tryauxfile
9177 % Open the new aux file. TeX will close it automatically at exit.
9178 \immediate\openout\auxfile=\jobname.aux
9180 \global\let\requireauxfile=\relax % Only do this once.
9183 % Read the last existing aux file, if any. No error if none exists.
9185 \def\tryauxfile{%
9186 \openin 1 \jobname.aux
9187 \ifeof 1 \else
9188 \readdatafile{aux}%
9189 \global\havexrefstrue
9191 \closein 1
9194 \def\setupdatafile{%
9195 \catcode`\^^@=\other
9196 \catcode`\^^A=\other
9197 \catcode`\^^B=\other
9198 \catcode`\^^C=\other
9199 \catcode`\^^D=\other
9200 \catcode`\^^E=\other
9201 \catcode`\^^F=\other
9202 \catcode`\^^G=\other
9203 \catcode`\^^H=\other
9204 \catcode`\^^K=\other
9205 \catcode`\^^L=\other
9206 \catcode`\^^N=\other
9207 \catcode`\^^P=\other
9208 \catcode`\^^Q=\other
9209 \catcode`\^^R=\other
9210 \catcode`\^^S=\other
9211 \catcode`\^^T=\other
9212 \catcode`\^^U=\other
9213 \catcode`\^^V=\other
9214 \catcode`\^^W=\other
9215 \catcode`\^^X=\other
9216 \catcode`\^^Z=\other
9217 \catcode`\^^[=\other
9218 \catcode`\^^\=\other
9219 \catcode`\^^]=\other
9220 \catcode`\^^^=\other
9221 \catcode`\^^_=\other
9222 % It was suggested to set the catcode of ^ to 7, which would allow ^^e4 etc.
9223 % in xref tags, i.e., node names. But since ^^e4 notation isn't
9224 % supported in the main text, it doesn't seem desirable. Furthermore,
9225 % that is not enough: for node names that actually contain a ^
9226 % character, we would end up writing a line like this: 'xrdef {'hat
9227 % b-title}{'hat b} and \xrdef does a \csname...\endcsname on the first
9228 % argument, and \hat is not an expandable control sequence. It could
9229 % all be worked out, but why? Either we support ^^ or we don't.
9231 % The other change necessary for this was to define \auxhat:
9232 % \def\auxhat{\def^{'hat }}% extra space so ok if followed by letter
9233 % and then to call \auxhat in \setq.
9235 \catcode`\^=\other
9237 % Special characters. Should be turned off anyway, but...
9238 \catcode`\~=\other
9239 \catcode`\[=\other
9240 \catcode`\]=\other
9241 \catcode`\"=\other
9242 \catcode`\_=\other
9243 \catcode`\|=\other
9244 \catcode`\<=\other
9245 \catcode`\>=\other
9246 \catcode`\$=\other
9247 \catcode`\#=\other
9248 \catcode`\&=\other
9249 \catcode`\%=\other
9250 \catcode`+=\other % avoid \+ for paranoia even though we've turned it off
9252 % This is to support \ in node names and titles, since the \
9253 % characters end up in a \csname. It's easier than
9254 % leaving it active and making its active definition an actual \
9255 % character. What I don't understand is why it works in the *value*
9256 % of the xrdef. Seems like it should be a catcode12 \, and that
9257 % should not typeset properly. But it works, so I'm moving on for
9258 % now. --karl, 15jan04.
9259 \catcode`\\=\other
9261 % @ is our escape character in .aux files, and we need braces.
9262 \catcode`\{=1
9263 \catcode`\}=2
9264 \catcode`\@=0
9267 \def\readdatafile#1{%
9268 \begingroup
9269 \setupdatafile
9270 \input\jobname.#1
9271 \endgroup}
9274 \message{insertions,}
9275 % including footnotes.
9277 \newcount \footnoteno
9279 % The trailing space in the following definition for supereject is
9280 % vital for proper filling; pages come out unaligned when you do a
9281 % pagealignmacro call if that space before the closing brace is
9282 % removed. (Generally, numeric constants should always be followed by a
9283 % space to prevent strange expansion errors.)
9284 \def\supereject{\par\penalty -20000\footnoteno =0 }
9286 % @footnotestyle is meaningful for Info output only.
9287 \let\footnotestyle=\comment
9289 {\catcode `\@=11
9291 % Auto-number footnotes. Otherwise like plain.
9292 \gdef\footnote{%
9293 \global\advance\footnoteno by \@ne
9294 \edef\thisfootno{$^{\the\footnoteno}$}%
9296 % In case the footnote comes at the end of a sentence, preserve the
9297 % extra spacing after we do the footnote number.
9298 \let\@sf\empty
9299 \ifhmode\edef\@sf{\spacefactor\the\spacefactor}\ptexslash\fi
9301 % Remove inadvertent blank space before typesetting the footnote number.
9302 \unskip
9303 \thisfootno\@sf
9304 \dofootnote
9307 % Don't bother with the trickery in plain.tex to not require the
9308 % footnote text as a parameter. Our footnotes don't need to be so general.
9310 % Oh yes, they do; otherwise, @ifset (and anything else that uses
9311 % \parseargline) fails inside footnotes because the tokens are fixed when
9312 % the footnote is read. --karl, 16nov96.
9314 \gdef\dofootnote{%
9315 \insert\footins\bgroup
9317 % Nested footnotes are not supported in TeX, that would take a lot
9318 % more work. (\startsavinginserts does not suffice.)
9319 \let\footnote=\errfootnotenest
9321 % We want to typeset this text as a normal paragraph, even if the
9322 % footnote reference occurs in (for example) a display environment.
9323 % So reset some parameters.
9324 \hsize=\txipagewidth
9325 \interlinepenalty\interfootnotelinepenalty
9326 \splittopskip\ht\strutbox % top baseline for broken footnotes
9327 \splitmaxdepth\dp\strutbox
9328 \floatingpenalty\@MM
9329 \leftskip\z@skip
9330 \rightskip\z@skip
9331 \spaceskip\z@skip
9332 \xspaceskip\z@skip
9333 \parindent\defaultparindent
9335 \smallfonts \rm
9337 % Because we use hanging indentation in footnotes, a @noindent appears
9338 % to exdent this text, so make it be a no-op. makeinfo does not use
9339 % hanging indentation so @noindent can still be needed within footnote
9340 % text after an @example or the like (not that this is good style).
9341 \let\noindent = \relax
9343 % Hang the footnote text off the number. Use \everypar in case the
9344 % footnote extends for more than one paragraph.
9345 \everypar = {\hang}%
9346 \textindent{\thisfootno}%
9348 % Don't crash into the line above the footnote text. Since this
9349 % expands into a box, it must come within the paragraph, lest it
9350 % provide a place where TeX can split the footnote.
9351 \footstrut
9353 % Invoke rest of plain TeX footnote routine.
9354 \futurelet\next\fo@t
9356 }%end \catcode `\@=11
9358 \def\errfootnotenest{%
9359 \errhelp=\EMsimple
9360 \errmessage{Nested footnotes not supported in texinfo.tex,
9361 even though they work in makeinfo; sorry}
9364 \def\errfootnoteheading{%
9365 \errhelp=\EMsimple
9366 \errmessage{Footnotes in chapters, sections, etc., are not supported}
9369 % In case a @footnote appears in a vbox, save the footnote text and create
9370 % the real \insert just after the vbox finished. Otherwise, the insertion
9371 % would be lost.
9372 % Similarly, if a @footnote appears inside an alignment, save the footnote
9373 % text to a box and make the \insert when a row of the table is finished.
9374 % And the same can be done for other insert classes. --kasal, 16nov03.
9376 % Replace the \insert primitive by a cheating macro.
9377 % Deeper inside, just make sure that the saved insertions are not spilled
9378 % out prematurely.
9380 \def\startsavinginserts{%
9381 \ifx \insert\ptexinsert
9382 \let\insert\saveinsert
9383 \else
9384 \let\checkinserts\relax
9388 % This \insert replacement works for both \insert\footins{foo} and
9389 % \insert\footins\bgroup foo\egroup, but it doesn't work for \insert27{foo}.
9391 \def\saveinsert#1{%
9392 \edef\next{\noexpand\savetobox \makeSAVEname#1}%
9393 \afterassignment\next
9394 % swallow the left brace
9395 \let\temp =
9397 \def\makeSAVEname#1{\makecsname{SAVE\expandafter\gobble\string#1}}
9398 \def\savetobox#1{\global\setbox#1 = \vbox\bgroup \unvbox#1}
9400 \def\checksaveins#1{\ifvoid#1\else \placesaveins#1\fi}
9402 \def\placesaveins#1{%
9403 \ptexinsert \csname\expandafter\gobblesave\string#1\endcsname
9404 {\box#1}%
9407 % eat @SAVE -- beware, all of them have catcode \other:
9409 \def\dospecials{\do S\do A\do V\do E} \uncatcodespecials % ;-)
9410 \gdef\gobblesave @SAVE{}
9413 % initialization:
9414 \def\newsaveins #1{%
9415 \edef\next{\noexpand\newsaveinsX \makeSAVEname#1}%
9416 \next
9418 \def\newsaveinsX #1{%
9419 \csname newbox\endcsname #1%
9420 \expandafter\def\expandafter\checkinserts\expandafter{\checkinserts
9421 \checksaveins #1}%
9424 % initialize:
9425 \let\checkinserts\empty
9426 \newsaveins\footins
9427 \newsaveins\margin
9430 % @image. We use the macros from epsf.tex to support this.
9431 % If epsf.tex is not installed and @image is used, we complain.
9433 % Check for and read epsf.tex up front. If we read it only at @image
9434 % time, we might be inside a group, and then its definitions would get
9435 % undone and the next image would fail.
9436 \openin 1 = epsf.tex
9437 \ifeof 1 \else
9438 % Do not bother showing banner with epsf.tex v2.7k (available in
9439 % doc/epsf.tex and on ctan).
9440 \def\epsfannounce{\toks0 = }%
9441 \input epsf.tex
9443 \closein 1
9445 % We will only complain once about lack of epsf.tex.
9446 \newif\ifwarnednoepsf
9447 \newhelp\noepsfhelp{epsf.tex must be installed for images to
9448 work. It is also included in the Texinfo distribution, or you can get
9449 it from https://ctan.org/texarchive/macros/texinfo/texinfo/doc/epsf.tex.}
9451 \def\image#1{%
9452 \ifx\epsfbox\thisisundefined
9453 \ifwarnednoepsf \else
9454 \errhelp = \noepsfhelp
9455 \errmessage{epsf.tex not found, images will be ignored}%
9456 \global\warnednoepsftrue
9458 \else
9459 \imagexxx #1,,,,,\finish
9463 % Arguments to @image:
9464 % #1 is (mandatory) image filename; we tack on .eps extension.
9465 % #2 is (optional) width, #3 is (optional) height.
9466 % #4 is (ignored optional) html alt text.
9467 % #5 is (ignored optional) extension.
9468 % #6 is just the usual extra ignored arg for parsing stuff.
9469 \newif\ifimagevmode
9470 \def\imagexxx#1,#2,#3,#4,#5,#6\finish{\begingroup
9471 \catcode`\^^M = 5 % in case we're inside an example
9472 \normalturnoffactive % allow _ et al. in names
9473 \def\xprocessmacroarg{\eatspaces}% in case we are being used via a macro
9474 % If the image is by itself, center it.
9475 \ifvmode
9476 \imagevmodetrue
9477 \else \ifx\centersub\centerV
9478 % for @center @image, we need a vbox so we can have our vertical space
9479 \imagevmodetrue
9480 \vbox\bgroup % vbox has better behavior than vtop herev
9481 \fi\fi
9483 \ifimagevmode
9484 \nobreak\medskip
9485 % Usually we'll have text after the image which will insert
9486 % \parskip glue, so insert it here too to equalize the space
9487 % above and below.
9488 \nobreak\vskip\parskip
9489 \nobreak
9492 % Leave vertical mode so that indentation from an enclosing
9493 % environment such as @quotation is respected.
9494 % However, if we're at the top level, we don't want the
9495 % normal paragraph indentation.
9496 % On the other hand, if we are in the case of @center @image, we don't
9497 % want to start a paragraph, which will create a hsize-width box and
9498 % eradicate the centering.
9499 \ifx\centersub\centerV\else \noindent \fi
9501 % Output the image.
9502 \ifpdf
9503 % For pdfTeX and LuaTeX <= 0.80
9504 \dopdfimage{#1}{#2}{#3}%
9505 \else
9506 \ifx\XeTeXrevision\thisisundefined
9507 % For epsf.tex
9508 % \epsfbox itself resets \epsf?size at each figure.
9509 \setbox0 = \hbox{\ignorespaces #2}%
9510 \ifdim\wd0 > 0pt \epsfxsize=#2\relax \fi
9511 \setbox0 = \hbox{\ignorespaces #3}%
9512 \ifdim\wd0 > 0pt \epsfysize=#3\relax \fi
9513 \epsfbox{#1.eps}%
9514 \else
9515 % For XeTeX
9516 \doxeteximage{#1}{#2}{#3}%
9520 \ifimagevmode
9521 \medskip % space after a standalone image
9522 \fi
9523 \ifx\centersub\centerV \egroup \fi
9524 \endgroup}
9527 % @float FLOATTYPE,LABEL,LOC ... @end float for displayed figures, tables,
9528 % etc. We don't actually implement floating yet, we always include the
9529 % float "here". But it seemed the best name for the future.
9531 \envparseargdef\float{\eatcommaspace\eatcommaspace\dofloat#1, , ,\finish}
9533 % There may be a space before second and/or third parameter; delete it.
9534 \def\eatcommaspace#1, {#1,}
9536 % #1 is the optional FLOATTYPE, the text label for this float, typically
9537 % "Figure", "Table", "Example", etc. Can't contain commas. If omitted,
9538 % this float will not be numbered and cannot be referred to.
9540 % #2 is the optional xref label. Also must be present for the float to
9541 % be referable.
9543 % #3 is the optional positioning argument; for now, it is ignored. It
9544 % will somehow specify the positions allowed to float to (here, top, bottom).
9546 % We keep a separate counter for each FLOATTYPE, which we reset at each
9547 % chapter-level command.
9548 \let\resetallfloatnos=\empty
9550 \def\dofloat#1,#2,#3,#4\finish{%
9551 \let\thiscaption=\empty
9552 \let\thisshortcaption=\empty
9554 % don't lose footnotes inside @float.
9556 % BEWARE: when the floats start float, we have to issue warning whenever an
9557 % insert appears inside a float which could possibly float. --kasal, 26may04
9559 \startsavinginserts
9561 % We can't be used inside a paragraph.
9562 \par
9564 \vtop\bgroup
9565 \def\floattype{#1}%
9566 \def\floatlabel{#2}%
9567 \def\floatloc{#3}% we do nothing with this yet.
9569 \ifx\floattype\empty
9570 \let\safefloattype=\empty
9571 \else
9573 % the floattype might have accents or other special characters,
9574 % but we need to use it in a control sequence name.
9575 \indexnofonts
9576 \turnoffactive
9577 \xdef\safefloattype{\floattype}%
9581 % If label is given but no type, we handle that as the empty type.
9582 \ifx\floatlabel\empty \else
9583 % We want each FLOATTYPE to be numbered separately (Figure 1,
9584 % Table 1, Figure 2, ...). (And if no label, no number.)
9586 \expandafter\getfloatno\csname\safefloattype floatno\endcsname
9587 \global\advance\floatno by 1
9590 % This magic value for \lastsection is output by \setref as the
9591 % XREFLABEL-title value. \xrefX uses it to distinguish float
9592 % labels (which have a completely different output format) from
9593 % node and anchor labels. And \xrdef uses it to construct the
9594 % lists of floats.
9596 \edef\lastsection{\floatmagic=\safefloattype}%
9597 \setref{\floatlabel}{Yfloat}%
9601 % start with \parskip glue, I guess.
9602 \vskip\parskip
9604 % Don't suppress indentation if a float happens to start a section.
9605 \restorefirstparagraphindent
9608 % we have these possibilities:
9609 % @float Foo,lbl & @caption{Cap}: Foo 1.1: Cap
9610 % @float Foo,lbl & no caption: Foo 1.1
9611 % @float Foo & @caption{Cap}: Foo: Cap
9612 % @float Foo & no caption: Foo
9613 % @float ,lbl & Caption{Cap}: 1.1: Cap
9614 % @float ,lbl & no caption: 1.1
9615 % @float & @caption{Cap}: Cap
9616 % @float & no caption:
9618 \def\Efloat{%
9619 \let\floatident = \empty
9621 % In all cases, if we have a float type, it comes first.
9622 \ifx\floattype\empty \else \def\floatident{\floattype}\fi
9624 % If we have an xref label, the number comes next.
9625 \ifx\floatlabel\empty \else
9626 \ifx\floattype\empty \else % if also had float type, need tie first.
9627 \appendtomacro\floatident{\tie}%
9629 % the number.
9630 \appendtomacro\floatident{\chaplevelprefix\the\floatno}%
9633 % Start the printed caption with what we've constructed in
9634 % \floatident, but keep it separate; we need \floatident again.
9635 \let\captionline = \floatident
9637 \ifx\thiscaption\empty \else
9638 \ifx\floatident\empty \else
9639 \appendtomacro\captionline{: }% had ident, so need a colon between
9642 % caption text.
9643 \appendtomacro\captionline{\scanexp\thiscaption}%
9646 % If we have anything to print, print it, with space before.
9647 % Eventually this needs to become an \insert.
9648 \ifx\captionline\empty \else
9649 \vskip.5\parskip
9650 \captionline
9652 % Space below caption.
9653 \vskip\parskip
9656 % If have an xref label, write the list of floats info. Do this
9657 % after the caption, to avoid chance of it being a breakpoint.
9658 \ifx\floatlabel\empty \else
9659 % Write the text that goes in the lof to the aux file as
9660 % \floatlabel-lof. Besides \floatident, we include the short
9661 % caption if specified, else the full caption if specified, else nothing.
9663 \requireauxfile
9664 \atdummies
9666 \ifx\thisshortcaption\empty
9667 \def\gtemp{\thiscaption}%
9668 \else
9669 \def\gtemp{\thisshortcaption}%
9671 \immediate\write\auxfile{@xrdef{\floatlabel-lof}{\floatident
9672 \ifx\gtemp\empty \else : \gtemp \fi}}%
9675 \egroup % end of \vtop
9677 \checkinserts
9680 % Append the tokens #2 to the definition of macro #1, not expanding either.
9682 \def\appendtomacro#1#2{%
9683 \expandafter\def\expandafter#1\expandafter{#1#2}%
9686 % @caption, @shortcaption
9688 \def\caption{\docaption\thiscaption}
9689 \def\shortcaption{\docaption\thisshortcaption}
9690 \def\docaption{\checkenv\float \bgroup\scanargctxt\defcaption}
9691 \def\defcaption#1#2{\egroup \def#1{#2}}
9693 % The parameter is the control sequence identifying the counter we are
9694 % going to use. Create it if it doesn't exist and assign it to \floatno.
9695 \def\getfloatno#1{%
9696 \ifx#1\relax
9697 % Haven't seen this figure type before.
9698 \csname newcount\endcsname #1%
9700 % Remember to reset this floatno at the next chap.
9701 \expandafter\gdef\expandafter\resetallfloatnos
9702 \expandafter{\resetallfloatnos #1=0 }%
9704 \let\floatno#1%
9707 % \setref calls this to get the XREFLABEL-snt value. We want an @xref
9708 % to the FLOATLABEL to expand to "Figure 3.1". We call \setref when we
9709 % first read the @float command.
9711 \def\Yfloat{\floattype@tie \chaplevelprefix\the\floatno}%
9713 % Magic string used for the XREFLABEL-title value, so \xrefX can
9714 % distinguish floats from other xref types.
9715 \def\floatmagic{!!float!!}
9717 % #1 is the control sequence we are passed; we expand into a conditional
9718 % which is true if #1 represents a float ref. That is, the magic
9719 % \lastsection value which we \setref above.
9721 \def\iffloat#1{\expandafter\doiffloat#1==\finish}
9723 % #1 is (maybe) the \floatmagic string. If so, #2 will be the
9724 % (safe) float type for this float. We set \iffloattype to #2.
9726 \def\doiffloat#1=#2=#3\finish{%
9727 \def\temp{#1}%
9728 \def\iffloattype{#2}%
9729 \ifx\temp\floatmagic
9732 % @listoffloats FLOATTYPE - print a list of floats like a table of contents.
9734 \parseargdef\listoffloats{%
9735 \def\floattype{#1}% floattype
9737 % the floattype might have accents or other special characters,
9738 % but we need to use it in a control sequence name.
9739 \indexnofonts
9740 \turnoffactive
9741 \xdef\safefloattype{\floattype}%
9744 % \xrdef saves the floats as a \do-list in \floatlistSAFEFLOATTYPE.
9745 \expandafter\ifx\csname floatlist\safefloattype\endcsname \relax
9746 \ifhavexrefs
9747 % if the user said @listoffloats foo but never @float foo.
9748 \message{\linenumber No `\safefloattype' floats to list.}%
9750 \else
9751 \begingroup
9752 \leftskip=\tocindent % indent these entries like a toc
9753 \let\do=\listoffloatsdo
9754 \csname floatlist\safefloattype\endcsname
9755 \endgroup
9759 % This is called on each entry in a list of floats. We're passed the
9760 % xref label, in the form LABEL-title, which is how we save it in the
9761 % aux file. We strip off the -title and look up \XRLABEL-lof, which
9762 % has the text we're supposed to typeset here.
9764 % Figures without xref labels will not be included in the list (since
9765 % they won't appear in the aux file).
9767 \def\listoffloatsdo#1{\listoffloatsdoentry#1\finish}
9768 \def\listoffloatsdoentry#1-title\finish{{%
9769 % Can't fully expand XR#1-lof because it can contain anything. Just
9770 % pass the control sequence. On the other hand, XR#1-pg is just the
9771 % page number, and we want to fully expand that so we can get a link
9772 % in pdf output.
9773 \toksA = \expandafter{\csname XR#1-lof\endcsname}%
9775 % use the same \entry macro we use to generate the TOC and index.
9776 \edef\writeentry{\noexpand\entry{\the\toksA}{\csname XR#1-pg\endcsname}}%
9777 \writeentry
9781 \message{localization,}
9783 % For single-language documents, @documentlanguage is usually given very
9784 % early, just after @documentencoding. Single argument is the language
9785 % (de) or locale (de_DE) abbreviation.
9788 \catcode`\_ = \active
9789 \globaldefs=1
9790 \parseargdef\documentlanguage{%
9791 \tex % read txi-??.tex file in plain TeX.
9792 % Read the file by the name they passed if it exists.
9793 \let_ = \normalunderscore % normal _ character for filename test
9794 \openin 1 txi-#1.tex
9795 \ifeof 1
9796 \documentlanguagetrywithoutunderscore #1_\finish
9797 \else
9798 \globaldefs = 1 % everything in the txi-LL files needs to persist
9799 \input txi-#1.tex
9801 \closein 1
9802 \endgroup % end raw TeX
9805 % If they passed de_DE, and txi-de_DE.tex doesn't exist,
9806 % try txi-de.tex.
9808 \gdef\documentlanguagetrywithoutunderscore#1_#2\finish{%
9809 \openin 1 txi-#1.tex
9810 \ifeof 1
9811 \errhelp = \nolanghelp
9812 \errmessage{Cannot read language file txi-#1.tex}%
9813 \else
9814 \globaldefs = 1 % everything in the txi-LL files needs to persist
9815 \input txi-#1.tex
9817 \closein 1
9819 }% end of special _ catcode
9821 \newhelp\nolanghelp{The given language definition file cannot be found or
9822 is empty. Maybe you need to install it? Putting it in the current
9823 directory should work if nowhere else does.}
9825 % This macro is called from txi-??.tex files; the first argument is the
9826 % \language name to set (without the "\lang@" prefix), the second and
9827 % third args are \{left,right}hyphenmin.
9829 % The language names to pass are determined when the format is built.
9830 % See the etex.log file created at that time, e.g.,
9831 % /usr/local/texlive/2008/texmf-var/web2c/pdftex/etex.log.
9833 % With TeX Live 2008, etex now includes hyphenation patterns for all
9834 % available languages. This means we can support hyphenation in
9835 % Texinfo, at least to some extent. (This still doesn't solve the
9836 % accented characters problem.)
9838 \catcode`@=11
9839 \def\txisetlanguage#1#2#3{%
9840 % do not set the language if the name is undefined in the current TeX.
9841 \expandafter\ifx\csname lang@#1\endcsname \relax
9842 \message{no patterns for #1}%
9843 \else
9844 \global\language = \csname lang@#1\endcsname
9846 % but there is no harm in adjusting the hyphenmin values regardless.
9847 \global\lefthyphenmin = #2\relax
9848 \global\righthyphenmin = #3\relax
9851 % XeTeX and LuaTeX can handle Unicode natively.
9852 % Their default I/O uses UTF-8 sequences instead of a byte-wise operation.
9853 % Other TeX engines' I/O (pdfTeX, etc.) is byte-wise.
9855 \newif\iftxinativeunicodecapable
9856 \newif\iftxiusebytewiseio
9858 \ifx\XeTeXrevision\thisisundefined
9859 \ifx\luatexversion\thisisundefined
9860 \txinativeunicodecapablefalse
9861 \txiusebytewiseiotrue
9862 \else
9863 \txinativeunicodecapabletrue
9864 \txiusebytewiseiofalse
9866 \else
9867 \txinativeunicodecapabletrue
9868 \txiusebytewiseiofalse
9871 % Set I/O by bytes instead of UTF-8 sequence for XeTeX and LuaTex
9872 % for non-UTF-8 (byte-wise) encodings.
9874 \def\setbytewiseio{%
9875 \ifx\XeTeXrevision\thisisundefined
9876 \else
9877 \XeTeXdefaultencoding "bytes" % For subsequent files to be read
9878 \XeTeXinputencoding "bytes" % For document root file
9879 % Unfortunately, there seems to be no corresponding XeTeX command for
9880 % output encoding. This is a problem for auxiliary index and TOC files.
9881 % The only solution would be perhaps to write out @U{...} sequences in
9882 % place of non-ASCII characters.
9885 \ifx\luatexversion\thisisundefined
9886 \else
9887 \directlua{
9888 local utf8_char, byte, gsub = unicode.utf8.char, string.byte, string.gsub
9889 local function convert_char (char)
9890 return utf8_char(byte(char))
9893 local function convert_line (line)
9894 return gsub(line, ".", convert_char)
9897 callback.register("process_input_buffer", convert_line)
9899 local function convert_line_out (line)
9900 local line_out = ""
9901 for c in string.utfvalues(line) do
9902 line_out = line_out .. string.char(c)
9904 return line_out
9907 callback.register("process_output_buffer", convert_line_out)
9911 \txiusebytewiseiotrue
9915 % Helpers for encodings.
9916 % Set the catcode of characters 128 through 255 to the specified number.
9918 \def\setnonasciicharscatcode#1{%
9919 \count255=128
9920 \loop\ifnum\count255<256
9921 \global\catcode\count255=#1\relax
9922 \advance\count255 by 1
9923 \repeat
9926 \def\setnonasciicharscatcodenonglobal#1{%
9927 \count255=128
9928 \loop\ifnum\count255<256
9929 \catcode\count255=#1\relax
9930 \advance\count255 by 1
9931 \repeat
9934 % @documentencoding sets the definition of non-ASCII characters
9935 % according to the specified encoding.
9937 \def\documentencoding{\parseargusing\filenamecatcodes\documentencodingzzz}
9938 \def\documentencodingzzz#1{%
9940 % Encoding being declared for the document.
9941 \def\declaredencoding{\csname #1.enc\endcsname}%
9943 % Supported encodings: names converted to tokens in order to be able
9944 % to compare them with \ifx.
9945 \def\ascii{\csname US-ASCII.enc\endcsname}%
9946 \def\latnine{\csname ISO-8859-15.enc\endcsname}%
9947 \def\latone{\csname ISO-8859-1.enc\endcsname}%
9948 \def\lattwo{\csname ISO-8859-2.enc\endcsname}%
9949 \def\utfeight{\csname UTF-8.enc\endcsname}%
9951 \ifx \declaredencoding \ascii
9952 \asciichardefs
9954 \else \ifx \declaredencoding \lattwo
9955 \iftxinativeunicodecapable
9956 \setbytewiseio
9958 \setnonasciicharscatcode\active
9959 \lattwochardefs
9961 \else \ifx \declaredencoding \latone
9962 \iftxinativeunicodecapable
9963 \setbytewiseio
9965 \setnonasciicharscatcode\active
9966 \latonechardefs
9968 \else \ifx \declaredencoding \latnine
9969 \iftxinativeunicodecapable
9970 \setbytewiseio
9972 \setnonasciicharscatcode\active
9973 \latninechardefs
9975 \else \ifx \declaredencoding \utfeight
9976 \iftxinativeunicodecapable
9977 % For native Unicode handling (XeTeX and LuaTeX)
9978 \nativeunicodechardefs
9979 \else
9980 % For treating UTF-8 as byte sequences (TeX, eTeX and pdfTeX)
9981 \setnonasciicharscatcode\active
9982 % since we already invoked \utfeightchardefs at the top level
9983 % (below), do not re-invoke it, otherwise our check for duplicated
9984 % definitions gets triggered. Making non-ascii chars active is
9985 % sufficient.
9988 \else
9989 \message{Ignoring unknown document encoding: #1.}%
9991 \fi % utfeight
9992 \fi % latnine
9993 \fi % latone
9994 \fi % lattwo
9995 \fi % ascii
9997 \ifx\XeTeXrevision\thisisundefined
9998 \else
9999 \ifx \declaredencoding \utfeight
10000 \else
10001 \ifx \declaredencoding \ascii
10002 \else
10003 \message{Warning: XeTeX with non-UTF-8 encodings cannot handle %
10004 non-ASCII characters in auxiliary files.}%
10010 % emacs-page
10011 % A message to be logged when using a character that isn't available
10012 % the default font encoding (OT1).
10014 \def\missingcharmsg#1{\message{Character missing, sorry: #1.}}
10016 % Take account of \c (plain) vs. \, (Texinfo) difference.
10017 \def\cedilla#1{\ifx\c\ptexc\c{#1}\else\,{#1}\fi}
10019 % First, make active non-ASCII characters in order for them to be
10020 % correctly categorized when TeX reads the replacement text of
10021 % macros containing the character definitions.
10022 \setnonasciicharscatcode\active
10025 \def\gdefchar#1#2{%
10026 \gdef#1{%
10027 \ifpassthroughchars
10028 \string#1%
10029 \else
10034 % Latin1 (ISO-8859-1) character definitions.
10035 \def\latonechardefs{%
10036 \gdefchar^^a0{\tie}
10037 \gdefchar^^a1{\exclamdown}
10038 \gdefchar^^a2{{\tcfont \char162}} % cent
10039 \gdefchar^^a3{\pounds{}}
10040 \gdefchar^^a4{{\tcfont \char164}} % currency
10041 \gdefchar^^a5{{\tcfont \char165}} % yen
10042 \gdefchar^^a6{{\tcfont \char166}} % broken bar
10043 \gdefchar^^a7{\S}
10044 \gdefchar^^a8{\"{}}
10045 \gdefchar^^a9{\copyright{}}
10046 \gdefchar^^aa{\ordf}
10047 \gdefchar^^ab{\guillemetleft{}}
10048 \gdefchar^^ac{\ensuremath\lnot}
10049 \gdefchar^^ad{\-}
10050 \gdefchar^^ae{\registeredsymbol{}}
10051 \gdefchar^^af{\={}}
10053 \gdefchar^^b0{\textdegree}
10054 \gdefchar^^b1{$\pm$}
10055 \gdefchar^^b2{$^2$}
10056 \gdefchar^^b3{$^3$}
10057 \gdefchar^^b4{\'{}}
10058 \gdefchar^^b5{$\mu$}
10059 \gdefchar^^b6{\P}
10060 \gdefchar^^b7{\ensuremath\cdot}
10061 \gdefchar^^b8{\cedilla\ }
10062 \gdefchar^^b9{$^1$}
10063 \gdefchar^^ba{\ordm}
10064 \gdefchar^^bb{\guillemetright{}}
10065 \gdefchar^^bc{$1\over4$}
10066 \gdefchar^^bd{$1\over2$}
10067 \gdefchar^^be{$3\over4$}
10068 \gdefchar^^bf{\questiondown}
10070 \gdefchar^^c0{\`A}
10071 \gdefchar^^c1{\'A}
10072 \gdefchar^^c2{\^A}
10073 \gdefchar^^c3{\~A}
10074 \gdefchar^^c4{\"A}
10075 \gdefchar^^c5{\ringaccent A}
10076 \gdefchar^^c6{\AE}
10077 \gdefchar^^c7{\cedilla C}
10078 \gdefchar^^c8{\`E}
10079 \gdefchar^^c9{\'E}
10080 \gdefchar^^ca{\^E}
10081 \gdefchar^^cb{\"E}
10082 \gdefchar^^cc{\`I}
10083 \gdefchar^^cd{\'I}
10084 \gdefchar^^ce{\^I}
10085 \gdefchar^^cf{\"I}
10087 \gdefchar^^d0{\DH}
10088 \gdefchar^^d1{\~N}
10089 \gdefchar^^d2{\`O}
10090 \gdefchar^^d3{\'O}
10091 \gdefchar^^d4{\^O}
10092 \gdefchar^^d5{\~O}
10093 \gdefchar^^d6{\"O}
10094 \gdefchar^^d7{$\times$}
10095 \gdefchar^^d8{\O}
10096 \gdefchar^^d9{\`U}
10097 \gdefchar^^da{\'U}
10098 \gdefchar^^db{\^U}
10099 \gdefchar^^dc{\"U}
10100 \gdefchar^^dd{\'Y}
10101 \gdefchar^^de{\TH}
10102 \gdefchar^^df{\ss}
10104 \gdefchar^^e0{\`a}
10105 \gdefchar^^e1{\'a}
10106 \gdefchar^^e2{\^a}
10107 \gdefchar^^e3{\~a}
10108 \gdefchar^^e4{\"a}
10109 \gdefchar^^e5{\ringaccent a}
10110 \gdefchar^^e6{\ae}
10111 \gdefchar^^e7{\cedilla c}
10112 \gdefchar^^e8{\`e}
10113 \gdefchar^^e9{\'e}
10114 \gdefchar^^ea{\^e}
10115 \gdefchar^^eb{\"e}
10116 \gdefchar^^ec{\`{\dotless i}}
10117 \gdefchar^^ed{\'{\dotless i}}
10118 \gdefchar^^ee{\^{\dotless i}}
10119 \gdefchar^^ef{\"{\dotless i}}
10121 \gdefchar^^f0{\dh}
10122 \gdefchar^^f1{\~n}
10123 \gdefchar^^f2{\`o}
10124 \gdefchar^^f3{\'o}
10125 \gdefchar^^f4{\^o}
10126 \gdefchar^^f5{\~o}
10127 \gdefchar^^f6{\"o}
10128 \gdefchar^^f7{$\div$}
10129 \gdefchar^^f8{\o}
10130 \gdefchar^^f9{\`u}
10131 \gdefchar^^fa{\'u}
10132 \gdefchar^^fb{\^u}
10133 \gdefchar^^fc{\"u}
10134 \gdefchar^^fd{\'y}
10135 \gdefchar^^fe{\th}
10136 \gdefchar^^ff{\"y}
10139 % Latin9 (ISO-8859-15) encoding character definitions.
10140 \def\latninechardefs{%
10141 % Encoding is almost identical to Latin1.
10142 \latonechardefs
10144 \gdefchar^^a4{\euro{}}
10145 \gdefchar^^a6{\v S}
10146 \gdefchar^^a8{\v s}
10147 \gdefchar^^b4{\v Z}
10148 \gdefchar^^b8{\v z}
10149 \gdefchar^^bc{\OE}
10150 \gdefchar^^bd{\oe}
10151 \gdefchar^^be{\"Y}
10154 % Latin2 (ISO-8859-2) character definitions.
10155 \def\lattwochardefs{%
10156 \gdefchar^^a0{\tie}
10157 \gdefchar^^a1{\ogonek{A}}
10158 \gdefchar^^a2{\u{}}
10159 \gdefchar^^a3{\L}
10160 \gdefchar^^a4{\missingcharmsg{CURRENCY SIGN}}
10161 \gdefchar^^a5{\v L}
10162 \gdefchar^^a6{\'S}
10163 \gdefchar^^a7{\S}
10164 \gdefchar^^a8{\"{}}
10165 \gdefchar^^a9{\v S}
10166 \gdefchar^^aa{\cedilla S}
10167 \gdefchar^^ab{\v T}
10168 \gdefchar^^ac{\'Z}
10169 \gdefchar^^ad{\-}
10170 \gdefchar^^ae{\v Z}
10171 \gdefchar^^af{\dotaccent Z}
10173 \gdefchar^^b0{\textdegree{}}
10174 \gdefchar^^b1{\ogonek{a}}
10175 \gdefchar^^b2{\ogonek{ }}
10176 \gdefchar^^b3{\l}
10177 \gdefchar^^b4{\'{}}
10178 \gdefchar^^b5{\v l}
10179 \gdefchar^^b6{\'s}
10180 \gdefchar^^b7{\v{}}
10181 \gdefchar^^b8{\cedilla\ }
10182 \gdefchar^^b9{\v s}
10183 \gdefchar^^ba{\cedilla s}
10184 \gdefchar^^bb{\v t}
10185 \gdefchar^^bc{\'z}
10186 \gdefchar^^bd{\H{}}
10187 \gdefchar^^be{\v z}
10188 \gdefchar^^bf{\dotaccent z}
10190 \gdefchar^^c0{\'R}
10191 \gdefchar^^c1{\'A}
10192 \gdefchar^^c2{\^A}
10193 \gdefchar^^c3{\u A}
10194 \gdefchar^^c4{\"A}
10195 \gdefchar^^c5{\'L}
10196 \gdefchar^^c6{\'C}
10197 \gdefchar^^c7{\cedilla C}
10198 \gdefchar^^c8{\v C}
10199 \gdefchar^^c9{\'E}
10200 \gdefchar^^ca{\ogonek{E}}
10201 \gdefchar^^cb{\"E}
10202 \gdefchar^^cc{\v E}
10203 \gdefchar^^cd{\'I}
10204 \gdefchar^^ce{\^I}
10205 \gdefchar^^cf{\v D}
10207 \gdefchar^^d0{\DH}
10208 \gdefchar^^d1{\'N}
10209 \gdefchar^^d2{\v N}
10210 \gdefchar^^d3{\'O}
10211 \gdefchar^^d4{\^O}
10212 \gdefchar^^d5{\H O}
10213 \gdefchar^^d6{\"O}
10214 \gdefchar^^d7{$\times$}
10215 \gdefchar^^d8{\v R}
10216 \gdefchar^^d9{\ringaccent U}
10217 \gdefchar^^da{\'U}
10218 \gdefchar^^db{\H U}
10219 \gdefchar^^dc{\"U}
10220 \gdefchar^^dd{\'Y}
10221 \gdefchar^^de{\cedilla T}
10222 \gdefchar^^df{\ss}
10224 \gdefchar^^e0{\'r}
10225 \gdefchar^^e1{\'a}
10226 \gdefchar^^e2{\^a}
10227 \gdefchar^^e3{\u a}
10228 \gdefchar^^e4{\"a}
10229 \gdefchar^^e5{\'l}
10230 \gdefchar^^e6{\'c}
10231 \gdefchar^^e7{\cedilla c}
10232 \gdefchar^^e8{\v c}
10233 \gdefchar^^e9{\'e}
10234 \gdefchar^^ea{\ogonek{e}}
10235 \gdefchar^^eb{\"e}
10236 \gdefchar^^ec{\v e}
10237 \gdefchar^^ed{\'{\dotless{i}}}
10238 \gdefchar^^ee{\^{\dotless{i}}}
10239 \gdefchar^^ef{\v d}
10241 \gdefchar^^f0{\dh}
10242 \gdefchar^^f1{\'n}
10243 \gdefchar^^f2{\v n}
10244 \gdefchar^^f3{\'o}
10245 \gdefchar^^f4{\^o}
10246 \gdefchar^^f5{\H o}
10247 \gdefchar^^f6{\"o}
10248 \gdefchar^^f7{$\div$}
10249 \gdefchar^^f8{\v r}
10250 \gdefchar^^f9{\ringaccent u}
10251 \gdefchar^^fa{\'u}
10252 \gdefchar^^fb{\H u}
10253 \gdefchar^^fc{\"u}
10254 \gdefchar^^fd{\'y}
10255 \gdefchar^^fe{\cedilla t}
10256 \gdefchar^^ff{\dotaccent{}}
10259 % UTF-8 character definitions.
10261 % This code to support UTF-8 is based on LaTeX's utf8.def, with some
10262 % changes for Texinfo conventions. It is included here under the GPL by
10263 % permission from Frank Mittelbach and the LaTeX team.
10265 \newcount\countUTFx
10266 \newcount\countUTFy
10267 \newcount\countUTFz
10269 \gdef\UTFviiiTwoOctets#1#2{\expandafter
10270 \UTFviiiDefined\csname u8:#1\string #2\endcsname}
10272 \gdef\UTFviiiThreeOctets#1#2#3{\expandafter
10273 \UTFviiiDefined\csname u8:#1\string #2\string #3\endcsname}
10275 \gdef\UTFviiiFourOctets#1#2#3#4{\expandafter
10276 \UTFviiiDefined\csname u8:#1\string #2\string #3\string #4\endcsname}
10278 \gdef\UTFviiiDefined#1{%
10279 \ifx #1\relax
10280 \message{\linenumber Unicode char \string #1 not defined for Texinfo}%
10281 \else
10282 \expandafter #1%
10286 % Give non-ASCII bytes the active definitions for processing UTF-8 sequences
10287 \begingroup
10288 \catcode`\~13
10289 \catcode`\$12
10290 \catcode`\"12
10292 % Loop from \countUTFx to \countUTFy, performing \UTFviiiTmp
10293 % substituting ~ and $ with a character token of that value.
10294 \def\UTFviiiLoop{%
10295 \global\catcode\countUTFx\active
10296 \uccode`\~\countUTFx
10297 \uccode`\$\countUTFx
10298 \uppercase\expandafter{\UTFviiiTmp}%
10299 \advance\countUTFx by 1
10300 \ifnum\countUTFx < \countUTFy
10301 \expandafter\UTFviiiLoop
10302 \fi}
10304 % For bytes other than the first in a UTF-8 sequence. Not expected to
10305 % be expanded except when writing to auxiliary files.
10306 \countUTFx = "80
10307 \countUTFy = "C2
10308 \def\UTFviiiTmp{%
10309 \gdef~{%
10310 \ifpassthroughchars $\fi}}%
10311 \UTFviiiLoop
10313 \countUTFx = "C2
10314 \countUTFy = "E0
10315 \def\UTFviiiTmp{%
10316 \gdef~{%
10317 \ifpassthroughchars $%
10318 \else\expandafter\UTFviiiTwoOctets\expandafter$\fi}}%
10319 \UTFviiiLoop
10321 \countUTFx = "E0
10322 \countUTFy = "F0
10323 \def\UTFviiiTmp{%
10324 \gdef~{%
10325 \ifpassthroughchars $%
10326 \else\expandafter\UTFviiiThreeOctets\expandafter$\fi}}%
10327 \UTFviiiLoop
10329 \countUTFx = "F0
10330 \countUTFy = "F4
10331 \def\UTFviiiTmp{%
10332 \gdef~{%
10333 \ifpassthroughchars $%
10334 \else\expandafter\UTFviiiFourOctets\expandafter$\fi
10336 \UTFviiiLoop
10337 \endgroup
10339 \def\globallet{\global\let} % save some \expandafter's below
10341 % @U{xxxx} to produce U+xxxx, if we support it.
10342 \def\U#1{%
10343 \expandafter\ifx\csname uni:#1\endcsname \relax
10344 \iftxinativeunicodecapable
10345 % All Unicode characters can be used if native Unicode handling is
10346 % active. However, if the font does not have the glyph,
10347 % letters are missing.
10348 \begingroup
10349 \uccode`\.="#1\relax
10350 \uppercase{.}
10351 \endgroup
10352 \else
10353 \errhelp = \EMsimple
10354 \errmessage{Unicode character U+#1 not supported, sorry}%
10356 \else
10357 \csname uni:#1\endcsname
10361 % These macros are used here to construct the name of a control
10362 % sequence to be defined.
10363 \def\UTFviiiTwoOctetsName#1#2{%
10364 \csname u8:#1\string #2\endcsname}%
10365 \def\UTFviiiThreeOctetsName#1#2#3{%
10366 \csname u8:#1\string #2\string #3\endcsname}%
10367 \def\UTFviiiFourOctetsName#1#2#3#4{%
10368 \csname u8:#1\string #2\string #3\string #4\endcsname}%
10370 % For UTF-8 byte sequences (TeX, e-TeX and pdfTeX),
10371 % provide a definition macro to replace a Unicode character;
10372 % this gets used by the @U command
10374 \begingroup
10375 \catcode`\"=12
10376 \catcode`\<=12
10377 \catcode`\.=12
10378 \catcode`\,=12
10379 \catcode`\;=12
10380 \catcode`\!=12
10381 \catcode`\~=13
10382 \gdef\DeclareUnicodeCharacterUTFviii#1#2{%
10383 \countUTFz = "#1\relax
10384 \begingroup
10385 \parseXMLCharref
10387 % Give \u8:... its definition. The sequence of seven \expandafter's
10388 % expands after the \gdef three times, e.g.
10390 % 1. \UTFviiTwoOctetsName B1 B2
10391 % 2. \csname u8:B1 \string B2 \endcsname
10392 % 3. \u8: B1 B2 (a single control sequence token)
10394 \expandafter\expandafter
10395 \expandafter\expandafter
10396 \expandafter\expandafter
10397 \expandafter\gdef \UTFviiiTmp{#2}%
10399 \expandafter\ifx\csname uni:#1\endcsname \relax \else
10400 \message{Internal error, already defined: #1}%
10403 % define an additional control sequence for this code point.
10404 \expandafter\globallet\csname uni:#1\endcsname \UTFviiiTmp
10405 \endgroup}
10407 % Given the value in \countUTFz as a Unicode code point, set \UTFviiiTmp
10408 % to the corresponding UTF-8 sequence.
10409 \gdef\parseXMLCharref{%
10410 \ifnum\countUTFz < "A0\relax
10411 \errhelp = \EMsimple
10412 \errmessage{Cannot define Unicode char value < 00A0}%
10413 \else\ifnum\countUTFz < "800\relax
10414 \parseUTFviiiA,%
10415 \parseUTFviiiB C\UTFviiiTwoOctetsName.,%
10416 \else\ifnum\countUTFz < "10000\relax
10417 \parseUTFviiiA;%
10418 \parseUTFviiiA,%
10419 \parseUTFviiiB E\UTFviiiThreeOctetsName.{,;}%
10420 \else
10421 \parseUTFviiiA;%
10422 \parseUTFviiiA,%
10423 \parseUTFviiiA!%
10424 \parseUTFviiiB F\UTFviiiFourOctetsName.{!,;}%
10425 \fi\fi\fi
10428 % Extract a byte from the end of the UTF-8 representation of \countUTFx.
10429 % It must be a non-initial byte in the sequence.
10430 % Change \uccode of #1 for it to be used in \parseUTFviiiB as one
10431 % of the bytes.
10432 \gdef\parseUTFviiiA#1{%
10433 \countUTFx = \countUTFz
10434 \divide\countUTFz by 64
10435 \countUTFy = \countUTFz % Save to be the future value of \countUTFz.
10436 \multiply\countUTFz by 64
10438 % \countUTFz is now \countUTFx with the last 5 bits cleared. Subtract
10439 % in order to get the last five bits.
10440 \advance\countUTFx by -\countUTFz
10442 % Convert this to the byte in the UTF-8 sequence.
10443 \advance\countUTFx by 128
10444 \uccode `#1\countUTFx
10445 \countUTFz = \countUTFy}
10447 % Used to put a UTF-8 byte sequence into \UTFviiiTmp
10448 % #1 is the increment for \countUTFz to yield a the first byte of the UTF-8
10449 % sequence.
10450 % #2 is one of the \UTFviii*OctetsName macros.
10451 % #3 is always a full stop (.)
10452 % #4 is a template for the other bytes in the sequence. The values for these
10453 % bytes is substituted in here with \uppercase using the \uccode's.
10454 \gdef\parseUTFviiiB#1#2#3#4{%
10455 \advance\countUTFz by "#10\relax
10456 \uccode `#3\countUTFz
10457 \uppercase{\gdef\UTFviiiTmp{#2#3#4}}}
10458 \endgroup
10460 % For native Unicode handling (XeTeX and LuaTeX),
10461 % provide a definition macro that sets a catcode to `other' non-globally
10463 \def\DeclareUnicodeCharacterNativeOther#1#2{%
10464 \catcode"#1=\other
10467 % https://en.wikipedia.org/wiki/Plane_(Unicode)#Basic_M
10468 % U+0000..U+007F = https://en.wikipedia.org/wiki/Basic_Latin_(Unicode_block)
10469 % U+0080..U+00FF = https://en.wikipedia.org/wiki/Latin-1_Supplement_(Unicode_block)
10470 % U+0100..U+017F = https://en.wikipedia.org/wiki/Latin_Extended-A
10471 % U+0180..U+024F = https://en.wikipedia.org/wiki/Latin_Extended-B
10473 % Many of our renditions are less than wonderful, and all the missing
10474 % characters are available somewhere. Loading the necessary fonts
10475 % awaits user request. We can't truly support Unicode without
10476 % reimplementing everything that's been done in LaTeX for many years,
10477 % plus probably using luatex or xetex, and who knows what else.
10478 % We won't be doing that here in this simple file. But we can try to at
10479 % least make most of the characters not bomb out.
10481 \def\unicodechardefs{%
10482 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00A0}{\tie}%
10483 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00A1}{\exclamdown}%
10484 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00A2}{{\tcfont \char162}}% 0242=cent
10485 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00A3}{\pounds{}}%
10486 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00A4}{{\tcfont \char164}}% 0244=currency
10487 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00A5}{{\tcfont \char165}}% 0245=yen
10488 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00A6}{{\tcfont \char166}}% 0246=brokenbar
10489 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00A7}{\S}%
10490 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00A8}{\"{ }}%
10491 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00A9}{\copyright{}}%
10492 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00AA}{\ordf}%
10493 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00AB}{\guillemetleft{}}%
10494 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00AC}{\ensuremath\lnot}%
10495 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00AD}{\-}%
10496 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00AE}{\registeredsymbol{}}%
10497 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00AF}{\={ }}%
10499 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00B0}{\ringaccent{ }}%
10500 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00B1}{\ensuremath\pm}%
10501 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00B2}{$^2$}%
10502 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00B3}{$^3$}%
10503 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00B4}{\'{ }}%
10504 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00B5}{$\mu$}%
10505 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00B6}{\P}%
10506 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00B7}{\ensuremath\cdot}%
10507 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00B8}{\cedilla{ }}%
10508 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00B9}{$^1$}%
10509 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00BA}{\ordm}%
10510 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00BB}{\guillemetright{}}%
10511 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00BC}{$1\over4$}%
10512 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00BD}{$1\over2$}%
10513 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00BE}{$3\over4$}%
10514 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00BF}{\questiondown}%
10516 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00C0}{\`A}%
10517 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00C1}{\'A}%
10518 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00C2}{\^A}%
10519 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00C3}{\~A}%
10520 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00C4}{\"A}%
10521 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00C5}{\AA}%
10522 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00C6}{\AE}%
10523 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00C7}{\cedilla{C}}%
10524 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00C8}{\`E}%
10525 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00C9}{\'E}%
10526 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00CA}{\^E}%
10527 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00CB}{\"E}%
10528 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00CC}{\`I}%
10529 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00CD}{\'I}%
10530 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00CE}{\^I}%
10531 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00CF}{\"I}%
10533 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00D0}{\DH}%
10534 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00D1}{\~N}%
10535 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00D2}{\`O}%
10536 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00D3}{\'O}%
10537 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00D4}{\^O}%
10538 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00D5}{\~O}%
10539 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00D6}{\"O}%
10540 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00D7}{\ensuremath\times}%
10541 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00D8}{\O}%
10542 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00D9}{\`U}%
10543 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00DA}{\'U}%
10544 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00DB}{\^U}%
10545 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00DC}{\"U}%
10546 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00DD}{\'Y}%
10547 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00DE}{\TH}%
10548 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00DF}{\ss}%
10550 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00E0}{\`a}%
10551 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00E1}{\'a}%
10552 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00E2}{\^a}%
10553 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00E3}{\~a}%
10554 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00E4}{\"a}%
10555 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00E5}{\aa}%
10556 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00E6}{\ae}%
10557 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00E7}{\cedilla{c}}%
10558 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00E8}{\`e}%
10559 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00E9}{\'e}%
10560 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00EA}{\^e}%
10561 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00EB}{\"e}%
10562 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00EC}{\`{\dotless{i}}}%
10563 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00ED}{\'{\dotless{i}}}%
10564 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00EE}{\^{\dotless{i}}}%
10565 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00EF}{\"{\dotless{i}}}%
10567 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00F0}{\dh}%
10568 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00F1}{\~n}%
10569 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00F2}{\`o}%
10570 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00F3}{\'o}%
10571 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00F4}{\^o}%
10572 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00F5}{\~o}%
10573 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00F6}{\"o}%
10574 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00F7}{\ensuremath\div}%
10575 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00F8}{\o}%
10576 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00F9}{\`u}%
10577 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00FA}{\'u}%
10578 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00FB}{\^u}%
10579 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00FC}{\"u}%
10580 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00FD}{\'y}%
10581 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00FE}{\th}%
10582 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00FF}{\"y}%
10584 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0100}{\=A}%
10585 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0101}{\=a}%
10586 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0102}{\u{A}}%
10587 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0103}{\u{a}}%
10588 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0104}{\ogonek{A}}%
10589 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0105}{\ogonek{a}}%
10590 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0106}{\'C}%
10591 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0107}{\'c}%
10592 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0108}{\^C}%
10593 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0109}{\^c}%
10594 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{010A}{\dotaccent{C}}%
10595 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{010B}{\dotaccent{c}}%
10596 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{010C}{\v{C}}%
10597 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{010D}{\v{c}}%
10598 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{010E}{\v{D}}%
10599 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{010F}{d'}%
10601 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0110}{\DH}%
10602 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0111}{\dh}%
10603 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0112}{\=E}%
10604 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0113}{\=e}%
10605 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0114}{\u{E}}%
10606 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0115}{\u{e}}%
10607 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0116}{\dotaccent{E}}%
10608 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0117}{\dotaccent{e}}%
10609 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0118}{\ogonek{E}}%
10610 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0119}{\ogonek{e}}%
10611 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{011A}{\v{E}}%
10612 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{011B}{\v{e}}%
10613 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{011C}{\^G}%
10614 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{011D}{\^g}%
10615 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{011E}{\u{G}}%
10616 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{011F}{\u{g}}%
10618 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0120}{\dotaccent{G}}%
10619 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0121}{\dotaccent{g}}%
10620 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0122}{\cedilla{G}}%
10621 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0123}{\cedilla{g}}%
10622 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0124}{\^H}%
10623 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0125}{\^h}%
10624 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0126}{\missingcharmsg{H WITH STROKE}}%
10625 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0127}{\missingcharmsg{h WITH STROKE}}%
10626 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0128}{\~I}%
10627 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0129}{\~{\dotless{i}}}%
10628 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{012A}{\=I}%
10629 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{012B}{\={\dotless{i}}}%
10630 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{012C}{\u{I}}%
10631 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{012D}{\u{\dotless{i}}}%
10632 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{012E}{\ogonek{I}}%
10633 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{012F}{\ogonek{i}}%
10635 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0130}{\dotaccent{I}}%
10636 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0131}{\dotless{i}}%
10637 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0132}{IJ}%
10638 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0133}{ij}%
10639 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0134}{\^J}%
10640 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0135}{\^{\dotless{j}}}%
10641 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0136}{\cedilla{K}}%
10642 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0137}{\cedilla{k}}%
10643 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0138}{\ensuremath\kappa}%
10644 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0139}{\'L}%
10645 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{013A}{\'l}%
10646 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{013B}{\cedilla{L}}%
10647 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{013C}{\cedilla{l}}%
10648 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{013D}{L'}% should kern
10649 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{013E}{l'}% should kern
10650 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{013F}{L\U{00B7}}%
10652 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0140}{l\U{00B7}}%
10653 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0141}{\L}%
10654 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0142}{\l}%
10655 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0143}{\'N}%
10656 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0144}{\'n}%
10657 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0145}{\cedilla{N}}%
10658 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0146}{\cedilla{n}}%
10659 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0147}{\v{N}}%
10660 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0148}{\v{n}}%
10661 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0149}{'n}%
10662 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{014A}{\missingcharmsg{ENG}}%
10663 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{014B}{\missingcharmsg{eng}}%
10664 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{014C}{\=O}%
10665 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{014D}{\=o}%
10666 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{014E}{\u{O}}%
10667 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{014F}{\u{o}}%
10669 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0150}{\H{O}}%
10670 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0151}{\H{o}}%
10671 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0152}{\OE}%
10672 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0153}{\oe}%
10673 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0154}{\'R}%
10674 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0155}{\'r}%
10675 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0156}{\cedilla{R}}%
10676 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0157}{\cedilla{r}}%
10677 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0158}{\v{R}}%
10678 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0159}{\v{r}}%
10679 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{015A}{\'S}%
10680 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{015B}{\'s}%
10681 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{015C}{\^S}%
10682 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{015D}{\^s}%
10683 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{015E}{\cedilla{S}}%
10684 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{015F}{\cedilla{s}}%
10686 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0160}{\v{S}}%
10687 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0161}{\v{s}}%
10688 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0162}{\cedilla{T}}%
10689 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0163}{\cedilla{t}}%
10690 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0164}{\v{T}}%
10691 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0165}{\v{t}}%
10692 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0166}{\missingcharmsg{H WITH STROKE}}%
10693 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0167}{\missingcharmsg{h WITH STROKE}}%
10694 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0168}{\~U}%
10695 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0169}{\~u}%
10696 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{016A}{\=U}%
10697 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{016B}{\=u}%
10698 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{016C}{\u{U}}%
10699 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{016D}{\u{u}}%
10700 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{016E}{\ringaccent{U}}%
10701 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{016F}{\ringaccent{u}}%
10703 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0170}{\H{U}}%
10704 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0171}{\H{u}}%
10705 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0172}{\ogonek{U}}%
10706 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0173}{\ogonek{u}}%
10707 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0174}{\^W}%
10708 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0175}{\^w}%
10709 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0176}{\^Y}%
10710 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0177}{\^y}%
10711 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0178}{\"Y}%
10712 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0179}{\'Z}%
10713 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{017A}{\'z}%
10714 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{017B}{\dotaccent{Z}}%
10715 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{017C}{\dotaccent{z}}%
10716 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{017D}{\v{Z}}%
10717 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{017E}{\v{z}}%
10718 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{017F}{\missingcharmsg{LONG S}}%
10720 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{01C4}{D\v{Z}}%
10721 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{01C5}{D\v{z}}%
10722 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{01C6}{d\v{z}}%
10723 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{01C7}{LJ}%
10724 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{01C8}{Lj}%
10725 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{01C9}{lj}%
10726 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{01CA}{NJ}%
10727 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{01CB}{Nj}%
10728 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{01CC}{nj}%
10729 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{01CD}{\v{A}}%
10730 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{01CE}{\v{a}}%
10731 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{01CF}{\v{I}}%
10733 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{01D0}{\v{\dotless{i}}}%
10734 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{01D1}{\v{O}}%
10735 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{01D2}{\v{o}}%
10736 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{01D3}{\v{U}}%
10737 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{01D4}{\v{u}}%
10739 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{01E2}{\={\AE}}%
10740 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{01E3}{\={\ae}}%
10741 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{01E6}{\v{G}}%
10742 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{01E7}{\v{g}}%
10743 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{01E8}{\v{K}}%
10744 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{01E9}{\v{k}}%
10746 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{01F0}{\v{\dotless{j}}}%
10747 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{01F1}{DZ}%
10748 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{01F2}{Dz}%
10749 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{01F3}{dz}%
10750 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{01F4}{\'G}%
10751 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{01F5}{\'g}%
10752 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{01F8}{\`N}%
10753 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{01F9}{\`n}%
10754 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{01FC}{\'{\AE}}%
10755 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{01FD}{\'{\ae}}%
10756 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{01FE}{\'{\O}}%
10757 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{01FF}{\'{\o}}%
10759 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{021E}{\v{H}}%
10760 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{021F}{\v{h}}%
10762 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0226}{\dotaccent{A}}%
10763 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0227}{\dotaccent{a}}%
10764 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0228}{\cedilla{E}}%
10765 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0229}{\cedilla{e}}%
10766 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{022E}{\dotaccent{O}}%
10767 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{022F}{\dotaccent{o}}%
10769 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0232}{\=Y}%
10770 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0233}{\=y}%
10771 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0237}{\dotless{j}}%
10773 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{02DB}{\ogonek{ }}%
10775 % Greek letters upper case
10776 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0391}{{\it A}}%
10777 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0392}{{\it B}}%
10778 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0393}{\ensuremath{\mit\Gamma}}%
10779 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0394}{\ensuremath{\mit\Delta}}%
10780 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0395}{{\it E}}%
10781 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0396}{{\it Z}}%
10782 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0397}{{\it H}}%
10783 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0398}{\ensuremath{\mit\Theta}}%
10784 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0399}{{\it I}}%
10785 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{039A}{{\it K}}%
10786 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{039B}{\ensuremath{\mit\Lambda}}%
10787 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{039C}{{\it M}}%
10788 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{039D}{{\it N}}%
10789 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{039E}{\ensuremath{\mit\Xi}}%
10790 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{039F}{{\it O}}%
10791 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{03A0}{\ensuremath{\mit\Pi}}%
10792 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{03A1}{{\it P}}%
10793 %\DeclareUnicodeCharacter{03A2}{} % none - corresponds to final sigma
10794 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{03A3}{\ensuremath{\mit\Sigma}}%
10795 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{03A4}{{\it T}}%
10796 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{03A5}{\ensuremath{\mit\Upsilon}}%
10797 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{03A6}{\ensuremath{\mit\Phi}}%
10798 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{03A7}{{\it X}}%
10799 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{03A8}{\ensuremath{\mit\Psi}}%
10800 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{03A9}{\ensuremath{\mit\Omega}}%
10802 % Vowels with accents
10803 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0390}{\ensuremath{\ddot{\acute\iota}}}%
10804 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{03AC}{\ensuremath{\acute\alpha}}%
10805 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{03AD}{\ensuremath{\acute\epsilon}}%
10806 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{03AE}{\ensuremath{\acute\eta}}%
10807 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{03AF}{\ensuremath{\acute\iota}}%
10808 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{03B0}{\ensuremath{\acute{\ddot\upsilon}}}%
10810 % Standalone accent
10811 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0384}{\ensuremath{\acute{\ }}}%
10813 % Greek letters lower case
10814 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{03B1}{\ensuremath\alpha}%
10815 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{03B2}{\ensuremath\beta}%
10816 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{03B3}{\ensuremath\gamma}%
10817 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{03B4}{\ensuremath\delta}%
10818 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{03B5}{\ensuremath\epsilon}%
10819 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{03B6}{\ensuremath\zeta}%
10820 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{03B7}{\ensuremath\eta}%
10821 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{03B8}{\ensuremath\theta}%
10822 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{03B9}{\ensuremath\iota}%
10823 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{03BA}{\ensuremath\kappa}%
10824 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{03BB}{\ensuremath\lambda}%
10825 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{03BC}{\ensuremath\mu}%
10826 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{03BD}{\ensuremath\nu}%
10827 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{03BE}{\ensuremath\xi}%
10828 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{03BF}{{\it o}}% omicron
10829 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{03C0}{\ensuremath\pi}%
10830 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{03C1}{\ensuremath\rho}%
10831 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{03C2}{\ensuremath\varsigma}%
10832 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{03C3}{\ensuremath\sigma}%
10833 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{03C4}{\ensuremath\tau}%
10834 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{03C5}{\ensuremath\upsilon}%
10835 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{03C6}{\ensuremath\phi}%
10836 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{03C7}{\ensuremath\chi}%
10837 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{03C8}{\ensuremath\psi}%
10838 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{03C9}{\ensuremath\omega}%
10840 % More Greek vowels with accents
10841 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{03CA}{\ensuremath{\ddot\iota}}%
10842 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{03CB}{\ensuremath{\ddot\upsilon}}%
10843 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{03CC}{\ensuremath{\acute o}}%
10844 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{03CD}{\ensuremath{\acute\upsilon}}%
10845 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{03CE}{\ensuremath{\acute\omega}}%
10847 % Variant Greek letters
10848 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{03D1}{\ensuremath\vartheta}%
10849 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{03D6}{\ensuremath\varpi}%
10850 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{03F1}{\ensuremath\varrho}%
10852 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E02}{\dotaccent{B}}%
10853 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E03}{\dotaccent{b}}%
10854 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E04}{\udotaccent{B}}%
10855 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E05}{\udotaccent{b}}%
10856 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E06}{\ubaraccent{B}}%
10857 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E07}{\ubaraccent{b}}%
10858 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E0A}{\dotaccent{D}}%
10859 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E0B}{\dotaccent{d}}%
10860 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E0C}{\udotaccent{D}}%
10861 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E0D}{\udotaccent{d}}%
10862 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E0E}{\ubaraccent{D}}%
10863 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E0F}{\ubaraccent{d}}%
10865 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E1E}{\dotaccent{F}}%
10866 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E1F}{\dotaccent{f}}%
10868 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E20}{\=G}%
10869 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E21}{\=g}%
10870 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E22}{\dotaccent{H}}%
10871 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E23}{\dotaccent{h}}%
10872 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E24}{\udotaccent{H}}%
10873 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E25}{\udotaccent{h}}%
10874 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E26}{\"H}%
10875 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E27}{\"h}%
10877 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E30}{\'K}%
10878 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E31}{\'k}%
10879 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E32}{\udotaccent{K}}%
10880 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E33}{\udotaccent{k}}%
10881 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E34}{\ubaraccent{K}}%
10882 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E35}{\ubaraccent{k}}%
10883 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E36}{\udotaccent{L}}%
10884 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E37}{\udotaccent{l}}%
10885 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E3A}{\ubaraccent{L}}%
10886 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E3B}{\ubaraccent{l}}%
10887 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E3E}{\'M}%
10888 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E3F}{\'m}%
10890 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E40}{\dotaccent{M}}%
10891 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E41}{\dotaccent{m}}%
10892 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E42}{\udotaccent{M}}%
10893 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E43}{\udotaccent{m}}%
10894 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E44}{\dotaccent{N}}%
10895 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E45}{\dotaccent{n}}%
10896 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E46}{\udotaccent{N}}%
10897 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E47}{\udotaccent{n}}%
10898 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E48}{\ubaraccent{N}}%
10899 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E49}{\ubaraccent{n}}%
10901 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E54}{\'P}%
10902 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E55}{\'p}%
10903 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E56}{\dotaccent{P}}%
10904 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E57}{\dotaccent{p}}%
10905 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E58}{\dotaccent{R}}%
10906 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E59}{\dotaccent{r}}%
10907 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E5A}{\udotaccent{R}}%
10908 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E5B}{\udotaccent{r}}%
10909 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E5E}{\ubaraccent{R}}%
10910 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E5F}{\ubaraccent{r}}%
10912 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E60}{\dotaccent{S}}%
10913 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E61}{\dotaccent{s}}%
10914 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E62}{\udotaccent{S}}%
10915 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E63}{\udotaccent{s}}%
10916 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E6A}{\dotaccent{T}}%
10917 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E6B}{\dotaccent{t}}%
10918 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E6C}{\udotaccent{T}}%
10919 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E6D}{\udotaccent{t}}%
10920 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E6E}{\ubaraccent{T}}%
10921 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E6F}{\ubaraccent{t}}%
10923 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E7C}{\~V}%
10924 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E7D}{\~v}%
10925 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E7E}{\udotaccent{V}}%
10926 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E7F}{\udotaccent{v}}%
10928 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E80}{\`W}%
10929 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E81}{\`w}%
10930 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E82}{\'W}%
10931 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E83}{\'w}%
10932 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E84}{\"W}%
10933 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E85}{\"w}%
10934 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E86}{\dotaccent{W}}%
10935 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E87}{\dotaccent{w}}%
10936 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E88}{\udotaccent{W}}%
10937 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E89}{\udotaccent{w}}%
10938 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E8A}{\dotaccent{X}}%
10939 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E8B}{\dotaccent{x}}%
10940 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E8C}{\"X}%
10941 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E8D}{\"x}%
10942 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E8E}{\dotaccent{Y}}%
10943 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E8F}{\dotaccent{y}}%
10945 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E90}{\^Z}%
10946 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E91}{\^z}%
10947 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E92}{\udotaccent{Z}}%
10948 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E93}{\udotaccent{z}}%
10949 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E94}{\ubaraccent{Z}}%
10950 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E95}{\ubaraccent{z}}%
10951 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E96}{\ubaraccent{h}}%
10952 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E97}{\"t}%
10953 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E98}{\ringaccent{w}}%
10954 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E99}{\ringaccent{y}}%
10956 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1EA0}{\udotaccent{A}}%
10957 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1EA1}{\udotaccent{a}}%
10959 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1EB8}{\udotaccent{E}}%
10960 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1EB9}{\udotaccent{e}}%
10961 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1EBC}{\~E}%
10962 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1EBD}{\~e}%
10964 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1ECA}{\udotaccent{I}}%
10965 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1ECB}{\udotaccent{i}}%
10966 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1ECC}{\udotaccent{O}}%
10967 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1ECD}{\udotaccent{o}}%
10969 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1EE4}{\udotaccent{U}}%
10970 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1EE5}{\udotaccent{u}}%
10972 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1EF2}{\`Y}%
10973 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1EF3}{\`y}%
10974 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1EF4}{\udotaccent{Y}}%
10976 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1EF8}{\~Y}%
10977 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1EF9}{\~y}%
10979 % Punctuation
10980 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{2013}{--}%
10981 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{2014}{---}%
10982 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{2018}{\quoteleft{}}%
10983 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{2019}{\quoteright{}}%
10984 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{201A}{\quotesinglbase{}}%
10985 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{201C}{\quotedblleft{}}%
10986 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{201D}{\quotedblright{}}%
10987 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{201E}{\quotedblbase{}}%
10988 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{2020}{\ensuremath\dagger}%
10989 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{2021}{\ensuremath\ddagger}%
10990 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{2022}{\bullet{}}%
10991 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{202F}{\thinspace}%
10992 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{2026}{\dots{}}%
10993 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{2039}{\guilsinglleft{}}%
10994 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{203A}{\guilsinglright{}}%
10996 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{20AC}{\euro{}}%
10998 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{2192}{\expansion{}}%
10999 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{21D2}{\result{}}%
11001 % Mathematical symbols
11002 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{2200}{\ensuremath\forall}%
11003 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{2203}{\ensuremath\exists}%
11004 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{2208}{\ensuremath\in}%
11005 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{2212}{\minus{}}%
11006 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{2217}{\ast}%
11007 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{221E}{\ensuremath\infty}%
11008 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{2225}{\ensuremath\parallel}%
11009 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{2227}{\ensuremath\wedge}%
11010 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{2229}{\ensuremath\cap}%
11011 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{2261}{\equiv{}}%
11012 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{2264}{\ensuremath\leq}%
11013 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{2265}{\ensuremath\geq}%
11014 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{2282}{\ensuremath\subset}%
11015 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{2287}{\ensuremath\supseteq}%
11017 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{2016}{\ensuremath\Vert}%
11018 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{2032}{\ensuremath\prime}%
11019 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{210F}{\ensuremath\hbar}%
11020 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{2111}{\ensuremath\Im}%
11021 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{2113}{\ensuremath\ell}%
11022 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{2118}{\ensuremath\wp}%
11023 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{211C}{\ensuremath\Re}%
11024 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{2135}{\ensuremath\aleph}%
11025 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{2190}{\ensuremath\leftarrow}%
11026 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{2191}{\ensuremath\uparrow}%
11027 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{2193}{\ensuremath\downarrow}%
11028 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{2194}{\ensuremath\leftrightarrow}%
11029 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{2195}{\ensuremath\updownarrow}%
11030 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{2196}{\ensuremath\nwarrow}%
11031 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{2197}{\ensuremath\nearrow}%
11032 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{2198}{\ensuremath\searrow}%
11033 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{2199}{\ensuremath\swarrow}%
11034 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{21A6}{\ensuremath\mapsto}%
11035 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{21A9}{\ensuremath\hookleftarrow}%
11036 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{21AA}{\ensuremath\hookrightarrow}%
11037 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{21BC}{\ensuremath\leftharpoonup}%
11038 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{21BD}{\ensuremath\leftharpoondown}%
11039 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{21C0}{\ensuremath\rightharpoonup}%
11040 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{21C1}{\ensuremath\rightharpoondown}%
11041 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{21CC}{\ensuremath\rightleftharpoons}%
11042 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{21D0}{\ensuremath\Leftarrow}%
11043 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{21D1}{\ensuremath\Uparrow}%
11044 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{21D3}{\ensuremath\Downarrow}%
11045 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{21D4}{\ensuremath\Leftrightarrow}%
11046 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{21D5}{\ensuremath\Updownarrow}%
11047 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{2202}{\ensuremath\partial}%
11048 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{2205}{\ensuremath\emptyset}%
11049 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{2207}{\ensuremath\nabla}%
11050 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{2209}{\ensuremath\notin}%
11051 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{220B}{\ensuremath\owns}%
11052 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{220F}{\ensuremath\prod}%
11053 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{2210}{\ensuremath\coprod}%
11054 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{2211}{\ensuremath\sum}%
11055 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{2213}{\ensuremath\mp}%
11056 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{2218}{\ensuremath\circ}%
11057 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{221A}{\ensuremath\surd}%
11058 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{221D}{\ensuremath\propto}%
11059 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{2220}{\ensuremath\angle}%
11060 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{2223}{\ensuremath\mid}%
11061 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{2228}{\ensuremath\vee}%
11062 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{222A}{\ensuremath\cup}%
11063 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{222B}{\ensuremath\smallint}%
11064 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{222E}{\ensuremath\oint}%
11065 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{223C}{\ensuremath\sim}%
11066 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{2240}{\ensuremath\wr}%
11067 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{2243}{\ensuremath\simeq}%
11068 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{2245}{\ensuremath\cong}%
11069 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{2248}{\ensuremath\approx}%
11070 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{224D}{\ensuremath\asymp}%
11071 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{2250}{\ensuremath\doteq}%
11072 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{2260}{\ensuremath\neq}%
11073 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{226A}{\ensuremath\ll}%
11074 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{226B}{\ensuremath\gg}%
11075 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{227A}{\ensuremath\prec}%
11076 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{227B}{\ensuremath\succ}%
11077 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{2283}{\ensuremath\supset}%
11078 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{2286}{\ensuremath\subseteq}%
11079 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{228E}{\ensuremath\uplus}%
11080 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{2291}{\ensuremath\sqsubseteq}%
11081 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{2292}{\ensuremath\sqsupseteq}%
11082 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{2293}{\ensuremath\sqcap}%
11083 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{2294}{\ensuremath\sqcup}%
11084 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{2295}{\ensuremath\oplus}%
11085 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{2296}{\ensuremath\ominus}%
11086 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{2297}{\ensuremath\otimes}%
11087 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{2298}{\ensuremath\oslash}%
11088 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{2299}{\ensuremath\odot}%
11089 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{22A2}{\ensuremath\vdash}%
11090 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{22A3}{\ensuremath\dashv}%
11091 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{22A4}{\ensuremath\ptextop}%
11092 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{22A5}{\ensuremath\bot}%
11093 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{22A8}{\ensuremath\models}%
11094 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{22C0}{\ensuremath\bigwedge}%
11095 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{22C1}{\ensuremath\bigvee}%
11096 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{22C2}{\ensuremath\bigcap}%
11097 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{22C3}{\ensuremath\bigcup}%
11098 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{22C4}{\ensuremath\diamond}%
11099 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{22C5}{\ensuremath\cdot}%
11100 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{22C6}{\ensuremath\star}%
11101 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{22C8}{\ensuremath\bowtie}%
11102 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{2308}{\ensuremath\lceil}%
11103 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{2309}{\ensuremath\rceil}%
11104 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{230A}{\ensuremath\lfloor}%
11105 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{230B}{\ensuremath\rfloor}%
11106 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{2322}{\ensuremath\frown}%
11107 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{2323}{\ensuremath\smile}%
11109 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{25B3}{\ensuremath\triangle}%
11110 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{25B7}{\ensuremath\triangleright}%
11111 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{25BD}{\ensuremath\bigtriangledown}%
11112 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{25C1}{\ensuremath\triangleleft}%
11113 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{25C7}{\ensuremath\diamond}%
11114 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{2660}{\ensuremath\spadesuit}%
11115 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{2661}{\ensuremath\heartsuit}%
11116 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{2662}{\ensuremath\diamondsuit}%
11117 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{2663}{\ensuremath\clubsuit}%
11118 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{266D}{\ensuremath\flat}%
11119 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{266E}{\ensuremath\natural}%
11120 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{266F}{\ensuremath\sharp}%
11121 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{26AA}{\ensuremath\bigcirc}%
11122 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{27B9}{\ensuremath\rangle}%
11123 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{27C2}{\ensuremath\perp}%
11124 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{27E8}{\ensuremath\langle}%
11125 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{27F5}{\ensuremath\longleftarrow}%
11126 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{27F6}{\ensuremath\longrightarrow}%
11127 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{27F7}{\ensuremath\longleftrightarrow}%
11128 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{27FC}{\ensuremath\longmapsto}%
11129 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{29F5}{\ensuremath\setminus}%
11130 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{2A00}{\ensuremath\bigodot}%
11131 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{2A01}{\ensuremath\bigoplus}%
11132 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{2A02}{\ensuremath\bigotimes}%
11133 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{2A04}{\ensuremath\biguplus}%
11134 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{2A06}{\ensuremath\bigsqcup}%
11135 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{2A3F}{\ensuremath\amalg}%
11136 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{2AAF}{\ensuremath\preceq}%
11137 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{2AB0}{\ensuremath\succeq}%
11139 \global\mathchardef\checkmark="1370% actually the square root sign
11140 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{2713}{\ensuremath\checkmark}%
11141 }% end of \unicodechardefs
11143 % UTF-8 byte sequence (pdfTeX) definitions (replacing and @U command)
11144 % It makes the setting that replace UTF-8 byte sequence.
11145 \def\utfeightchardefs{%
11146 \let\DeclareUnicodeCharacter\DeclareUnicodeCharacterUTFviii
11147 \unicodechardefs
11150 % Whether the active definitions of non-ASCII characters expand to
11151 % non-active tokens with the same character code. This is used to
11152 % write characters literally, instead of using active definitions for
11153 % printing the correct glyphs.
11154 \newif\ifpassthroughchars
11155 \passthroughcharsfalse
11157 % For native Unicode handling (XeTeX and LuaTeX),
11158 % provide a definition macro to replace/pass-through a Unicode character
11160 \def\DeclareUnicodeCharacterNative#1#2{%
11161 \catcode"#1=\active
11162 \def\dodeclareunicodecharacternative##1##2##3{%
11163 \begingroup
11164 \uccode`\~="##2\relax
11165 \uppercase{\gdef~}{%
11166 \ifpassthroughchars
11167 ##1%
11168 \else
11169 ##3%
11172 \endgroup
11174 \begingroup
11175 \uccode`\.="#1\relax
11176 \uppercase{\def\UTFNativeTmp{.}}%
11177 \expandafter\dodeclareunicodecharacternative\UTFNativeTmp{#1}{#2}%
11178 \endgroup
11181 % Native Unicode handling (XeTeX and LuaTeX) character replacing definition.
11182 % It activates the setting that replaces Unicode characters.
11183 \def\nativeunicodechardefs{%
11184 \let\DeclareUnicodeCharacter\DeclareUnicodeCharacterNative
11185 \unicodechardefs
11188 % For native Unicode handling (XeTeX and LuaTeX),
11189 % make the character token expand
11190 % to the sequences given in \unicodechardefs for printing.
11191 \def\DeclareUnicodeCharacterNativeAtU#1#2{%
11192 \def\UTFAtUTmp{#2}
11193 \expandafter\globallet\csname uni:#1\endcsname \UTFAtUTmp
11196 % @U command definitions for native Unicode handling (XeTeX and LuaTeX).
11197 \def\nativeunicodechardefsatu{%
11198 \let\DeclareUnicodeCharacter\DeclareUnicodeCharacterNativeAtU
11199 \unicodechardefs
11202 % US-ASCII character definitions.
11203 \def\asciichardefs{% nothing need be done
11204 \relax
11207 % define all Unicode characters we know about, for the sake of @U.
11208 \iftxinativeunicodecapable
11209 \nativeunicodechardefsatu
11210 \else
11211 \utfeightchardefs
11215 % Make non-ASCII characters printable again for compatibility with
11216 % existing Texinfo documents that may use them, even without declaring a
11217 % document encoding.
11219 \setnonasciicharscatcode \other
11222 \message{formatting,}
11224 \newdimen\defaultparindent \defaultparindent = 15pt
11226 \chapheadingskip = 15pt plus 4pt minus 2pt
11227 \secheadingskip = 12pt plus 3pt minus 2pt
11228 \subsecheadingskip = 9pt plus 2pt minus 2pt
11230 % Prevent underfull vbox error messages.
11231 \vbadness = 10000
11233 % Don't be very finicky about underfull hboxes, either.
11234 \hbadness = 6666
11236 % Following George Bush, get rid of widows and orphans.
11237 \widowpenalty=10000
11238 \clubpenalty=10000
11240 % Use TeX 3.0's \emergencystretch to help line breaking, but if we're
11241 % using an old version of TeX, don't do anything. We want the amount of
11242 % stretch added to depend on the line length, hence the dependence on
11243 % \hsize. We call this whenever the paper size is set.
11245 \def\setemergencystretch{%
11246 \ifx\emergencystretch\thisisundefined
11247 % Allow us to assign to \emergencystretch anyway.
11248 \def\emergencystretch{\dimen0}%
11249 \else
11250 \emergencystretch = .15\hsize
11254 % Parameters in order: 1) textheight; 2) textwidth;
11255 % 3) voffset; 4) hoffset; 5) binding offset; 6) topskip;
11256 % 7) physical page height; 8) physical page width.
11258 % We also call \setleading{\textleading}, so the caller should define
11259 % \textleading. The caller should also set \parskip.
11261 \def\internalpagesizes#1#2#3#4#5#6#7#8{%
11262 \voffset = #3\relax
11263 \topskip = #6\relax
11264 \splittopskip = \topskip
11266 \vsize = #1\relax
11267 \advance\vsize by \topskip
11268 \outervsize = \vsize
11269 \advance\outervsize by 2\topandbottommargin
11270 \txipageheight = \vsize
11272 \hsize = #2\relax
11273 \outerhsize = \hsize
11274 \advance\outerhsize by 0.5in
11275 \txipagewidth = \hsize
11277 \normaloffset = #4\relax
11278 \bindingoffset = #5\relax
11280 \ifpdf
11281 \pdfpageheight #7\relax
11282 \pdfpagewidth #8\relax
11283 % if we don't reset these, they will remain at "1 true in" of
11284 % whatever layout pdftex was dumped with.
11285 \pdfhorigin = 1 true in
11286 \pdfvorigin = 1 true in
11287 \else
11288 \ifx\XeTeXrevision\thisisundefined
11289 \special{papersize=#8,#7}%
11290 \else
11291 \pdfpageheight #7\relax
11292 \pdfpagewidth #8\relax
11293 % XeTeX does not have \pdfhorigin and \pdfvorigin.
11297 \setleading{\textleading}
11299 \parindent = \defaultparindent
11300 \setemergencystretch
11303 % @letterpaper (the default).
11304 \def\letterpaper{{\globaldefs = 1
11305 \parskip = 3pt plus 2pt minus 1pt
11306 \textleading = 13.2pt
11308 % If page is nothing but text, make it come out even.
11309 \internalpagesizes{607.2pt}{6in}% that's 46 lines
11310 {\voffset}{.25in}%
11311 {\bindingoffset}{36pt}%
11312 {11in}{8.5in}%
11315 % Use @smallbook to reset parameters for 7x9.25 trim size.
11316 \def\smallbook{{\globaldefs = 1
11317 \parskip = 2pt plus 1pt
11318 \textleading = 12pt
11320 \internalpagesizes{7.5in}{5in}%
11321 {-.2in}{0in}%
11322 {\bindingoffset}{16pt}%
11323 {9.25in}{7in}%
11325 \lispnarrowing = 0.3in
11326 \tolerance = 700
11327 \contentsrightmargin = 0pt
11328 \defbodyindent = .5cm
11331 % Use @smallerbook to reset parameters for 6x9 trim size.
11332 % (Just testing, parameters still in flux.)
11333 \def\smallerbook{{\globaldefs = 1
11334 \parskip = 1.5pt plus 1pt
11335 \textleading = 12pt
11337 \internalpagesizes{7.4in}{4.8in}%
11338 {-.2in}{-.4in}%
11339 {0pt}{14pt}%
11340 {9in}{6in}%
11342 \lispnarrowing = 0.25in
11343 \tolerance = 700
11344 \contentsrightmargin = 0pt
11345 \defbodyindent = .4cm
11348 % Use @afourpaper to print on European A4 paper.
11349 \def\afourpaper{{\globaldefs = 1
11350 \parskip = 3pt plus 2pt minus 1pt
11351 \textleading = 13.2pt
11353 % Double-side printing via postscript on Laserjet 4050
11354 % prints double-sided nicely when \bindingoffset=10mm and \hoffset=-6mm.
11355 % To change the settings for a different printer or situation, adjust
11356 % \normaloffset until the front-side and back-side texts align. Then
11357 % do the same for \bindingoffset. You can set these for testing in
11358 % your texinfo source file like this:
11359 % @tex
11360 % \global\normaloffset = -6mm
11361 % \global\bindingoffset = 10mm
11362 % @end tex
11363 \internalpagesizes{673.2pt}{160mm}% that's 51 lines
11364 {\voffset}{\hoffset}%
11365 {\bindingoffset}{44pt}%
11366 {297mm}{210mm}%
11368 \tolerance = 700
11369 \contentsrightmargin = 0pt
11370 \defbodyindent = 5mm
11373 % Use @afivepaper to print on European A5 paper.
11374 % From romildo@urano.iceb.ufop.br, 2 July 2000.
11375 % He also recommends making @example and @lisp be small.
11376 \def\afivepaper{{\globaldefs = 1
11377 \parskip = 2pt plus 1pt minus 0.1pt
11378 \textleading = 12.5pt
11380 \internalpagesizes{160mm}{120mm}%
11381 {\voffset}{\hoffset}%
11382 {\bindingoffset}{8pt}%
11383 {210mm}{148mm}%
11385 \lispnarrowing = 0.2in
11386 \tolerance = 800
11387 \contentsrightmargin = 0pt
11388 \defbodyindent = 2mm
11389 \tableindent = 12mm
11392 % A specific text layout, 24x15cm overall, intended for A4 paper.
11393 \def\afourlatex{{\globaldefs = 1
11394 \afourpaper
11395 \internalpagesizes{237mm}{150mm}%
11396 {\voffset}{4.6mm}%
11397 {\bindingoffset}{7mm}%
11398 {297mm}{210mm}%
11400 % Must explicitly reset to 0 because we call \afourpaper.
11401 \globaldefs = 0
11404 % Use @afourwide to print on A4 paper in landscape format.
11405 \def\afourwide{{\globaldefs = 1
11406 \afourpaper
11407 \internalpagesizes{241mm}{165mm}%
11408 {\voffset}{-2.95mm}%
11409 {\bindingoffset}{7mm}%
11410 {297mm}{210mm}%
11411 \globaldefs = 0
11414 % @pagesizes TEXTHEIGHT[,TEXTWIDTH]
11415 % Perhaps we should allow setting the margins, \topskip, \parskip,
11416 % and/or leading, also. Or perhaps we should compute them somehow.
11418 \parseargdef\pagesizes{\pagesizesyyy #1,,\finish}
11419 \def\pagesizesyyy#1,#2,#3\finish{{%
11420 \setbox0 = \hbox{\ignorespaces #2}\ifdim\wd0 > 0pt \hsize=#2\relax \fi
11421 \globaldefs = 1
11423 \parskip = 3pt plus 2pt minus 1pt
11424 \setleading{\textleading}%
11426 \dimen0 = #1\relax
11427 \advance\dimen0 by \voffset
11429 \dimen2 = \hsize
11430 \advance\dimen2 by \normaloffset
11432 \internalpagesizes{#1}{\hsize}%
11433 {\voffset}{\normaloffset}%
11434 {\bindingoffset}{44pt}%
11435 {\dimen0}{\dimen2}%
11438 % Set default to letter.
11440 \letterpaper
11442 % Default value of \hfuzz, for suppressing warnings about overfull hboxes.
11443 \hfuzz = 1pt
11446 \message{and turning on texinfo input format.}
11448 \def^^L{\par} % remove \outer, so ^L can appear in an @comment
11450 % DEL is a comment character, in case @c does not suffice.
11451 \catcode`\^^? = 14
11453 % Define macros to output various characters with catcode for normal text.
11454 \catcode`\"=\other \def\normaldoublequote{"}
11455 \catcode`\$=\other \def\normaldollar{$}%$ font-lock fix
11456 \catcode`\+=\other \def\normalplus{+}
11457 \catcode`\<=\other \def\normalless{<}
11458 \catcode`\>=\other \def\normalgreater{>}
11459 \catcode`\^=\other \def\normalcaret{^}
11460 \catcode`\_=\other \def\normalunderscore{_}
11461 \catcode`\|=\other \def\normalverticalbar{|}
11462 \catcode`\~=\other \def\normaltilde{~}
11464 % This macro is used to make a character print one way in \tt
11465 % (where it can probably be output as-is), and another way in other fonts,
11466 % where something hairier probably needs to be done.
11468 % #1 is what to print if we are indeed using \tt; #2 is what to print
11469 % otherwise. Since all the Computer Modern typewriter fonts have zero
11470 % interword stretch (and shrink), and it is reasonable to expect all
11471 % typewriter fonts to have this, we can check that font parameter.
11473 \def\ifusingtt#1#2{\ifdim \fontdimen3\font=0pt #1\else #2\fi}
11475 % Same as above, but check for italic font. Actually this also catches
11476 % non-italic slanted fonts since it is impossible to distinguish them from
11477 % italic fonts. But since this is only used by $ and it uses \sl anyway
11478 % this is not a problem.
11479 \def\ifusingit#1#2{\ifdim \fontdimen1\font>0pt #1\else #2\fi}
11481 % Set catcodes for Texinfo file
11483 % Active characters for printing the wanted glyph.
11484 % Most of these we simply print from the \tt font, but for some, we can
11485 % use math or other variants that look better in normal text.
11487 \catcode`\"=\active
11488 \def\activedoublequote{{\tt\char34}}
11489 \let"=\activedoublequote
11490 \catcode`\~=\active \def\activetilde{{\tt\char126}} \let~ = \activetilde
11491 \chardef\hatchar=`\^
11492 \catcode`\^=\active \def\activehat{{\tt \hatchar}} \let^ = \activehat
11494 \catcode`\_=\active
11495 \def_{\ifusingtt\normalunderscore\_}
11496 \def\_{\leavevmode \kern.07em \vbox{\hrule width.3em height.1ex}\kern .07em }
11497 \let\realunder=_
11499 \catcode`\|=\active \def|{{\tt\char124}}
11501 \chardef \less=`\<
11502 \catcode`\<=\active \def\activeless{{\tt \less}}\let< = \activeless
11503 \chardef \gtr=`\>
11504 \catcode`\>=\active \def\activegtr{{\tt \gtr}}\let> = \activegtr
11505 \catcode`\+=\active \def+{{\tt \char 43}}
11506 \catcode`\$=\active \def${\ifusingit{{\sl\$}}\normaldollar}%$ font-lock fix
11507 \catcode`\-=\active \let-=\normaldash
11510 % used for headline/footline in the output routine, in case the page
11511 % breaks in the middle of an @tex block.
11512 \def\texinfochars{%
11513 \let< = \activeless
11514 \let> = \activegtr
11515 \let~ = \activetilde
11516 \let^ = \activehat
11517 \markupsetuplqdefault \markupsetuprqdefault
11518 \let\b = \strong
11519 \let\i = \smartitalic
11520 % in principle, all other definitions in \tex have to be undone too.
11523 % Used sometimes to turn off (effectively) the active characters even after
11524 % parsing them.
11525 \def\turnoffactive{%
11526 \normalturnoffactive
11527 \otherbackslash
11530 \catcode`\@=0
11532 % \backslashcurfont outputs one backslash character in current font,
11533 % as in \char`\\.
11534 \global\chardef\backslashcurfont=`\\
11535 \global\let\rawbackslashxx=\backslashcurfont % let existing .??s files work
11537 % \realbackslash is an actual character `\' with catcode other, and
11538 % \doublebackslash is two of them (for the pdf outlines).
11539 {\catcode`\\=\other @gdef@realbackslash{\} @gdef@doublebackslash{\\}}
11541 % In Texinfo, backslash is an active character; it prints the backslash
11542 % in fixed width font.
11543 \catcode`\\=\active % @ for escape char from now on.
11545 % Print a typewriter backslash. For math mode, we can't simply use
11546 % \backslashcurfont: the story here is that in math mode, the \char
11547 % of \backslashcurfont ends up printing the roman \ from the math symbol
11548 % font (because \char in math mode uses the \mathcode, and plain.tex
11549 % sets \mathcode`\\="026E). Hence we use an explicit \mathchar,
11550 % which is the decimal equivalent of "715c (class 7, e.g., use \fam;
11551 % ignored family value; char position "5C). We can't use " for the
11552 % usual hex value because it has already been made active.
11554 @def@ttbackslash{{@tt @ifmmode @mathchar29020 @else @backslashcurfont @fi}}
11555 @let@backslashchar = @ttbackslash % @backslashchar{} is for user documents.
11557 % \rawbackslash defines an active \ to do \backslashcurfont.
11558 % \otherbackslash defines an active \ to be a literal `\' character with
11559 % catcode other. We switch back and forth between these.
11560 @gdef@rawbackslash{@let\=@backslashcurfont}
11561 @gdef@otherbackslash{@let\=@realbackslash}
11563 % Same as @turnoffactive except outputs \ as {\tt\char`\\} instead of
11564 % the literal character `\'.
11566 {@catcode`- = @active
11567 @gdef@normalturnoffactive{%
11568 @passthroughcharstrue
11569 @let-=@normaldash
11570 @let"=@normaldoublequote
11571 @let$=@normaldollar %$ font-lock fix
11572 @let+=@normalplus
11573 @let<=@normalless
11574 @let>=@normalgreater
11575 @let^=@normalcaret
11576 @let_=@normalunderscore
11577 @let|=@normalverticalbar
11578 @let~=@normaltilde
11579 @let\=@ttbackslash
11580 @markupsetuplqdefault
11581 @markupsetuprqdefault
11582 @unsepspaces
11586 % If a .fmt file is being used, characters that might appear in a file
11587 % name cannot be active until we have parsed the command line.
11588 % So turn them off again, and have @fixbackslash turn them back on.
11589 @catcode`+=@other @catcode`@_=@other
11591 % \enablebackslashhack - allow file to begin `\input texinfo'
11593 % If a .fmt file is being used, we don't want the `\input texinfo' to show up.
11594 % That is what \eatinput is for; after that, the `\' should revert to printing
11595 % a backslash.
11596 % If the file did not have a `\input texinfo', then it is turned off after
11597 % the first line; otherwise the first `\' in the file would cause an error.
11598 % This is used on the very last line of this file, texinfo.tex.
11599 % We also use @c to call @fixbackslash, in case ends of lines are hidden.
11601 @catcode`@^=7
11602 @catcode`@^^M=13@gdef@enablebackslashhack{%
11603 @global@let\ = @eatinput%
11604 @catcode`@^^M=13%
11605 @def@c{@fixbackslash@c}%
11606 % Definition for the newline at the end of this file.
11607 @def ^^M{@let^^M@secondlinenl}%
11608 % Definition for a newline in the main Texinfo file.
11609 @gdef @secondlinenl{@fixbackslash}%
11610 % In case the first line has a whole-line command on it
11611 @let@originalparsearg@parsearg
11612 @def@parsearg{@fixbackslash@originalparsearg}
11615 {@catcode`@^=7 @catcode`@^^M=13%
11616 @gdef@eatinput input texinfo#1^^M{@fixbackslash}}
11618 % Emergency active definition of newline, in case an active newline token
11619 % appears by mistake.
11620 {@catcode`@^=7 @catcode13=13%
11621 @gdef@enableemergencynewline{%
11622 @gdef^^M{%
11623 @par%
11624 %<warning: active newline>@par%
11628 @gdef@fixbackslash{%
11629 @ifx\@eatinput @let\ = @ttbackslash @fi
11630 @catcode13=5 % regular end of line
11631 @enableemergencynewline
11632 @let@c=@texinfoc
11633 @let@parsearg@originalparsearg
11634 % Also turn back on active characters that might appear in the input
11635 % file name, in case not using a pre-dumped format.
11636 @catcode`+=@active
11637 @catcode`@_=@active
11639 % If texinfo.cnf is present on the system, read it.
11640 % Useful for site-wide @afourpaper, etc. This macro, @fixbackslash, gets
11641 % called at the beginning of every Texinfo file. Not opening texinfo.cnf
11642 % directly in this file, texinfo.tex, makes it possible to make a format
11643 % file for Texinfo.
11645 @openin 1 texinfo.cnf
11646 @ifeof 1 @else @input texinfo.cnf @fi
11647 @closein 1
11651 % Say @foo, not \foo, in error messages.
11652 @escapechar = `@@
11654 % These (along with & and #) are made active for url-breaking, so need
11655 % active definitions as the normal characters.
11656 @def@normaldot{.}
11657 @def@normalquest{?}
11658 @def@normalslash{/}
11660 % These look ok in all fonts, so just make them not special.
11661 % @hashchar{} gets its own user-level command, because of #line.
11662 @catcode`@& = @other @def@normalamp{&}
11663 @catcode`@# = @other @def@normalhash{#}
11664 @catcode`@% = @other @def@normalpercent{%}
11666 @let @hashchar = @normalhash
11668 @c Finally, make ` and ' active, so that txicodequoteundirected and
11669 @c txicodequotebacktick work right in, e.g., @w{@code{`foo'}}. If we
11670 @c don't make ` and ' active, @code will not get them as active chars.
11671 @c Do this last of all since we use ` in the previous @catcode assignments.
11672 @catcode`@'=@active
11673 @catcode`@`=@active
11674 @markupsetuplqdefault
11675 @markupsetuprqdefault
11677 @c Local variables:
11678 @c eval: (add-hook 'write-file-hooks 'time-stamp)
11679 @c page-delimiter: "^\\\\message\\|emacs-page"
11680 @c time-stamp-start: "def\\\\texinfoversion{"
11681 @c time-stamp-format: "%:y-%02m-%02d.%02H"
11682 @c time-stamp-end: "}"
11683 @c End:
11685 @c vim:sw=2:
11687 @enablebackslashhack